* coff-arm.c (coff_arm_link_hash_table_create): Use bfd_zmalloc.
[binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elfxx-mips.c
1 /* MIPS-specific support for ELF
2 Copyright 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012, 2013
4 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5
6 Most of the information added by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support,
7 <ian@cygnus.com>.
8 N32/64 ABI support added by Mark Mitchell, CodeSourcery, LLC.
9 <mark@codesourcery.com>
10 Traditional MIPS targets support added by Koundinya.K, Dansk Data
11 Elektronik & Operations Research Group. <kk@ddeorg.soft.net>
12
13 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
14
15 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
16 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
17 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
18 (at your option) any later version.
19
20 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
21 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
22 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
23 GNU General Public License for more details.
24
25 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
26 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
27 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
28 MA 02110-1301, USA. */
29
30
31 /* This file handles functionality common to the different MIPS ABI's. */
32
33 #include "sysdep.h"
34 #include "bfd.h"
35 #include "libbfd.h"
36 #include "libiberty.h"
37 #include "elf-bfd.h"
38 #include "elfxx-mips.h"
39 #include "elf/mips.h"
40 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
41
42 /* Get the ECOFF swapping routines. */
43 #include "coff/sym.h"
44 #include "coff/symconst.h"
45 #include "coff/ecoff.h"
46 #include "coff/mips.h"
47
48 #include "hashtab.h"
49
50 /* This structure is used to hold information about one GOT entry.
51 There are three types of entry:
52
53 (1) absolute addresses
54 (abfd == NULL)
55 (2) SYMBOL + OFFSET addresses, where SYMBOL is local to an input bfd
56 (abfd != NULL, symndx >= 0)
57 (3) SYMBOL addresses, where SYMBOL is not local to an input bfd
58 (abfd != NULL, symndx == -1)
59
60 Type (3) entries are treated differently for different types of GOT.
61 In the "master" GOT -- i.e. the one that describes every GOT
62 reference needed in the link -- the mips_got_entry is keyed on both
63 the symbol and the input bfd that references it. If it turns out
64 that we need multiple GOTs, we can then use this information to
65 create separate GOTs for each input bfd.
66
67 However, we want each of these separate GOTs to have at most one
68 entry for a given symbol, so their type (3) entries are keyed only
69 on the symbol. The input bfd given by the "abfd" field is somewhat
70 arbitrary in this case.
71
72 This means that when there are multiple GOTs, each GOT has a unique
73 mips_got_entry for every symbol within it. We can therefore use the
74 mips_got_entry fields (tls_type and gotidx) to track the symbol's
75 GOT index.
76
77 However, if it turns out that we need only a single GOT, we continue
78 to use the master GOT to describe it. There may therefore be several
79 mips_got_entries for the same symbol, each with a different input bfd.
80 We want to make sure that each symbol gets a unique GOT entry, so when
81 there's a single GOT, we use the symbol's hash entry, not the
82 mips_got_entry fields, to track a symbol's GOT index. */
83 struct mips_got_entry
84 {
85 /* The input bfd in which the symbol is defined. */
86 bfd *abfd;
87 /* The index of the symbol, as stored in the relocation r_info, if
88 we have a local symbol; -1 otherwise. */
89 long symndx;
90 union
91 {
92 /* If abfd == NULL, an address that must be stored in the got. */
93 bfd_vma address;
94 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx != -1, the addend of the relocation
95 that should be added to the symbol value. */
96 bfd_vma addend;
97 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx == -1, the hash table entry
98 corresponding to symbol in the GOT. The symbol's entry
99 is in the local area if h->global_got_area is GGA_NONE,
100 otherwise it is in the global area. */
101 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
102 } d;
103
104 /* The TLS types included in this GOT entry (specifically, GD and
105 IE). The GD and IE flags can be added as we encounter new
106 relocations. LDM can also be set; it will always be alone, not
107 combined with any GD or IE flags. An LDM GOT entry will be
108 a local symbol entry with r_symndx == 0. */
109 unsigned char tls_type;
110
111 /* The offset from the beginning of the .got section to the entry
112 corresponding to this symbol+addend. If it's a global symbol
113 whose offset is yet to be decided, it's going to be -1. */
114 long gotidx;
115 };
116
117 /* This structure describes a range of addends: [MIN_ADDEND, MAX_ADDEND].
118 The structures form a non-overlapping list that is sorted by increasing
119 MIN_ADDEND. */
120 struct mips_got_page_range
121 {
122 struct mips_got_page_range *next;
123 bfd_signed_vma min_addend;
124 bfd_signed_vma max_addend;
125 };
126
127 /* This structure describes the range of addends that are applied to page
128 relocations against a given symbol. */
129 struct mips_got_page_entry
130 {
131 /* The input bfd in which the symbol is defined. */
132 bfd *abfd;
133 /* The index of the symbol, as stored in the relocation r_info. */
134 long symndx;
135 /* The ranges for this page entry. */
136 struct mips_got_page_range *ranges;
137 /* The maximum number of page entries needed for RANGES. */
138 bfd_vma num_pages;
139 };
140
141 /* This structure is used to hold .got information when linking. */
142
143 struct mips_got_info
144 {
145 /* The global symbol in the GOT with the lowest index in the dynamic
146 symbol table. */
147 struct elf_link_hash_entry *global_gotsym;
148 /* The number of global .got entries. */
149 unsigned int global_gotno;
150 /* The number of global .got entries that are in the GGA_RELOC_ONLY area. */
151 unsigned int reloc_only_gotno;
152 /* The number of .got slots used for TLS. */
153 unsigned int tls_gotno;
154 /* The first unused TLS .got entry. Used only during
155 mips_elf_initialize_tls_index. */
156 unsigned int tls_assigned_gotno;
157 /* The number of local .got entries, eventually including page entries. */
158 unsigned int local_gotno;
159 /* The maximum number of page entries needed. */
160 unsigned int page_gotno;
161 /* The number of local .got entries we have used. */
162 unsigned int assigned_gotno;
163 /* A hash table holding members of the got. */
164 struct htab *got_entries;
165 /* A hash table of mips_got_page_entry structures. */
166 struct htab *got_page_entries;
167 /* A hash table mapping input bfds to other mips_got_info. NULL
168 unless multi-got was necessary. */
169 struct htab *bfd2got;
170 /* In multi-got links, a pointer to the next got (err, rather, most
171 of the time, it points to the previous got). */
172 struct mips_got_info *next;
173 /* This is the GOT index of the TLS LDM entry for the GOT, MINUS_ONE
174 for none, or MINUS_TWO for not yet assigned. This is needed
175 because a single-GOT link may have multiple hash table entries
176 for the LDM. It does not get initialized in multi-GOT mode. */
177 bfd_vma tls_ldm_offset;
178 };
179
180 /* Map an input bfd to a got in a multi-got link. */
181
182 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash
183 {
184 bfd *bfd;
185 struct mips_got_info *g;
186 };
187
188 /* Structure passed when traversing the bfd2got hash table, used to
189 create and merge bfd's gots. */
190
191 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg
192 {
193 /* A hashtable that maps bfds to gots. */
194 htab_t bfd2got;
195 /* The output bfd. */
196 bfd *obfd;
197 /* The link information. */
198 struct bfd_link_info *info;
199 /* A pointer to the primary got, i.e., the one that's going to get
200 the implicit relocations from DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO and
201 DT_MIPS_GOTSYM. */
202 struct mips_got_info *primary;
203 /* A non-primary got we're trying to merge with other input bfd's
204 gots. */
205 struct mips_got_info *current;
206 /* The maximum number of got entries that can be addressed with a
207 16-bit offset. */
208 unsigned int max_count;
209 /* The maximum number of page entries needed by each got. */
210 unsigned int max_pages;
211 /* The total number of global entries which will live in the
212 primary got and be automatically relocated. This includes
213 those not referenced by the primary GOT but included in
214 the "master" GOT. */
215 unsigned int global_count;
216 };
217
218 /* Another structure used to pass arguments for got entries traversal. */
219
220 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg
221 {
222 struct mips_got_info *g;
223 int value;
224 unsigned int needed_relocs;
225 struct bfd_link_info *info;
226 };
227
228 /* A structure used to count TLS relocations or GOT entries, for GOT
229 entry or ELF symbol table traversal. */
230
231 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg
232 {
233 struct bfd_link_info *info;
234 unsigned int needed;
235 };
236
237 struct _mips_elf_section_data
238 {
239 struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
240 union
241 {
242 bfd_byte *tdata;
243 } u;
244 };
245
246 #define mips_elf_section_data(sec) \
247 ((struct _mips_elf_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec))
248
249 #define is_mips_elf(bfd) \
250 (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
251 && elf_tdata (bfd) != NULL \
252 && elf_object_id (bfd) == MIPS_ELF_DATA)
253
254 /* The ABI says that every symbol used by dynamic relocations must have
255 a global GOT entry. Among other things, this provides the dynamic
256 linker with a free, directly-indexed cache. The GOT can therefore
257 contain symbols that are not referenced by GOT relocations themselves
258 (in other words, it may have symbols that are not referenced by things
259 like R_MIPS_GOT16 and R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE).
260
261 GOT relocations are less likely to overflow if we put the associated
262 GOT entries towards the beginning. We therefore divide the global
263 GOT entries into two areas: "normal" and "reloc-only". Entries in
264 the first area can be used for both dynamic relocations and GP-relative
265 accesses, while those in the "reloc-only" area are for dynamic
266 relocations only.
267
268 These GGA_* ("Global GOT Area") values are organised so that lower
269 values are more general than higher values. Also, non-GGA_NONE
270 values are ordered by the position of the area in the GOT. */
271 #define GGA_NORMAL 0
272 #define GGA_RELOC_ONLY 1
273 #define GGA_NONE 2
274
275 /* Information about a non-PIC interface to a PIC function. There are
276 two ways of creating these interfaces. The first is to add:
277
278 lui $25,%hi(func)
279 addiu $25,$25,%lo(func)
280
281 immediately before a PIC function "func". The second is to add:
282
283 lui $25,%hi(func)
284 j func
285 addiu $25,$25,%lo(func)
286
287 to a separate trampoline section.
288
289 Stubs of the first kind go in a new section immediately before the
290 target function. Stubs of the second kind go in a single section
291 pointed to by the hash table's "strampoline" field. */
292 struct mips_elf_la25_stub {
293 /* The generated section that contains this stub. */
294 asection *stub_section;
295
296 /* The offset of the stub from the start of STUB_SECTION. */
297 bfd_vma offset;
298
299 /* One symbol for the original function. Its location is available
300 in H->root.root.u.def. */
301 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
302 };
303
304 /* Macros for populating a mips_elf_la25_stub. */
305
306 #define LA25_LUI(VAL) (0x3c190000 | (VAL)) /* lui t9,VAL */
307 #define LA25_J(VAL) (0x08000000 | (((VAL) >> 2) & 0x3ffffff)) /* j VAL */
308 #define LA25_ADDIU(VAL) (0x27390000 | (VAL)) /* addiu t9,t9,VAL */
309 #define LA25_LUI_MICROMIPS(VAL) \
310 (0x41b90000 | (VAL)) /* lui t9,VAL */
311 #define LA25_J_MICROMIPS(VAL) \
312 (0xd4000000 | (((VAL) >> 1) & 0x3ffffff)) /* j VAL */
313 #define LA25_ADDIU_MICROMIPS(VAL) \
314 (0x33390000 | (VAL)) /* addiu t9,t9,VAL */
315
316 /* This structure is passed to mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f when sorting
317 the dynamic symbols. */
318
319 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data
320 {
321 /* The symbol in the global GOT with the lowest dynamic symbol table
322 index. */
323 struct elf_link_hash_entry *low;
324 /* The least dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a non-TLS
325 symbol with a GOT entry. */
326 long min_got_dynindx;
327 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a symbol
328 with a GOT entry that is not referenced (e.g., a dynamic symbol
329 with dynamic relocations pointing to it from non-primary GOTs). */
330 long max_unref_got_dynindx;
331 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index not corresponding to a
332 symbol without a GOT entry. */
333 long max_non_got_dynindx;
334 };
335
336 /* The MIPS ELF linker needs additional information for each symbol in
337 the global hash table. */
338
339 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry
340 {
341 struct elf_link_hash_entry root;
342
343 /* External symbol information. */
344 EXTR esym;
345
346 /* The la25 stub we have created for ths symbol, if any. */
347 struct mips_elf_la25_stub *la25_stub;
348
349 /* Number of R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 relocs against
350 this symbol. */
351 unsigned int possibly_dynamic_relocs;
352
353 /* If there is a stub that 32 bit functions should use to call this
354 16 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
355 asection *fn_stub;
356
357 /* If there is a stub that 16 bit functions should use to call this
358 32 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
359 asection *call_stub;
360
361 /* This is like the call_stub field, but it is used if the function
362 being called returns a floating point value. */
363 asection *call_fp_stub;
364
365 #define GOT_NORMAL 0
366 #define GOT_TLS_GD 1
367 #define GOT_TLS_LDM 2
368 #define GOT_TLS_IE 4
369 #define GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE 0x40
370 #define GOT_TLS_DONE 0x80
371 unsigned char tls_type;
372
373 /* This is only used in single-GOT mode; in multi-GOT mode there
374 is one mips_got_entry per GOT entry, so the offset is stored
375 there. In single-GOT mode there may be many mips_got_entry
376 structures all referring to the same GOT slot. It might be
377 possible to use root.got.offset instead, but that field is
378 overloaded already. */
379 bfd_vma tls_got_offset;
380
381 /* The highest GGA_* value that satisfies all references to this symbol. */
382 unsigned int global_got_area : 2;
383
384 /* True if all GOT relocations against this symbol are for calls. This is
385 a looser condition than no_fn_stub below, because there may be other
386 non-call non-GOT relocations against the symbol. */
387 unsigned int got_only_for_calls : 1;
388
389 /* True if one of the relocations described by possibly_dynamic_relocs
390 is against a readonly section. */
391 unsigned int readonly_reloc : 1;
392
393 /* True if there is a relocation against this symbol that must be
394 resolved by the static linker (in other words, if the relocation
395 cannot possibly be made dynamic). */
396 unsigned int has_static_relocs : 1;
397
398 /* True if we must not create a .MIPS.stubs entry for this symbol.
399 This is set, for example, if there are relocations related to
400 taking the function's address, i.e. any but R_MIPS_CALL*16 ones.
401 See "MIPS ABI Supplement, 3rd Edition", p. 4-20. */
402 unsigned int no_fn_stub : 1;
403
404 /* Whether we need the fn_stub; this is true if this symbol appears
405 in any relocs other than a 16 bit call. */
406 unsigned int need_fn_stub : 1;
407
408 /* True if this symbol is referenced by branch relocations from
409 any non-PIC input file. This is used to determine whether an
410 la25 stub is required. */
411 unsigned int has_nonpic_branches : 1;
412
413 /* Does this symbol need a traditional MIPS lazy-binding stub
414 (as opposed to a PLT entry)? */
415 unsigned int needs_lazy_stub : 1;
416 };
417
418 /* MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
419
420 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table
421 {
422 struct elf_link_hash_table root;
423
424 /* The number of .rtproc entries. */
425 bfd_size_type procedure_count;
426
427 /* The size of the .compact_rel section (if SGI_COMPAT). */
428 bfd_size_type compact_rel_size;
429
430 /* This flag indicates that the value of DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP dynamic entry
431 is set to the address of __rld_obj_head as in IRIX5 and IRIX6. */
432 bfd_boolean use_rld_obj_head;
433
434 /* The __rld_map or __rld_obj_head symbol. */
435 struct elf_link_hash_entry *rld_symbol;
436
437 /* This is set if we see any mips16 stub sections. */
438 bfd_boolean mips16_stubs_seen;
439
440 /* True if we can generate copy relocs and PLTs. */
441 bfd_boolean use_plts_and_copy_relocs;
442
443 /* True if we're generating code for VxWorks. */
444 bfd_boolean is_vxworks;
445
446 /* True if we already reported the small-data section overflow. */
447 bfd_boolean small_data_overflow_reported;
448
449 /* Shortcuts to some dynamic sections, or NULL if they are not
450 being used. */
451 asection *srelbss;
452 asection *sdynbss;
453 asection *srelplt;
454 asection *srelplt2;
455 asection *sgotplt;
456 asection *splt;
457 asection *sstubs;
458 asection *sgot;
459
460 /* The master GOT information. */
461 struct mips_got_info *got_info;
462
463 /* The size of the PLT header in bytes. */
464 bfd_vma plt_header_size;
465
466 /* The size of a PLT entry in bytes. */
467 bfd_vma plt_entry_size;
468
469 /* The number of functions that need a lazy-binding stub. */
470 bfd_vma lazy_stub_count;
471
472 /* The size of a function stub entry in bytes. */
473 bfd_vma function_stub_size;
474
475 /* The number of reserved entries at the beginning of the GOT. */
476 unsigned int reserved_gotno;
477
478 /* The section used for mips_elf_la25_stub trampolines.
479 See the comment above that structure for details. */
480 asection *strampoline;
481
482 /* A table of mips_elf_la25_stubs, indexed by (input_section, offset)
483 pairs. */
484 htab_t la25_stubs;
485
486 /* A function FN (NAME, IS, OS) that creates a new input section
487 called NAME and links it to output section OS. If IS is nonnull,
488 the new section should go immediately before it, otherwise it
489 should go at the (current) beginning of OS.
490
491 The function returns the new section on success, otherwise it
492 returns null. */
493 asection *(*add_stub_section) (const char *, asection *, asection *);
494 };
495
496 /* Get the MIPS ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
497
498 #define mips_elf_hash_table(p) \
499 (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
500 == MIPS_ELF_DATA ? ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
501
502 /* A structure used to communicate with htab_traverse callbacks. */
503 struct mips_htab_traverse_info
504 {
505 /* The usual link-wide information. */
506 struct bfd_link_info *info;
507 bfd *output_bfd;
508
509 /* Starts off FALSE and is set to TRUE if the link should be aborted. */
510 bfd_boolean error;
511 };
512
513 /* MIPS ELF private object data. */
514
515 struct mips_elf_obj_tdata
516 {
517 /* Generic ELF private object data. */
518 struct elf_obj_tdata root;
519
520 /* Input BFD providing Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP attribute for output. */
521 bfd *abi_fp_bfd;
522 };
523
524 /* Get MIPS ELF private object data from BFD's tdata. */
525
526 #define mips_elf_tdata(bfd) \
527 ((struct mips_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
528
529 #define TLS_RELOC_P(r_type) \
530 (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32 \
531 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 \
532 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32 \
533 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64 \
534 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD \
535 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM \
536 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16 \
537 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16 \
538 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL \
539 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32 \
540 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64 \
541 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16 \
542 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16 \
543 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_GD \
544 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM \
545 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_HI16 \
546 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_LO16 \
547 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL \
548 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_HI16 \
549 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_LO16 \
550 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD \
551 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM \
552 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16 \
553 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16 \
554 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL \
555 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16 \
556 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16)
557
558 /* Structure used to pass information to mips_elf_output_extsym. */
559
560 struct extsym_info
561 {
562 bfd *abfd;
563 struct bfd_link_info *info;
564 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug;
565 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
566 bfd_boolean failed;
567 };
568
569 /* The names of the runtime procedure table symbols used on IRIX5. */
570
571 static const char * const mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[] =
572 {
573 "_procedure_table",
574 "_procedure_string_table",
575 "_procedure_table_size",
576 NULL
577 };
578
579 /* These structures are used to generate the .compact_rel section on
580 IRIX5. */
581
582 typedef struct
583 {
584 unsigned long id1; /* Always one? */
585 unsigned long num; /* Number of compact relocation entries. */
586 unsigned long id2; /* Always two? */
587 unsigned long offset; /* The file offset of the first relocation. */
588 unsigned long reserved0; /* Zero? */
589 unsigned long reserved1; /* Zero? */
590 } Elf32_compact_rel;
591
592 typedef struct
593 {
594 bfd_byte id1[4];
595 bfd_byte num[4];
596 bfd_byte id2[4];
597 bfd_byte offset[4];
598 bfd_byte reserved0[4];
599 bfd_byte reserved1[4];
600 } Elf32_External_compact_rel;
601
602 typedef struct
603 {
604 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
605 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
606 unsigned int dist2to : 8;
607 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
608 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
609 unsigned long vaddr; /* VADDR to be relocated. */
610 } Elf32_crinfo;
611
612 typedef struct
613 {
614 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
615 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
616 unsigned int dist2to : 8;
617 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
618 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
619 } Elf32_crinfo2;
620
621 typedef struct
622 {
623 bfd_byte info[4];
624 bfd_byte konst[4];
625 bfd_byte vaddr[4];
626 } Elf32_External_crinfo;
627
628 typedef struct
629 {
630 bfd_byte info[4];
631 bfd_byte konst[4];
632 } Elf32_External_crinfo2;
633
634 /* These are the constants used to swap the bitfields in a crinfo. */
635
636 #define CRINFO_CTYPE (0x1)
637 #define CRINFO_CTYPE_SH (31)
638 #define CRINFO_RTYPE (0xf)
639 #define CRINFO_RTYPE_SH (27)
640 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO (0xff)
641 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH (19)
642 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR (0x7ffff)
643 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH (0)
644
645 /* A compact relocation info has long (3 words) or short (2 words)
646 formats. A short format doesn't have VADDR field and relvaddr
647 fields contains ((VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry) >> 2). */
648 #define CRF_MIPS_LONG 1
649 #define CRF_MIPS_SHORT 0
650
651 /* There are 4 types of compact relocation at least. The value KONST
652 has different meaning for each type:
653
654 (type) (konst)
655 CT_MIPS_REL32 Address in data
656 CT_MIPS_WORD Address in word (XXX)
657 CT_MIPS_GPHI_LO GP - vaddr
658 CT_MIPS_JMPAD Address to jump
659 */
660
661 #define CRT_MIPS_REL32 0xa
662 #define CRT_MIPS_WORD 0xb
663 #define CRT_MIPS_GPHI_LO 0xc
664 #define CRT_MIPS_JMPAD 0xd
665
666 #define mips_elf_set_cr_format(x,format) ((x).ctype = (format))
667 #define mips_elf_set_cr_type(x,type) ((x).rtype = (type))
668 #define mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to(x,v) ((x).dist2to = (v))
669 #define mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr(x,d) ((x).relvaddr = (d)<<2)
670 \f
671 /* The structure of the runtime procedure descriptor created by the
672 loader for use by the static exception system. */
673
674 typedef struct runtime_pdr {
675 bfd_vma adr; /* Memory address of start of procedure. */
676 long regmask; /* Save register mask. */
677 long regoffset; /* Save register offset. */
678 long fregmask; /* Save floating point register mask. */
679 long fregoffset; /* Save floating point register offset. */
680 long frameoffset; /* Frame size. */
681 short framereg; /* Frame pointer register. */
682 short pcreg; /* Offset or reg of return pc. */
683 long irpss; /* Index into the runtime string table. */
684 long reserved;
685 struct exception_info *exception_info;/* Pointer to exception array. */
686 } RPDR, *pRPDR;
687 #define cbRPDR sizeof (RPDR)
688 #define rpdNil ((pRPDR) 0)
689 \f
690 static struct mips_got_entry *mips_elf_create_local_got_entry
691 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd *, bfd_vma, unsigned long,
692 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, int);
693 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f
694 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
695 static bfd_vma mips_elf_high
696 (bfd_vma);
697 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
698 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *,
699 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, asection *, bfd_vma,
700 bfd_vma *, asection *);
701 static hashval_t mips_elf_got_entry_hash
702 (const void *);
703 static bfd_vma mips_elf_adjust_gp
704 (bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
705 static struct mips_got_info *mips_elf_got_for_ibfd
706 (struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
707
708 /* This will be used when we sort the dynamic relocation records. */
709 static bfd *reldyn_sorting_bfd;
710
711 /* True if ABFD is for CPUs with load interlocking that include
712 non-MIPS1 CPUs and R3900. */
713 #define LOAD_INTERLOCKS_P(abfd) \
714 ( ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) != E_MIPS_ARCH_1) \
715 || ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == E_MIPS_MACH_3900))
716
717 /* True if ABFD is for CPUs that are faster if JAL is converted to BAL.
718 This should be safe for all architectures. We enable this predicate
719 for RM9000 for now. */
720 #define JAL_TO_BAL_P(abfd) \
721 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == E_MIPS_MACH_9000)
722
723 /* True if ABFD is for CPUs that are faster if JALR is converted to BAL.
724 This should be safe for all architectures. We enable this predicate for
725 all CPUs. */
726 #define JALR_TO_BAL_P(abfd) 1
727
728 /* True if ABFD is for CPUs that are faster if JR is converted to B.
729 This should be safe for all architectures. We enable this predicate for
730 all CPUs. */
731 #define JR_TO_B_P(abfd) 1
732
733 /* True if ABFD is a PIC object. */
734 #define PIC_OBJECT_P(abfd) \
735 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC) != 0)
736
737 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N32 ABI. */
738 #define ABI_N32_P(abfd) \
739 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI2) != 0)
740
741 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N64 ABI. */
742 #define ABI_64_P(abfd) \
743 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64)
744
745 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using NewABI conventions. */
746 #define NEWABI_P(abfd) (ABI_N32_P (abfd) || ABI_64_P (abfd))
747
748 /* The IRIX compatibility level we are striving for. */
749 #define IRIX_COMPAT(abfd) \
750 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_irix_compat (abfd))
751
752 /* Whether we are trying to be compatible with IRIX at all. */
753 #define SGI_COMPAT(abfd) \
754 (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) != ict_none)
755
756 /* The name of the options section. */
757 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME(abfd) \
758 (NEWABI_P (abfd) ? ".MIPS.options" : ".options")
759
760 /* True if NAME is the recognized name of any SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section.
761 Some IRIX system files do not use MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME. */
762 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P(NAME) \
763 (strcmp (NAME, ".MIPS.options") == 0 || strcmp (NAME, ".options") == 0)
764
765 /* Whether the section is readonly. */
766 #define MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION(sec) \
767 ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY)) \
768 == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY))
769
770 /* The name of the stub section. */
771 #define MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME(abfd) ".MIPS.stubs"
772
773 /* The size of an external REL relocation. */
774 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE(abfd) \
775 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rel)
776
777 /* The size of an external RELA relocation. */
778 #define MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE(abfd) \
779 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rela)
780
781 /* The size of an external dynamic table entry. */
782 #define MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE(abfd) \
783 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn)
784
785 /* The size of a GOT entry. */
786 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE(abfd) \
787 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->arch_size / 8)
788
789 /* The size of the .rld_map section. */
790 #define MIPS_ELF_RLD_MAP_SIZE(abfd) \
791 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->arch_size / 8)
792
793 /* The size of a symbol-table entry. */
794 #define MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE(abfd) \
795 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym)
796
797 /* The default alignment for sections, as a power of two. */
798 #define MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN(abfd) \
799 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->log_file_align)
800
801 /* Get word-sized data. */
802 #define MIPS_ELF_GET_WORD(abfd, ptr) \
803 (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? bfd_get_64 (abfd, ptr) : bfd_get_32 (abfd, ptr))
804
805 /* Put out word-sized data. */
806 #define MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD(abfd, val, ptr) \
807 (ABI_64_P (abfd) \
808 ? bfd_put_64 (abfd, val, ptr) \
809 : bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, ptr))
810
811 /* The opcode for word-sized loads (LW or LD). */
812 #define MIPS_ELF_LOAD_WORD(abfd) \
813 (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 0xdc000000 : 0x8c000000)
814
815 /* Add a dynamic symbol table-entry. */
816 #define MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY(info, tag, val) \
817 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, tag, val)
818
819 #define MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO(abfd, rtype, rela) \
820 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_rtype_to_howto (rtype, rela))
821
822 /* The name of the dynamic relocation section. */
823 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME(INFO) \
824 (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? ".rela.dyn" : ".rel.dyn")
825
826 /* In case we're on a 32-bit machine, construct a 64-bit "-1" value
827 from smaller values. Start with zero, widen, *then* decrement. */
828 #define MINUS_ONE (((bfd_vma)0) - 1)
829 #define MINUS_TWO (((bfd_vma)0) - 2)
830
831 /* The value to write into got[1] for SVR4 targets, to identify it is
832 a GNU object. The dynamic linker can then use got[1] to store the
833 module pointer. */
834 #define MIPS_ELF_GNU_GOT1_MASK(abfd) \
835 ((bfd_vma) 1 << (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 63 : 31))
836
837 /* The offset of $gp from the beginning of the .got section. */
838 #define ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET(INFO) \
839 (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? 0x0 : 0x7ff0)
840
841 /* The maximum size of the GOT for it to be addressable using 16-bit
842 offsets from $gp. */
843 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE(INFO) (ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (INFO) + 0x7fff)
844
845 /* Instructions which appear in a stub. */
846 #define STUB_LW(abfd) \
847 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
848 ? 0xdf998010 /* ld t9,0x8010(gp) */ \
849 : 0x8f998010)) /* lw t9,0x8010(gp) */
850 #define STUB_MOVE(abfd) \
851 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
852 ? 0x03e0782d /* daddu t7,ra */ \
853 : 0x03e07821)) /* addu t7,ra */
854 #define STUB_LUI(VAL) (0x3c180000 + (VAL)) /* lui t8,VAL */
855 #define STUB_JALR 0x0320f809 /* jalr t9,ra */
856 #define STUB_ORI(VAL) (0x37180000 + (VAL)) /* ori t8,t8,VAL */
857 #define STUB_LI16U(VAL) (0x34180000 + (VAL)) /* ori t8,zero,VAL unsigned */
858 #define STUB_LI16S(abfd, VAL) \
859 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
860 ? (0x64180000 + (VAL)) /* daddiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */ \
861 : (0x24180000 + (VAL)))) /* addiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */
862
863 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE 16
864 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE 20
865
866 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
867 section. */
868
869 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER(abfd) \
870 (ABI_N32_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib32/libc.so.1" \
871 : ABI_64_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib64/libc.so.1" \
872 : "/usr/lib/libc.so.1")
873
874 #ifdef BFD64
875 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) \
876 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? CONCAT4 (pre,64,_,pos) : CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos))
877 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
878 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_SYM (i) : ELF32_R_SYM (i))
879 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
880 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_MIPS_R_TYPE (i) : ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
881 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
882 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_INFO (s, t) : ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
883 #else
884 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos)
885 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
886 (ELF32_R_SYM (i))
887 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
888 (ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
889 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
890 (ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
891 #endif
892 \f
893 /* The mips16 compiler uses a couple of special sections to handle
894 floating point arguments.
895
896 Section names that look like .mips16.fn.FNNAME contain stubs that
897 copy floating point arguments from the fp regs to the gp regs and
898 then jump to FNNAME. If any 32 bit function calls FNNAME, the
899 call should be redirected to the stub instead. If no 32 bit
900 function calls FNNAME, the stub should be discarded. We need to
901 consider any reference to the function, not just a call, because
902 if the address of the function is taken we will need the stub,
903 since the address might be passed to a 32 bit function.
904
905 Section names that look like .mips16.call.FNNAME contain stubs
906 that copy floating point arguments from the gp regs to the fp
907 regs and then jump to FNNAME. If FNNAME is a 32 bit function,
908 then any 16 bit function that calls FNNAME should be redirected
909 to the stub instead. If FNNAME is not a 32 bit function, the
910 stub should be discarded.
911
912 .mips16.call.fp.FNNAME sections are similar, but contain stubs
913 which call FNNAME and then copy the return value from the fp regs
914 to the gp regs. These stubs store the return value in $18 while
915 calling FNNAME; any function which might call one of these stubs
916 must arrange to save $18 around the call. (This case is not
917 needed for 32 bit functions that call 16 bit functions, because
918 16 bit functions always return floating point values in both
919 $f0/$f1 and $2/$3.)
920
921 Note that in all cases FNNAME might be defined statically.
922 Therefore, FNNAME is not used literally. Instead, the relocation
923 information will indicate which symbol the section is for.
924
925 We record any stubs that we find in the symbol table. */
926
927 #define FN_STUB ".mips16.fn."
928 #define CALL_STUB ".mips16.call."
929 #define CALL_FP_STUB ".mips16.call.fp."
930
931 #define FN_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, FN_STUB)
932 #define CALL_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, CALL_STUB)
933 #define CALL_FP_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, CALL_FP_STUB)
934 \f
935 /* The format of the first PLT entry in an O32 executable. */
936 static const bfd_vma mips_o32_exec_plt0_entry[] =
937 {
938 0x3c1c0000, /* lui $28, %hi(&GOTPLT[0]) */
939 0x8f990000, /* lw $25, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])($28) */
940 0x279c0000, /* addiu $28, $28, %lo(&GOTPLT[0]) */
941 0x031cc023, /* subu $24, $24, $28 */
942 0x03e07821, /* move $15, $31 # 32-bit move (addu) */
943 0x0018c082, /* srl $24, $24, 2 */
944 0x0320f809, /* jalr $25 */
945 0x2718fffe /* subu $24, $24, 2 */
946 };
947
948 /* The format of the first PLT entry in an N32 executable. Different
949 because gp ($28) is not available; we use t2 ($14) instead. */
950 static const bfd_vma mips_n32_exec_plt0_entry[] =
951 {
952 0x3c0e0000, /* lui $14, %hi(&GOTPLT[0]) */
953 0x8dd90000, /* lw $25, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])($14) */
954 0x25ce0000, /* addiu $14, $14, %lo(&GOTPLT[0]) */
955 0x030ec023, /* subu $24, $24, $14 */
956 0x03e07821, /* move $15, $31 # 32-bit move (addu) */
957 0x0018c082, /* srl $24, $24, 2 */
958 0x0320f809, /* jalr $25 */
959 0x2718fffe /* subu $24, $24, 2 */
960 };
961
962 /* The format of the first PLT entry in an N64 executable. Different
963 from N32 because of the increased size of GOT entries. */
964 static const bfd_vma mips_n64_exec_plt0_entry[] =
965 {
966 0x3c0e0000, /* lui $14, %hi(&GOTPLT[0]) */
967 0xddd90000, /* ld $25, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])($14) */
968 0x25ce0000, /* addiu $14, $14, %lo(&GOTPLT[0]) */
969 0x030ec023, /* subu $24, $24, $14 */
970 0x03e0782d, /* move $15, $31 # 64-bit move (daddu) */
971 0x0018c0c2, /* srl $24, $24, 3 */
972 0x0320f809, /* jalr $25 */
973 0x2718fffe /* subu $24, $24, 2 */
974 };
975
976 /* The format of subsequent PLT entries. */
977 static const bfd_vma mips_exec_plt_entry[] =
978 {
979 0x3c0f0000, /* lui $15, %hi(.got.plt entry) */
980 0x01f90000, /* l[wd] $25, %lo(.got.plt entry)($15) */
981 0x25f80000, /* addiu $24, $15, %lo(.got.plt entry) */
982 0x03200008 /* jr $25 */
983 };
984
985 /* The format of the first PLT entry in a VxWorks executable. */
986 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry[] =
987 {
988 0x3c190000, /* lui t9, %hi(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_) */
989 0x27390000, /* addiu t9, t9, %lo(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_) */
990 0x8f390008, /* lw t9, 8(t9) */
991 0x00000000, /* nop */
992 0x03200008, /* jr t9 */
993 0x00000000 /* nop */
994 };
995
996 /* The format of subsequent PLT entries. */
997 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry[] =
998 {
999 0x10000000, /* b .PLT_resolver */
1000 0x24180000, /* li t8, <pltindex> */
1001 0x3c190000, /* lui t9, %hi(<.got.plt slot>) */
1002 0x27390000, /* addiu t9, t9, %lo(<.got.plt slot>) */
1003 0x8f390000, /* lw t9, 0(t9) */
1004 0x00000000, /* nop */
1005 0x03200008, /* jr t9 */
1006 0x00000000 /* nop */
1007 };
1008
1009 /* The format of the first PLT entry in a VxWorks shared object. */
1010 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry[] =
1011 {
1012 0x8f990008, /* lw t9, 8(gp) */
1013 0x00000000, /* nop */
1014 0x03200008, /* jr t9 */
1015 0x00000000, /* nop */
1016 0x00000000, /* nop */
1017 0x00000000 /* nop */
1018 };
1019
1020 /* The format of subsequent PLT entries. */
1021 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry[] =
1022 {
1023 0x10000000, /* b .PLT_resolver */
1024 0x24180000 /* li t8, <pltindex> */
1025 };
1026 \f
1027 /* microMIPS 32-bit opcode helper installer. */
1028
1029 static void
1030 bfd_put_micromips_32 (const bfd *abfd, bfd_vma opcode, bfd_byte *ptr)
1031 {
1032 bfd_put_16 (abfd, (opcode >> 16) & 0xffff, ptr);
1033 bfd_put_16 (abfd, opcode & 0xffff, ptr + 2);
1034 }
1035
1036 /* microMIPS 32-bit opcode helper retriever. */
1037
1038 static bfd_vma
1039 bfd_get_micromips_32 (const bfd *abfd, const bfd_byte *ptr)
1040 {
1041 return (bfd_get_16 (abfd, ptr) << 16) | bfd_get_16 (abfd, ptr + 2);
1042 }
1043 \f
1044 /* Look up an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
1045
1046 #define mips_elf_link_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy, follow) \
1047 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) \
1048 elf_link_hash_lookup (&(table)->root, (string), (create), \
1049 (copy), (follow)))
1050
1051 /* Traverse a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
1052
1053 #define mips_elf_link_hash_traverse(table, func, info) \
1054 (elf_link_hash_traverse \
1055 (&(table)->root, \
1056 (bfd_boolean (*) (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, void *)) (func), \
1057 (info)))
1058
1059 /* Find the base offsets for thread-local storage in this object,
1060 for GD/LD and IE/LE respectively. */
1061
1062 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
1063 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
1064
1065 static bfd_vma
1066 dtprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
1067 {
1068 /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
1069 if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
1070 return 0;
1071 return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
1072 }
1073
1074 static bfd_vma
1075 tprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
1076 {
1077 /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
1078 if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
1079 return 0;
1080 return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
1081 }
1082
1083 /* Create an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
1084
1085 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
1086 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
1087 struct bfd_hash_table *table, const char *string)
1088 {
1089 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *ret =
1090 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
1091
1092 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
1093 subclass. */
1094 if (ret == NULL)
1095 ret = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry));
1096 if (ret == NULL)
1097 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
1098
1099 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
1100 ret = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
1101 _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc ((struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret,
1102 table, string));
1103 if (ret != NULL)
1104 {
1105 /* Set local fields. */
1106 memset (&ret->esym, 0, sizeof (EXTR));
1107 /* We use -2 as a marker to indicate that the information has
1108 not been set. -1 means there is no associated ifd. */
1109 ret->esym.ifd = -2;
1110 ret->la25_stub = 0;
1111 ret->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0;
1112 ret->fn_stub = NULL;
1113 ret->call_stub = NULL;
1114 ret->call_fp_stub = NULL;
1115 ret->tls_type = GOT_NORMAL;
1116 ret->global_got_area = GGA_NONE;
1117 ret->got_only_for_calls = TRUE;
1118 ret->readonly_reloc = FALSE;
1119 ret->has_static_relocs = FALSE;
1120 ret->no_fn_stub = FALSE;
1121 ret->need_fn_stub = FALSE;
1122 ret->has_nonpic_branches = FALSE;
1123 ret->needs_lazy_stub = FALSE;
1124 }
1125
1126 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
1127 }
1128
1129 /* Allocate MIPS ELF private object data. */
1130
1131 bfd_boolean
1132 _bfd_mips_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1133 {
1134 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_obj_tdata),
1135 MIPS_ELF_DATA);
1136 }
1137
1138 bfd_boolean
1139 _bfd_mips_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1140 {
1141 if (!sec->used_by_bfd)
1142 {
1143 struct _mips_elf_section_data *sdata;
1144 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*sdata);
1145
1146 sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
1147 if (sdata == NULL)
1148 return FALSE;
1149 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
1150 }
1151
1152 return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
1153 }
1154 \f
1155 /* Read ECOFF debugging information from a .mdebug section into a
1156 ecoff_debug_info structure. */
1157
1158 bfd_boolean
1159 _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
1160 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
1161 {
1162 HDRR *symhdr;
1163 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
1164 char *ext_hdr;
1165
1166 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
1167 memset (debug, 0, sizeof (*debug));
1168
1169 ext_hdr = bfd_malloc (swap->external_hdr_size);
1170 if (ext_hdr == NULL && swap->external_hdr_size != 0)
1171 goto error_return;
1172
1173 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, section, ext_hdr, 0,
1174 swap->external_hdr_size))
1175 goto error_return;
1176
1177 symhdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
1178 (*swap->swap_hdr_in) (abfd, ext_hdr, symhdr);
1179
1180 /* The symbolic header contains absolute file offsets and sizes to
1181 read. */
1182 #define READ(ptr, offset, count, size, type) \
1183 if (symhdr->count == 0) \
1184 debug->ptr = NULL; \
1185 else \
1186 { \
1187 bfd_size_type amt = (bfd_size_type) size * symhdr->count; \
1188 debug->ptr = bfd_malloc (amt); \
1189 if (debug->ptr == NULL) \
1190 goto error_return; \
1191 if (bfd_seek (abfd, symhdr->offset, SEEK_SET) != 0 \
1192 || bfd_bread (debug->ptr, amt, abfd) != amt) \
1193 goto error_return; \
1194 }
1195
1196 READ (line, cbLineOffset, cbLine, sizeof (unsigned char), unsigned char *);
1197 READ (external_dnr, cbDnOffset, idnMax, swap->external_dnr_size, void *);
1198 READ (external_pdr, cbPdOffset, ipdMax, swap->external_pdr_size, void *);
1199 READ (external_sym, cbSymOffset, isymMax, swap->external_sym_size, void *);
1200 READ (external_opt, cbOptOffset, ioptMax, swap->external_opt_size, void *);
1201 READ (external_aux, cbAuxOffset, iauxMax, sizeof (union aux_ext),
1202 union aux_ext *);
1203 READ (ss, cbSsOffset, issMax, sizeof (char), char *);
1204 READ (ssext, cbSsExtOffset, issExtMax, sizeof (char), char *);
1205 READ (external_fdr, cbFdOffset, ifdMax, swap->external_fdr_size, void *);
1206 READ (external_rfd, cbRfdOffset, crfd, swap->external_rfd_size, void *);
1207 READ (external_ext, cbExtOffset, iextMax, swap->external_ext_size, void *);
1208 #undef READ
1209
1210 debug->fdr = NULL;
1211
1212 return TRUE;
1213
1214 error_return:
1215 if (ext_hdr != NULL)
1216 free (ext_hdr);
1217 if (debug->line != NULL)
1218 free (debug->line);
1219 if (debug->external_dnr != NULL)
1220 free (debug->external_dnr);
1221 if (debug->external_pdr != NULL)
1222 free (debug->external_pdr);
1223 if (debug->external_sym != NULL)
1224 free (debug->external_sym);
1225 if (debug->external_opt != NULL)
1226 free (debug->external_opt);
1227 if (debug->external_aux != NULL)
1228 free (debug->external_aux);
1229 if (debug->ss != NULL)
1230 free (debug->ss);
1231 if (debug->ssext != NULL)
1232 free (debug->ssext);
1233 if (debug->external_fdr != NULL)
1234 free (debug->external_fdr);
1235 if (debug->external_rfd != NULL)
1236 free (debug->external_rfd);
1237 if (debug->external_ext != NULL)
1238 free (debug->external_ext);
1239 return FALSE;
1240 }
1241 \f
1242 /* Swap RPDR (runtime procedure table entry) for output. */
1243
1244 static void
1245 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (bfd *abfd, const RPDR *in, struct rpdr_ext *ex)
1246 {
1247 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, in->adr, ex->p_adr);
1248 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regmask, ex->p_regmask);
1249 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regoffset, ex->p_regoffset);
1250 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregmask, ex->p_fregmask);
1251 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregoffset, ex->p_fregoffset);
1252 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->frameoffset, ex->p_frameoffset);
1253
1254 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->framereg, ex->p_framereg);
1255 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->pcreg, ex->p_pcreg);
1256
1257 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->irpss, ex->p_irpss);
1258 }
1259
1260 /* Create a runtime procedure table from the .mdebug section. */
1261
1262 static bfd_boolean
1263 mips_elf_create_procedure_table (void *handle, bfd *abfd,
1264 struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *s,
1265 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
1266 {
1267 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
1268 HDRR *hdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
1269 RPDR *rpdr, *rp;
1270 struct rpdr_ext *erp;
1271 void *rtproc;
1272 struct pdr_ext *epdr;
1273 struct sym_ext *esym;
1274 char *ss, **sv;
1275 char *str;
1276 bfd_size_type size;
1277 bfd_size_type count;
1278 unsigned long sindex;
1279 unsigned long i;
1280 PDR pdr;
1281 SYMR sym;
1282 const char *no_name_func = _("static procedure (no name)");
1283
1284 epdr = NULL;
1285 rpdr = NULL;
1286 esym = NULL;
1287 ss = NULL;
1288 sv = NULL;
1289
1290 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
1291
1292 sindex = strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
1293 count = hdr->ipdMax;
1294 if (count > 0)
1295 {
1296 size = swap->external_pdr_size;
1297
1298 epdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1299 if (epdr == NULL)
1300 goto error_return;
1301
1302 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_pdr (handle, (bfd_byte *) epdr))
1303 goto error_return;
1304
1305 size = sizeof (RPDR);
1306 rp = rpdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1307 if (rpdr == NULL)
1308 goto error_return;
1309
1310 size = sizeof (char *);
1311 sv = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1312 if (sv == NULL)
1313 goto error_return;
1314
1315 count = hdr->isymMax;
1316 size = swap->external_sym_size;
1317 esym = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1318 if (esym == NULL)
1319 goto error_return;
1320
1321 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_sym (handle, (bfd_byte *) esym))
1322 goto error_return;
1323
1324 count = hdr->issMax;
1325 ss = bfd_malloc (count);
1326 if (ss == NULL)
1327 goto error_return;
1328 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_ss (handle, (bfd_byte *) ss))
1329 goto error_return;
1330
1331 count = hdr->ipdMax;
1332 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned long) count; i++, rp++)
1333 {
1334 (*swap->swap_pdr_in) (abfd, epdr + i, &pdr);
1335 (*swap->swap_sym_in) (abfd, &esym[pdr.isym], &sym);
1336 rp->adr = sym.value;
1337 rp->regmask = pdr.regmask;
1338 rp->regoffset = pdr.regoffset;
1339 rp->fregmask = pdr.fregmask;
1340 rp->fregoffset = pdr.fregoffset;
1341 rp->frameoffset = pdr.frameoffset;
1342 rp->framereg = pdr.framereg;
1343 rp->pcreg = pdr.pcreg;
1344 rp->irpss = sindex;
1345 sv[i] = ss + sym.iss;
1346 sindex += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
1347 }
1348 }
1349
1350 size = sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2) + sindex;
1351 size = BFD_ALIGN (size, 16);
1352 rtproc = bfd_alloc (abfd, size);
1353 if (rtproc == NULL)
1354 {
1355 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = 0;
1356 goto error_return;
1357 }
1358
1359 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = count + 2;
1360
1361 erp = rtproc;
1362 memset (erp, 0, sizeof (struct rpdr_ext));
1363 erp++;
1364 str = (char *) rtproc + sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2);
1365 strcpy (str, no_name_func);
1366 str += strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
1367 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1368 {
1369 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (abfd, rpdr + i, erp + i);
1370 strcpy (str, sv[i]);
1371 str += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
1372 }
1373 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, -1, (erp + count)->p_adr);
1374
1375 /* Set the size and contents of .rtproc section. */
1376 s->size = size;
1377 s->contents = rtproc;
1378
1379 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
1380 matters, but someday it might). */
1381 s->map_head.link_order = NULL;
1382
1383 if (epdr != NULL)
1384 free (epdr);
1385 if (rpdr != NULL)
1386 free (rpdr);
1387 if (esym != NULL)
1388 free (esym);
1389 if (ss != NULL)
1390 free (ss);
1391 if (sv != NULL)
1392 free (sv);
1393
1394 return TRUE;
1395
1396 error_return:
1397 if (epdr != NULL)
1398 free (epdr);
1399 if (rpdr != NULL)
1400 free (rpdr);
1401 if (esym != NULL)
1402 free (esym);
1403 if (ss != NULL)
1404 free (ss);
1405 if (sv != NULL)
1406 free (sv);
1407 return FALSE;
1408 }
1409 \f
1410 /* We're going to create a stub for H. Create a symbol for the stub's
1411 value and size, to help make the disassembly easier to read. */
1412
1413 static bfd_boolean
1414 mips_elf_create_stub_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1415 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1416 const char *prefix, asection *s, bfd_vma value,
1417 bfd_vma size)
1418 {
1419 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
1420 struct elf_link_hash_entry *elfh;
1421 const char *name;
1422
1423 if (ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (h->root.other))
1424 value |= 1;
1425
1426 /* Create a new symbol. */
1427 name = ACONCAT ((prefix, h->root.root.root.string, NULL));
1428 bh = NULL;
1429 if (!_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (info, s->owner, name,
1430 BSF_LOCAL, s, value, NULL,
1431 TRUE, FALSE, &bh))
1432 return FALSE;
1433
1434 /* Make it a local function. */
1435 elfh = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
1436 elfh->type = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FUNC);
1437 elfh->size = size;
1438 elfh->forced_local = 1;
1439 return TRUE;
1440 }
1441
1442 /* We're about to redefine H. Create a symbol to represent H's
1443 current value and size, to help make the disassembly easier
1444 to read. */
1445
1446 static bfd_boolean
1447 mips_elf_create_shadow_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1448 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1449 const char *prefix)
1450 {
1451 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
1452 struct elf_link_hash_entry *elfh;
1453 const char *name;
1454 asection *s;
1455 bfd_vma value;
1456
1457 /* Read the symbol's value. */
1458 BFD_ASSERT (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
1459 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
1460 s = h->root.root.u.def.section;
1461 value = h->root.root.u.def.value;
1462
1463 /* Create a new symbol. */
1464 name = ACONCAT ((prefix, h->root.root.root.string, NULL));
1465 bh = NULL;
1466 if (!_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (info, s->owner, name,
1467 BSF_LOCAL, s, value, NULL,
1468 TRUE, FALSE, &bh))
1469 return FALSE;
1470
1471 /* Make it local and copy the other attributes from H. */
1472 elfh = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
1473 elfh->type = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, ELF_ST_TYPE (h->root.type));
1474 elfh->other = h->root.other;
1475 elfh->size = h->root.size;
1476 elfh->forced_local = 1;
1477 return TRUE;
1478 }
1479
1480 /* Return TRUE if relocations in SECTION can refer directly to a MIPS16
1481 function rather than to a hard-float stub. */
1482
1483 static bfd_boolean
1484 section_allows_mips16_refs_p (asection *section)
1485 {
1486 const char *name;
1487
1488 name = bfd_get_section_name (section->owner, section);
1489 return (FN_STUB_P (name)
1490 || CALL_STUB_P (name)
1491 || CALL_FP_STUB_P (name)
1492 || strcmp (name, ".pdr") == 0);
1493 }
1494
1495 /* [RELOCS, RELEND) are the relocations against SEC, which is a MIPS16
1496 stub section of some kind. Return the R_SYMNDX of the target
1497 function, or 0 if we can't decide which function that is. */
1498
1499 static unsigned long
1500 mips16_stub_symndx (const struct elf_backend_data *bed,
1501 asection *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1502 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
1503 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend)
1504 {
1505 int int_rels_per_ext_rel = bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
1506 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
1507
1508 /* Trust the first R_MIPS_NONE relocation, if any, but not a subsequent
1509 one in a compound relocation. */
1510 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; rel += int_rels_per_ext_rel)
1511 if (ELF_R_TYPE (sec->owner, rel->r_info) == R_MIPS_NONE)
1512 return ELF_R_SYM (sec->owner, rel->r_info);
1513
1514 /* Otherwise trust the first relocation, whatever its kind. This is
1515 the traditional behavior. */
1516 if (relocs < relend)
1517 return ELF_R_SYM (sec->owner, relocs->r_info);
1518
1519 return 0;
1520 }
1521
1522 /* Check the mips16 stubs for a particular symbol, and see if we can
1523 discard them. */
1524
1525 static void
1526 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1527 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h)
1528 {
1529 /* Dynamic symbols must use the standard call interface, in case other
1530 objects try to call them. */
1531 if (h->fn_stub != NULL
1532 && h->root.dynindx != -1)
1533 {
1534 mips_elf_create_shadow_symbol (info, h, ".mips16.");
1535 h->need_fn_stub = TRUE;
1536 }
1537
1538 if (h->fn_stub != NULL
1539 && ! h->need_fn_stub)
1540 {
1541 /* We don't need the fn_stub; the only references to this symbol
1542 are 16 bit calls. Clobber the size to 0 to prevent it from
1543 being included in the link. */
1544 h->fn_stub->size = 0;
1545 h->fn_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1546 h->fn_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1547 h->fn_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1548 }
1549
1550 if (h->call_stub != NULL
1551 && ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->root.other))
1552 {
1553 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1554 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
1555 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
1556 h->call_stub->size = 0;
1557 h->call_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1558 h->call_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1559 h->call_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1560 }
1561
1562 if (h->call_fp_stub != NULL
1563 && ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->root.other))
1564 {
1565 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1566 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
1567 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
1568 h->call_fp_stub->size = 0;
1569 h->call_fp_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1570 h->call_fp_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1571 h->call_fp_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1572 }
1573 }
1574
1575 /* Hashtable callbacks for mips_elf_la25_stubs. */
1576
1577 static hashval_t
1578 mips_elf_la25_stub_hash (const void *entry_)
1579 {
1580 const struct mips_elf_la25_stub *entry;
1581
1582 entry = (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *) entry_;
1583 return entry->h->root.root.u.def.section->id
1584 + entry->h->root.root.u.def.value;
1585 }
1586
1587 static int
1588 mips_elf_la25_stub_eq (const void *entry1_, const void *entry2_)
1589 {
1590 const struct mips_elf_la25_stub *entry1, *entry2;
1591
1592 entry1 = (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *) entry1_;
1593 entry2 = (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *) entry2_;
1594 return ((entry1->h->root.root.u.def.section
1595 == entry2->h->root.root.u.def.section)
1596 && (entry1->h->root.root.u.def.value
1597 == entry2->h->root.root.u.def.value));
1598 }
1599
1600 /* Called by the linker to set up the la25 stub-creation code. FN is
1601 the linker's implementation of add_stub_function. Return true on
1602 success. */
1603
1604 bfd_boolean
1605 _bfd_mips_elf_init_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1606 asection *(*fn) (const char *, asection *,
1607 asection *))
1608 {
1609 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
1610
1611 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
1612 if (htab == NULL)
1613 return FALSE;
1614
1615 htab->add_stub_section = fn;
1616 htab->la25_stubs = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_la25_stub_hash,
1617 mips_elf_la25_stub_eq, NULL);
1618 if (htab->la25_stubs == NULL)
1619 return FALSE;
1620
1621 return TRUE;
1622 }
1623
1624 /* Return true if H is a locally-defined PIC function, in the sense
1625 that it or its fn_stub might need $25 to be valid on entry.
1626 Note that MIPS16 functions set up $gp using PC-relative instructions,
1627 so they themselves never need $25 to be valid. Only non-MIPS16
1628 entry points are of interest here. */
1629
1630 static bfd_boolean
1631 mips_elf_local_pic_function_p (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h)
1632 {
1633 return ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
1634 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
1635 && h->root.def_regular
1636 && !bfd_is_abs_section (h->root.root.u.def.section)
1637 && (!ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->root.other)
1638 || (h->fn_stub && h->need_fn_stub))
1639 && (PIC_OBJECT_P (h->root.root.u.def.section->owner)
1640 || ELF_ST_IS_MIPS_PIC (h->root.other)));
1641 }
1642
1643 /* Set *SEC to the input section that contains the target of STUB.
1644 Return the offset of the target from the start of that section. */
1645
1646 static bfd_vma
1647 mips_elf_get_la25_target (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *stub,
1648 asection **sec)
1649 {
1650 if (ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (stub->h->root.other))
1651 {
1652 BFD_ASSERT (stub->h->need_fn_stub);
1653 *sec = stub->h->fn_stub;
1654 return 0;
1655 }
1656 else
1657 {
1658 *sec = stub->h->root.root.u.def.section;
1659 return stub->h->root.root.u.def.value;
1660 }
1661 }
1662
1663 /* STUB describes an la25 stub that we have decided to implement
1664 by inserting an LUI/ADDIU pair before the target function.
1665 Create the section and redirect the function symbol to it. */
1666
1667 static bfd_boolean
1668 mips_elf_add_la25_intro (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *stub,
1669 struct bfd_link_info *info)
1670 {
1671 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
1672 char *name;
1673 asection *s, *input_section;
1674 unsigned int align;
1675
1676 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
1677 if (htab == NULL)
1678 return FALSE;
1679
1680 /* Create a unique name for the new section. */
1681 name = bfd_malloc (11 + sizeof (".text.stub."));
1682 if (name == NULL)
1683 return FALSE;
1684 sprintf (name, ".text.stub.%d", (int) htab_elements (htab->la25_stubs));
1685
1686 /* Create the section. */
1687 mips_elf_get_la25_target (stub, &input_section);
1688 s = htab->add_stub_section (name, input_section,
1689 input_section->output_section);
1690 if (s == NULL)
1691 return FALSE;
1692
1693 /* Make sure that any padding goes before the stub. */
1694 align = input_section->alignment_power;
1695 if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (s->owner, s, align))
1696 return FALSE;
1697 if (align > 3)
1698 s->size = (1 << align) - 8;
1699
1700 /* Create a symbol for the stub. */
1701 mips_elf_create_stub_symbol (info, stub->h, ".pic.", s, s->size, 8);
1702 stub->stub_section = s;
1703 stub->offset = s->size;
1704
1705 /* Allocate room for it. */
1706 s->size += 8;
1707 return TRUE;
1708 }
1709
1710 /* STUB describes an la25 stub that we have decided to implement
1711 with a separate trampoline. Allocate room for it and redirect
1712 the function symbol to it. */
1713
1714 static bfd_boolean
1715 mips_elf_add_la25_trampoline (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *stub,
1716 struct bfd_link_info *info)
1717 {
1718 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
1719 asection *s;
1720
1721 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
1722 if (htab == NULL)
1723 return FALSE;
1724
1725 /* Create a trampoline section, if we haven't already. */
1726 s = htab->strampoline;
1727 if (s == NULL)
1728 {
1729 asection *input_section = stub->h->root.root.u.def.section;
1730 s = htab->add_stub_section (".text", NULL,
1731 input_section->output_section);
1732 if (s == NULL || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s->owner, s, 4))
1733 return FALSE;
1734 htab->strampoline = s;
1735 }
1736
1737 /* Create a symbol for the stub. */
1738 mips_elf_create_stub_symbol (info, stub->h, ".pic.", s, s->size, 16);
1739 stub->stub_section = s;
1740 stub->offset = s->size;
1741
1742 /* Allocate room for it. */
1743 s->size += 16;
1744 return TRUE;
1745 }
1746
1747 /* H describes a symbol that needs an la25 stub. Make sure that an
1748 appropriate stub exists and point H at it. */
1749
1750 static bfd_boolean
1751 mips_elf_add_la25_stub (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1752 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h)
1753 {
1754 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
1755 struct mips_elf_la25_stub search, *stub;
1756 bfd_boolean use_trampoline_p;
1757 asection *s;
1758 bfd_vma value;
1759 void **slot;
1760
1761 /* Describe the stub we want. */
1762 search.stub_section = NULL;
1763 search.offset = 0;
1764 search.h = h;
1765
1766 /* See if we've already created an equivalent stub. */
1767 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
1768 if (htab == NULL)
1769 return FALSE;
1770
1771 slot = htab_find_slot (htab->la25_stubs, &search, INSERT);
1772 if (slot == NULL)
1773 return FALSE;
1774
1775 stub = (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *) *slot;
1776 if (stub != NULL)
1777 {
1778 /* We can reuse the existing stub. */
1779 h->la25_stub = stub;
1780 return TRUE;
1781 }
1782
1783 /* Create a permanent copy of ENTRY and add it to the hash table. */
1784 stub = bfd_malloc (sizeof (search));
1785 if (stub == NULL)
1786 return FALSE;
1787 *stub = search;
1788 *slot = stub;
1789
1790 /* Prefer to use LUI/ADDIU stubs if the function is at the beginning
1791 of the section and if we would need no more than 2 nops. */
1792 value = mips_elf_get_la25_target (stub, &s);
1793 use_trampoline_p = (value != 0 || s->alignment_power > 4);
1794
1795 h->la25_stub = stub;
1796 return (use_trampoline_p
1797 ? mips_elf_add_la25_trampoline (stub, info)
1798 : mips_elf_add_la25_intro (stub, info));
1799 }
1800
1801 /* A mips_elf_link_hash_traverse callback that is called before sizing
1802 sections. DATA points to a mips_htab_traverse_info structure. */
1803
1804 static bfd_boolean
1805 mips_elf_check_symbols (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
1806 {
1807 struct mips_htab_traverse_info *hti;
1808
1809 hti = (struct mips_htab_traverse_info *) data;
1810 if (!hti->info->relocatable)
1811 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs (hti->info, h);
1812
1813 if (mips_elf_local_pic_function_p (h))
1814 {
1815 /* PR 12845: If H is in a section that has been garbage
1816 collected it will have its output section set to *ABS*. */
1817 if (bfd_is_abs_section (h->root.root.u.def.section->output_section))
1818 return TRUE;
1819
1820 /* H is a function that might need $25 to be valid on entry.
1821 If we're creating a non-PIC relocatable object, mark H as
1822 being PIC. If we're creating a non-relocatable object with
1823 non-PIC branches and jumps to H, make sure that H has an la25
1824 stub. */
1825 if (hti->info->relocatable)
1826 {
1827 if (!PIC_OBJECT_P (hti->output_bfd))
1828 h->root.other = ELF_ST_SET_MIPS_PIC (h->root.other);
1829 }
1830 else if (h->has_nonpic_branches && !mips_elf_add_la25_stub (hti->info, h))
1831 {
1832 hti->error = TRUE;
1833 return FALSE;
1834 }
1835 }
1836 return TRUE;
1837 }
1838 \f
1839 /* R_MIPS16_26 is used for the mips16 jal and jalx instructions.
1840 Most mips16 instructions are 16 bits, but these instructions
1841 are 32 bits.
1842
1843 The format of these instructions is:
1844
1845 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1846 | JALX | X| Imm 20:16 | Imm 25:21 |
1847 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1848 | Immediate 15:0 |
1849 +-----------------------------------------------+
1850
1851 JALX is the 5-bit value 00011. X is 0 for jal, 1 for jalx.
1852 Note that the immediate value in the first word is swapped.
1853
1854 When producing a relocatable object file, R_MIPS16_26 is
1855 handled mostly like R_MIPS_26. In particular, the addend is
1856 stored as a straight 26-bit value in a 32-bit instruction.
1857 (gas makes life simpler for itself by never adjusting a
1858 R_MIPS16_26 reloc to be against a section, so the addend is
1859 always zero). However, the 32 bit instruction is stored as 2
1860 16-bit values, rather than a single 32-bit value. In a
1861 big-endian file, the result is the same; in a little-endian
1862 file, the two 16-bit halves of the 32 bit value are swapped.
1863 This is so that a disassembler can recognize the jal
1864 instruction.
1865
1866 When doing a final link, R_MIPS16_26 is treated as a 32 bit
1867 instruction stored as two 16-bit values. The addend A is the
1868 contents of the targ26 field. The calculation is the same as
1869 R_MIPS_26. When storing the calculated value, reorder the
1870 immediate value as shown above, and don't forget to store the
1871 value as two 16-bit values.
1872
1873 To put it in MIPS ABI terms, the relocation field is T-targ26-16,
1874 defined as
1875
1876 big-endian:
1877 +--------+----------------------+
1878 | | |
1879 | | targ26-16 |
1880 |31 26|25 0|
1881 +--------+----------------------+
1882
1883 little-endian:
1884 +----------+------+-------------+
1885 | | | |
1886 | sub1 | | sub2 |
1887 |0 9|10 15|16 31|
1888 +----------+--------------------+
1889 where targ26-16 is sub1 followed by sub2 (i.e., the addend field A is
1890 ((sub1 << 16) | sub2)).
1891
1892 When producing a relocatable object file, the calculation is
1893 (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
1894 When producing a fully linked file, the calculation is
1895 let R = (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
1896 ((R & 0x1f0000) << 5) | ((R & 0x3e00000) >> 5) | (R & 0xffff)
1897
1898 The table below lists the other MIPS16 instruction relocations.
1899 Each one is calculated in the same way as the non-MIPS16 relocation
1900 given on the right, but using the extended MIPS16 layout of 16-bit
1901 immediate fields:
1902
1903 R_MIPS16_GPREL R_MIPS_GPREL16
1904 R_MIPS16_GOT16 R_MIPS_GOT16
1905 R_MIPS16_CALL16 R_MIPS_CALL16
1906 R_MIPS16_HI16 R_MIPS_HI16
1907 R_MIPS16_LO16 R_MIPS_LO16
1908
1909 A typical instruction will have a format like this:
1910
1911 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1912 | EXTEND | Imm 10:5 | Imm 15:11 |
1913 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1914 | Major | rx | ry | Imm 4:0 |
1915 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1916
1917 EXTEND is the five bit value 11110. Major is the instruction
1918 opcode.
1919
1920 All we need to do here is shuffle the bits appropriately.
1921 As above, the two 16-bit halves must be swapped on a
1922 little-endian system. */
1923
1924 static inline bfd_boolean
1925 mips16_reloc_p (int r_type)
1926 {
1927 switch (r_type)
1928 {
1929 case R_MIPS16_26:
1930 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
1931 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
1932 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
1933 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
1934 case R_MIPS16_LO16:
1935 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
1936 case R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
1937 case R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
1938 case R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
1939 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
1940 case R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
1941 case R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
1942 return TRUE;
1943
1944 default:
1945 return FALSE;
1946 }
1947 }
1948
1949 /* Check if a microMIPS reloc. */
1950
1951 static inline bfd_boolean
1952 micromips_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
1953 {
1954 return r_type >= R_MICROMIPS_min && r_type < R_MICROMIPS_max;
1955 }
1956
1957 /* Similar to MIPS16, the two 16-bit halves in microMIPS must be swapped
1958 on a little-endian system. This does not apply to R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1
1959 and R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1 relocs that apply to 16-bit instructions. */
1960
1961 static inline bfd_boolean
1962 micromips_reloc_shuffle_p (unsigned int r_type)
1963 {
1964 return (micromips_reloc_p (r_type)
1965 && r_type != R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1
1966 && r_type != R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1);
1967 }
1968
1969 static inline bfd_boolean
1970 got16_reloc_p (int r_type)
1971 {
1972 return (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16
1973 || r_type == R_MIPS16_GOT16
1974 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_GOT16);
1975 }
1976
1977 static inline bfd_boolean
1978 call16_reloc_p (int r_type)
1979 {
1980 return (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL16
1981 || r_type == R_MIPS16_CALL16
1982 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_CALL16);
1983 }
1984
1985 static inline bfd_boolean
1986 got_disp_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
1987 {
1988 return r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_DISP || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP;
1989 }
1990
1991 static inline bfd_boolean
1992 got_page_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
1993 {
1994 return r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE;
1995 }
1996
1997 static inline bfd_boolean
1998 got_ofst_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
1999 {
2000 return r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_OFST || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_GOT_OFST;
2001 }
2002
2003 static inline bfd_boolean
2004 got_hi16_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2005 {
2006 return r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_HI16 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16;
2007 }
2008
2009 static inline bfd_boolean
2010 got_lo16_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2011 {
2012 return r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_LO16 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16;
2013 }
2014
2015 static inline bfd_boolean
2016 call_hi16_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2017 {
2018 return r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_HI16 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16;
2019 }
2020
2021 static inline bfd_boolean
2022 call_lo16_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2023 {
2024 return r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_LO16 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16;
2025 }
2026
2027 static inline bfd_boolean
2028 hi16_reloc_p (int r_type)
2029 {
2030 return (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16
2031 || r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16
2032 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_HI16);
2033 }
2034
2035 static inline bfd_boolean
2036 lo16_reloc_p (int r_type)
2037 {
2038 return (r_type == R_MIPS_LO16
2039 || r_type == R_MIPS16_LO16
2040 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_LO16);
2041 }
2042
2043 static inline bfd_boolean
2044 mips16_call_reloc_p (int r_type)
2045 {
2046 return r_type == R_MIPS16_26 || r_type == R_MIPS16_CALL16;
2047 }
2048
2049 static inline bfd_boolean
2050 jal_reloc_p (int r_type)
2051 {
2052 return (r_type == R_MIPS_26
2053 || r_type == R_MIPS16_26
2054 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_26_S1);
2055 }
2056
2057 static inline bfd_boolean
2058 micromips_branch_reloc_p (int r_type)
2059 {
2060 return (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_26_S1
2061 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1
2062 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1
2063 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1);
2064 }
2065
2066 static inline bfd_boolean
2067 tls_gd_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2068 {
2069 return (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD
2070 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_GD
2071 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD);
2072 }
2073
2074 static inline bfd_boolean
2075 tls_ldm_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2076 {
2077 return (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM
2078 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM
2079 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM);
2080 }
2081
2082 static inline bfd_boolean
2083 tls_gottprel_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2084 {
2085 return (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL
2086 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL
2087 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL);
2088 }
2089
2090 void
2091 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_unshuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
2092 bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
2093 {
2094 bfd_vma first, second, val;
2095
2096 if (!mips16_reloc_p (r_type) && !micromips_reloc_shuffle_p (r_type))
2097 return;
2098
2099 /* Pick up the first and second halfwords of the instruction. */
2100 first = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data);
2101 second = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data + 2);
2102 if (micromips_reloc_p (r_type) || (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !jal_shuffle))
2103 val = first << 16 | second;
2104 else if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26)
2105 val = (((first & 0xf800) << 16) | ((second & 0xffe0) << 11)
2106 | ((first & 0x1f) << 11) | (first & 0x7e0) | (second & 0x1f));
2107 else
2108 val = (((first & 0xfc00) << 16) | ((first & 0x3e0) << 11)
2109 | ((first & 0x1f) << 21) | second);
2110 bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, data);
2111 }
2112
2113 void
2114 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_shuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
2115 bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
2116 {
2117 bfd_vma first, second, val;
2118
2119 if (!mips16_reloc_p (r_type) && !micromips_reloc_shuffle_p (r_type))
2120 return;
2121
2122 val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, data);
2123 if (micromips_reloc_p (r_type) || (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !jal_shuffle))
2124 {
2125 second = val & 0xffff;
2126 first = val >> 16;
2127 }
2128 else if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26)
2129 {
2130 second = ((val >> 11) & 0xffe0) | (val & 0x1f);
2131 first = ((val >> 16) & 0xf800) | ((val >> 11) & 0x1f) | (val & 0x7e0);
2132 }
2133 else
2134 {
2135 second = val & 0xffff;
2136 first = ((val >> 16) & 0xfc00) | ((val >> 11) & 0x3e0)
2137 | ((val >> 21) & 0x1f);
2138 }
2139 bfd_put_16 (abfd, second, data + 2);
2140 bfd_put_16 (abfd, first, data);
2141 }
2142
2143 bfd_reloc_status_type
2144 _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
2145 arelent *reloc_entry, asection *input_section,
2146 bfd_boolean relocatable, void *data, bfd_vma gp)
2147 {
2148 bfd_vma relocation;
2149 bfd_signed_vma val;
2150 bfd_reloc_status_type status;
2151
2152 if (bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
2153 relocation = 0;
2154 else
2155 relocation = symbol->value;
2156
2157 relocation += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
2158 relocation += symbol->section->output_offset;
2159
2160 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
2161 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2162
2163 /* Set val to the offset into the section or symbol. */
2164 val = reloc_entry->addend;
2165
2166 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (val, 16);
2167
2168 /* Adjust val for the final section location and GP value. If we
2169 are producing relocatable output, we don't want to do this for
2170 an external symbol. */
2171 if (! relocatable
2172 || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
2173 val += relocation - gp;
2174
2175 if (reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
2176 {
2177 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
2178 (bfd_byte *) data
2179 + reloc_entry->address);
2180 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
2181 return status;
2182 }
2183 else
2184 reloc_entry->addend = val;
2185
2186 if (relocatable)
2187 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
2188
2189 return bfd_reloc_ok;
2190 }
2191
2192 /* Used to store a REL high-part relocation such as R_MIPS_HI16 or
2193 R_MIPS_GOT16. REL is the relocation, INPUT_SECTION is the section
2194 that contains the relocation field and DATA points to the start of
2195 INPUT_SECTION. */
2196
2197 struct mips_hi16
2198 {
2199 struct mips_hi16 *next;
2200 bfd_byte *data;
2201 asection *input_section;
2202 arelent rel;
2203 };
2204
2205 /* FIXME: This should not be a static variable. */
2206
2207 static struct mips_hi16 *mips_hi16_list;
2208
2209 /* A howto special_function for REL *HI16 relocations. We can only
2210 calculate the correct value once we've seen the partnering
2211 *LO16 relocation, so just save the information for later.
2212
2213 The ABI requires that the *LO16 immediately follow the *HI16.
2214 However, as a GNU extension, we permit an arbitrary number of
2215 *HI16s to be associated with a single *LO16. This significantly
2216 simplies the relocation handling in gcc. */
2217
2218 bfd_reloc_status_type
2219 _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
2220 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data,
2221 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
2222 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2223 {
2224 struct mips_hi16 *n;
2225
2226 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
2227 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2228
2229 n = bfd_malloc (sizeof *n);
2230 if (n == NULL)
2231 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2232
2233 n->next = mips_hi16_list;
2234 n->data = data;
2235 n->input_section = input_section;
2236 n->rel = *reloc_entry;
2237 mips_hi16_list = n;
2238
2239 if (output_bfd != NULL)
2240 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
2241
2242 return bfd_reloc_ok;
2243 }
2244
2245 /* A howto special_function for REL R_MIPS*_GOT16 relocations. This is just
2246 like any other 16-bit relocation when applied to global symbols, but is
2247 treated in the same as R_MIPS_HI16 when applied to local symbols. */
2248
2249 bfd_reloc_status_type
2250 _bfd_mips_elf_got16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
2251 void *data, asection *input_section,
2252 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
2253 {
2254 if ((symbol->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK)) != 0
2255 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (symbol))
2256 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (symbol)))
2257 /* The relocation is against a global symbol. */
2258 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
2259 input_section, output_bfd,
2260 error_message);
2261
2262 return _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
2263 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
2264 }
2265
2266 /* A howto special_function for REL *LO16 relocations. The *LO16 itself
2267 is a straightforward 16 bit inplace relocation, but we must deal with
2268 any partnering high-part relocations as well. */
2269
2270 bfd_reloc_status_type
2271 _bfd_mips_elf_lo16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
2272 void *data, asection *input_section,
2273 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
2274 {
2275 bfd_vma vallo;
2276 bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
2277
2278 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
2279 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2280
2281 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
2282 location);
2283 vallo = bfd_get_32 (abfd, location);
2284 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
2285 location);
2286
2287 while (mips_hi16_list != NULL)
2288 {
2289 bfd_reloc_status_type ret;
2290 struct mips_hi16 *hi;
2291
2292 hi = mips_hi16_list;
2293
2294 /* R_MIPS*_GOT16 relocations are something of a special case. We
2295 want to install the addend in the same way as for a R_MIPS*_HI16
2296 relocation (with a rightshift of 16). However, since GOT16
2297 relocations can also be used with global symbols, their howto
2298 has a rightshift of 0. */
2299 if (hi->rel.howto->type == R_MIPS_GOT16)
2300 hi->rel.howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, R_MIPS_HI16, FALSE);
2301 else if (hi->rel.howto->type == R_MIPS16_GOT16)
2302 hi->rel.howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, R_MIPS16_HI16, FALSE);
2303 else if (hi->rel.howto->type == R_MICROMIPS_GOT16)
2304 hi->rel.howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, R_MICROMIPS_HI16, FALSE);
2305
2306 /* VALLO is a signed 16-bit number. Bias it by 0x8000 so that any
2307 carry or borrow will induce a change of +1 or -1 in the high part. */
2308 hi->rel.addend += (vallo + 0x8000) & 0xffff;
2309
2310 ret = _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, &hi->rel, symbol, hi->data,
2311 hi->input_section, output_bfd,
2312 error_message);
2313 if (ret != bfd_reloc_ok)
2314 return ret;
2315
2316 mips_hi16_list = hi->next;
2317 free (hi);
2318 }
2319
2320 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
2321 input_section, output_bfd,
2322 error_message);
2323 }
2324
2325 /* A generic howto special_function. This calculates and installs the
2326 relocation itself, thus avoiding the oft-discussed problems in
2327 bfd_perform_relocation and bfd_install_relocation. */
2328
2329 bfd_reloc_status_type
2330 _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
2331 asymbol *symbol, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2332 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
2333 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2334 {
2335 bfd_signed_vma val;
2336 bfd_reloc_status_type status;
2337 bfd_boolean relocatable;
2338
2339 relocatable = (output_bfd != NULL);
2340
2341 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
2342 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2343
2344 /* Build up the field adjustment in VAL. */
2345 val = 0;
2346 if (!relocatable || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
2347 {
2348 /* Either we're calculating the final field value or we have a
2349 relocation against a section symbol. Add in the section's
2350 offset or address. */
2351 val += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
2352 val += symbol->section->output_offset;
2353 }
2354
2355 if (!relocatable)
2356 {
2357 /* We're calculating the final field value. Add in the symbol's value
2358 and, if pc-relative, subtract the address of the field itself. */
2359 val += symbol->value;
2360 if (reloc_entry->howto->pc_relative)
2361 {
2362 val -= input_section->output_section->vma;
2363 val -= input_section->output_offset;
2364 val -= reloc_entry->address;
2365 }
2366 }
2367
2368 /* VAL is now the final adjustment. If we're keeping this relocation
2369 in the output file, and if the relocation uses a separate addend,
2370 we just need to add VAL to that addend. Otherwise we need to add
2371 VAL to the relocation field itself. */
2372 if (relocatable && !reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
2373 reloc_entry->addend += val;
2374 else
2375 {
2376 bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
2377
2378 /* Add in the separate addend, if any. */
2379 val += reloc_entry->addend;
2380
2381 /* Add VAL to the relocation field. */
2382 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
2383 location);
2384 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
2385 location);
2386 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
2387 location);
2388
2389 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
2390 return status;
2391 }
2392
2393 if (relocatable)
2394 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
2395
2396 return bfd_reloc_ok;
2397 }
2398 \f
2399 /* Swap an entry in a .gptab section. Note that these routines rely
2400 on the equivalence of the two elements of the union. */
2401
2402 static void
2403 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_gptab *ex,
2404 Elf32_gptab *in)
2405 {
2406 in->gt_entry.gt_g_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
2407 in->gt_entry.gt_bytes = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
2408 }
2409
2410 static void
2411 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_gptab *in,
2412 Elf32_External_gptab *ex)
2413 {
2414 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_g_value, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
2415 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_bytes, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
2416 }
2417
2418 static void
2419 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_compact_rel *in,
2420 Elf32_External_compact_rel *ex)
2421 {
2422 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id1, ex->id1);
2423 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->num, ex->num);
2424 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id2, ex->id2);
2425 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->offset, ex->offset);
2426 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved0, ex->reserved0);
2427 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved1, ex->reserved1);
2428 }
2429
2430 static void
2431 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_crinfo *in,
2432 Elf32_External_crinfo *ex)
2433 {
2434 unsigned long l;
2435
2436 l = (((in->ctype & CRINFO_CTYPE) << CRINFO_CTYPE_SH)
2437 | ((in->rtype & CRINFO_RTYPE) << CRINFO_RTYPE_SH)
2438 | ((in->dist2to & CRINFO_DIST2TO) << CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH)
2439 | ((in->relvaddr & CRINFO_RELVADDR) << CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH));
2440 H_PUT_32 (abfd, l, ex->info);
2441 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->konst, ex->konst);
2442 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->vaddr, ex->vaddr);
2443 }
2444 \f
2445 /* A .reginfo section holds a single Elf32_RegInfo structure. These
2446 routines swap this structure in and out. They are used outside of
2447 BFD, so they are globally visible. */
2448
2449 void
2450 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex,
2451 Elf32_RegInfo *in)
2452 {
2453 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
2454 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
2455 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
2456 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
2457 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
2458 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
2459 }
2460
2461 void
2462 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_RegInfo *in,
2463 Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex)
2464 {
2465 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
2466 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
2467 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
2468 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
2469 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
2470 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
2471 }
2472
2473 /* In the 64 bit ABI, the .MIPS.options section holds register
2474 information in an Elf64_Reginfo structure. These routines swap
2475 them in and out. They are globally visible because they are used
2476 outside of BFD. These routines are here so that gas can call them
2477 without worrying about whether the 64 bit ABI has been included. */
2478
2479 void
2480 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex,
2481 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in)
2482 {
2483 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
2484 in->ri_pad = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_pad);
2485 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
2486 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
2487 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
2488 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
2489 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_64 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
2490 }
2491
2492 void
2493 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in,
2494 Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex)
2495 {
2496 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
2497 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_pad, ex->ri_pad);
2498 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
2499 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
2500 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
2501 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
2502 H_PUT_64 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
2503 }
2504
2505 /* Swap in an options header. */
2506
2507 void
2508 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf_External_Options *ex,
2509 Elf_Internal_Options *in)
2510 {
2511 in->kind = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->kind);
2512 in->size = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->size);
2513 in->section = H_GET_16 (abfd, ex->section);
2514 in->info = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->info);
2515 }
2516
2517 /* Swap out an options header. */
2518
2519 void
2520 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf_Internal_Options *in,
2521 Elf_External_Options *ex)
2522 {
2523 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->kind, ex->kind);
2524 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->size, ex->size);
2525 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->section, ex->section);
2526 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->info, ex->info);
2527 }
2528 \f
2529 /* This function is called via qsort() to sort the dynamic relocation
2530 entries by increasing r_symndx value. */
2531
2532 static int
2533 sort_dynamic_relocs (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
2534 {
2535 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1;
2536 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2;
2537 int diff;
2538
2539 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, &int_reloc1);
2540 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, &int_reloc2);
2541
2542 diff = ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc1.r_info) - ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc2.r_info);
2543 if (diff != 0)
2544 return diff;
2545
2546 if (int_reloc1.r_offset < int_reloc2.r_offset)
2547 return -1;
2548 if (int_reloc1.r_offset > int_reloc2.r_offset)
2549 return 1;
2550 return 0;
2551 }
2552
2553 /* Like sort_dynamic_relocs, but used for elf64 relocations. */
2554
2555 static int
2556 sort_dynamic_relocs_64 (const void *arg1 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2557 const void *arg2 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2558 {
2559 #ifdef BFD64
2560 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1[3];
2561 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2[3];
2562
2563 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
2564 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, int_reloc1);
2565 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
2566 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, int_reloc2);
2567
2568 if (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info) < ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info))
2569 return -1;
2570 if (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info) > ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info))
2571 return 1;
2572
2573 if (int_reloc1[0].r_offset < int_reloc2[0].r_offset)
2574 return -1;
2575 if (int_reloc1[0].r_offset > int_reloc2[0].r_offset)
2576 return 1;
2577 return 0;
2578 #else
2579 abort ();
2580 #endif
2581 }
2582
2583
2584 /* This routine is used to write out ECOFF debugging external symbol
2585 information. It is called via mips_elf_link_hash_traverse. The
2586 ECOFF external symbol information must match the ELF external
2587 symbol information. Unfortunately, at this point we don't know
2588 whether a symbol is required by reloc information, so the two
2589 tables may wind up being different. We must sort out the external
2590 symbol information before we can set the final size of the .mdebug
2591 section, and we must set the size of the .mdebug section before we
2592 can relocate any sections, and we can't know which symbols are
2593 required by relocation until we relocate the sections.
2594 Fortunately, it is relatively unlikely that any symbol will be
2595 stripped but required by a reloc. In particular, it can not happen
2596 when generating a final executable. */
2597
2598 static bfd_boolean
2599 mips_elf_output_extsym (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
2600 {
2601 struct extsym_info *einfo = data;
2602 bfd_boolean strip;
2603 asection *sec, *output_section;
2604
2605 if (h->root.indx == -2)
2606 strip = FALSE;
2607 else if ((h->root.def_dynamic
2608 || h->root.ref_dynamic
2609 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
2610 && !h->root.def_regular
2611 && !h->root.ref_regular)
2612 strip = TRUE;
2613 else if (einfo->info->strip == strip_all
2614 || (einfo->info->strip == strip_some
2615 && bfd_hash_lookup (einfo->info->keep_hash,
2616 h->root.root.root.string,
2617 FALSE, FALSE) == NULL))
2618 strip = TRUE;
2619 else
2620 strip = FALSE;
2621
2622 if (strip)
2623 return TRUE;
2624
2625 if (h->esym.ifd == -2)
2626 {
2627 h->esym.jmptbl = 0;
2628 h->esym.cobol_main = 0;
2629 h->esym.weakext = 0;
2630 h->esym.reserved = 0;
2631 h->esym.ifd = ifdNil;
2632 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
2633 h->esym.asym.st = stGlobal;
2634
2635 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
2636 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
2637 {
2638 const char *name;
2639
2640 /* Use undefined class. Also, set class and type for some
2641 special symbols. */
2642 name = h->root.root.root.string;
2643 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
2644 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
2645 {
2646 h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
2647 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
2648 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
2649 }
2650 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
2651 {
2652 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
2653 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
2654 h->esym.asym.value =
2655 mips_elf_hash_table (einfo->info)->procedure_count;
2656 }
2657 else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (einfo->abfd))
2658 {
2659 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
2660 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
2661 h->esym.asym.value = elf_gp (einfo->abfd);
2662 }
2663 else
2664 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
2665 }
2666 else if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
2667 && h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2668 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
2669 else
2670 {
2671 const char *name;
2672
2673 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
2674 output_section = sec->output_section;
2675
2676 /* When making a shared library and symbol h is the one from
2677 the another shared library, OUTPUT_SECTION may be null. */
2678 if (output_section == NULL)
2679 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
2680 else
2681 {
2682 name = bfd_section_name (output_section->owner, output_section);
2683
2684 if (strcmp (name, ".text") == 0)
2685 h->esym.asym.sc = scText;
2686 else if (strcmp (name, ".data") == 0)
2687 h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
2688 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0)
2689 h->esym.asym.sc = scSData;
2690 else if (strcmp (name, ".rodata") == 0
2691 || strcmp (name, ".rdata") == 0)
2692 h->esym.asym.sc = scRData;
2693 else if (strcmp (name, ".bss") == 0)
2694 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
2695 else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
2696 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
2697 else if (strcmp (name, ".init") == 0)
2698 h->esym.asym.sc = scInit;
2699 else if (strcmp (name, ".fini") == 0)
2700 h->esym.asym.sc = scFini;
2701 else
2702 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
2703 }
2704 }
2705
2706 h->esym.asym.reserved = 0;
2707 h->esym.asym.index = indexNil;
2708 }
2709
2710 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_common)
2711 h->esym.asym.value = h->root.root.u.c.size;
2712 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
2713 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2714 {
2715 if (h->esym.asym.sc == scCommon)
2716 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
2717 else if (h->esym.asym.sc == scSCommon)
2718 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
2719
2720 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
2721 output_section = sec->output_section;
2722 if (output_section != NULL)
2723 h->esym.asym.value = (h->root.root.u.def.value
2724 + sec->output_offset
2725 + output_section->vma);
2726 else
2727 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
2728 }
2729 else
2730 {
2731 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hd = h;
2732
2733 while (hd->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
2734 hd = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h->root.root.u.i.link;
2735
2736 if (hd->needs_lazy_stub)
2737 {
2738 /* Set type and value for a symbol with a function stub. */
2739 h->esym.asym.st = stProc;
2740 sec = hd->root.root.u.def.section;
2741 if (sec == NULL)
2742 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
2743 else
2744 {
2745 output_section = sec->output_section;
2746 if (output_section != NULL)
2747 h->esym.asym.value = (hd->root.plt.offset
2748 + sec->output_offset
2749 + output_section->vma);
2750 else
2751 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
2752 }
2753 }
2754 }
2755
2756 if (! bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (einfo->abfd, einfo->debug, einfo->swap,
2757 h->root.root.root.string,
2758 &h->esym))
2759 {
2760 einfo->failed = TRUE;
2761 return FALSE;
2762 }
2763
2764 return TRUE;
2765 }
2766
2767 /* A comparison routine used to sort .gptab entries. */
2768
2769 static int
2770 gptab_compare (const void *p1, const void *p2)
2771 {
2772 const Elf32_gptab *a1 = p1;
2773 const Elf32_gptab *a2 = p2;
2774
2775 return a1->gt_entry.gt_g_value - a2->gt_entry.gt_g_value;
2776 }
2777 \f
2778 /* Functions to manage the got entry hash table. */
2779
2780 /* Use all 64 bits of a bfd_vma for the computation of a 32-bit
2781 hash number. */
2782
2783 static INLINE hashval_t
2784 mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (bfd_vma addr)
2785 {
2786 #ifdef BFD64
2787 return addr + (addr >> 32);
2788 #else
2789 return addr;
2790 #endif
2791 }
2792
2793 /* got_entries only match if they're identical, except for gotidx, so
2794 use all fields to compute the hash, and compare the appropriate
2795 union members. */
2796
2797 static hashval_t
2798 mips_elf_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
2799 {
2800 const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
2801
2802 return entry->symndx
2803 + ((entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM) << 17)
2804 + (! entry->abfd ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
2805 : entry->abfd->id
2806 + (entry->symndx >= 0 ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend)
2807 : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash));
2808 }
2809
2810 static int
2811 mips_elf_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
2812 {
2813 const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
2814 const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
2815
2816 /* An LDM entry can only match another LDM entry. */
2817 if ((e1->tls_type ^ e2->tls_type) & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2818 return 0;
2819
2820 return e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->symndx == e2->symndx
2821 && (! e1->abfd ? e1->d.address == e2->d.address
2822 : e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
2823 : e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
2824 }
2825
2826 /* multi_got_entries are still a match in the case of global objects,
2827 even if the input bfd in which they're referenced differs, so the
2828 hash computation and compare functions are adjusted
2829 accordingly. */
2830
2831 static hashval_t
2832 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
2833 {
2834 const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
2835
2836 return entry->symndx
2837 + (! entry->abfd
2838 ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
2839 : entry->symndx >= 0
2840 ? ((entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2841 ? (GOT_TLS_LDM << 17)
2842 : (entry->abfd->id
2843 + mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend)))
2844 : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash);
2845 }
2846
2847 static int
2848 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
2849 {
2850 const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
2851 const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
2852
2853 /* Any two LDM entries match. */
2854 if (e1->tls_type & e2->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2855 return 1;
2856
2857 /* Nothing else matches an LDM entry. */
2858 if ((e1->tls_type ^ e2->tls_type) & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2859 return 0;
2860
2861 return e1->symndx == e2->symndx
2862 && (e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
2863 : e1->abfd == NULL || e2->abfd == NULL
2864 ? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.address == e2->d.address
2865 : e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
2866 }
2867
2868 static hashval_t
2869 mips_got_page_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
2870 {
2871 const struct mips_got_page_entry *entry;
2872
2873 entry = (const struct mips_got_page_entry *) entry_;
2874 return entry->abfd->id + entry->symndx;
2875 }
2876
2877 static int
2878 mips_got_page_entry_eq (const void *entry1_, const void *entry2_)
2879 {
2880 const struct mips_got_page_entry *entry1, *entry2;
2881
2882 entry1 = (const struct mips_got_page_entry *) entry1_;
2883 entry2 = (const struct mips_got_page_entry *) entry2_;
2884 return entry1->abfd == entry2->abfd && entry1->symndx == entry2->symndx;
2885 }
2886 \f
2887 /* Return the dynamic relocation section. If it doesn't exist, try to
2888 create a new it if CREATE_P, otherwise return NULL. Also return NULL
2889 if creation fails. */
2890
2891 static asection *
2892 mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd_boolean create_p)
2893 {
2894 const char *dname;
2895 asection *sreloc;
2896 bfd *dynobj;
2897
2898 dname = MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info);
2899 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2900 sreloc = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, dname);
2901 if (sreloc == NULL && create_p)
2902 {
2903 sreloc = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, dname,
2904 (SEC_ALLOC
2905 | SEC_LOAD
2906 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2907 | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2908 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
2909 | SEC_READONLY));
2910 if (sreloc == NULL
2911 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, sreloc,
2912 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (dynobj)))
2913 return NULL;
2914 }
2915 return sreloc;
2916 }
2917
2918 /* Count the number of relocations needed for a TLS GOT entry, with
2919 access types from TLS_TYPE, and symbol H (or a local symbol if H
2920 is NULL). */
2921
2922 static int
2923 mips_tls_got_relocs (struct bfd_link_info *info, unsigned char tls_type,
2924 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
2925 {
2926 int indx = 0;
2927 int ret = 0;
2928 bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
2929 bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
2930
2931 if (h && WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, info->shared, h)
2932 && (!info->shared || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
2933 indx = h->dynindx;
2934
2935 if ((info->shared || indx != 0)
2936 && (h == NULL
2937 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT
2938 || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
2939 need_relocs = TRUE;
2940
2941 if (!need_relocs)
2942 return FALSE;
2943
2944 if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2945 {
2946 ret++;
2947 if (indx != 0)
2948 ret++;
2949 }
2950
2951 if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
2952 ret++;
2953
2954 if ((tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM) && info->shared)
2955 ret++;
2956
2957 return ret;
2958 }
2959
2960 /* Count the number of TLS relocations required for the GOT entry in
2961 ARG1, if it describes a local symbol. */
2962
2963 static int
2964 mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs (void **arg1, void *arg2)
2965 {
2966 struct mips_got_entry *entry = * (struct mips_got_entry **) arg1;
2967 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2968
2969 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx != -1)
2970 arg->needed += mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, entry->tls_type, NULL);
2971
2972 return 1;
2973 }
2974
2975 /* Count the number of TLS GOT entries required for the global (or
2976 forced-local) symbol in ARG1. */
2977
2978 static int
2979 mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries (void *arg1, void *arg2)
2980 {
2981 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2982 = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) arg1;
2983 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2984
2985 if (hm->tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2986 arg->needed += 2;
2987 if (hm->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
2988 arg->needed += 1;
2989
2990 return 1;
2991 }
2992
2993 /* Count the number of TLS relocations required for the global (or
2994 forced-local) symbol in ARG1. */
2995
2996 static int
2997 mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs (void *arg1, void *arg2)
2998 {
2999 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
3000 = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) arg1;
3001 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
3002
3003 arg->needed += mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, hm->tls_type, &hm->root);
3004
3005 return 1;
3006 }
3007
3008 /* Output a simple dynamic relocation into SRELOC. */
3009
3010 static void
3011 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
3012 asection *sreloc,
3013 unsigned long reloc_index,
3014 unsigned long indx,
3015 int r_type,
3016 bfd_vma offset)
3017 {
3018 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
3019
3020 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
3021
3022 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, indx, r_type);
3023 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
3024
3025 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
3026 {
3027 (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
3028 (output_bfd, &rel[0],
3029 (sreloc->contents
3030 + reloc_index * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
3031 }
3032 else
3033 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
3034 (output_bfd, &rel[0],
3035 (sreloc->contents
3036 + reloc_index * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
3037 }
3038
3039 /* Initialize a set of TLS GOT entries for one symbol. */
3040
3041 static void
3042 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (bfd *abfd, bfd_vma got_offset,
3043 unsigned char *tls_type_p,
3044 struct bfd_link_info *info,
3045 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
3046 bfd_vma value)
3047 {
3048 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3049 int indx;
3050 asection *sreloc, *sgot;
3051 bfd_vma offset, offset2;
3052 bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
3053
3054 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3055 if (htab == NULL)
3056 return;
3057
3058 sgot = htab->sgot;
3059
3060 indx = 0;
3061 if (h != NULL)
3062 {
3063 bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
3064
3065 if (WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, info->shared, &h->root)
3066 && (!info->shared || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->root)))
3067 indx = h->root.dynindx;
3068 }
3069
3070 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_DONE)
3071 return;
3072
3073 if ((info->shared || indx != 0)
3074 && (h == NULL
3075 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT
3076 || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
3077 need_relocs = TRUE;
3078
3079 /* MINUS_ONE means the symbol is not defined in this object. It may not
3080 be defined at all; assume that the value doesn't matter in that
3081 case. Otherwise complain if we would use the value. */
3082 BFD_ASSERT (value != MINUS_ONE || (indx != 0 && need_relocs)
3083 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak);
3084
3085 /* Emit necessary relocations. */
3086 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
3087
3088 /* General Dynamic. */
3089 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_GD)
3090 {
3091 offset = got_offset;
3092 offset2 = offset + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
3093
3094 if (need_relocs)
3095 {
3096 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
3097 (abfd, sreloc, sreloc->reloc_count++, indx,
3098 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
3099 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset);
3100
3101 if (indx)
3102 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
3103 (abfd, sreloc, sreloc->reloc_count++, indx,
3104 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32,
3105 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset2);
3106 else
3107 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
3108 sgot->contents + offset2);
3109 }
3110 else
3111 {
3112 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
3113 sgot->contents + offset);
3114 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
3115 sgot->contents + offset2);
3116 }
3117
3118 got_offset += 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
3119 }
3120
3121 /* Initial Exec model. */
3122 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_IE)
3123 {
3124 offset = got_offset;
3125
3126 if (need_relocs)
3127 {
3128 if (indx == 0)
3129 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma,
3130 sgot->contents + offset);
3131 else
3132 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
3133 sgot->contents + offset);
3134
3135 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
3136 (abfd, sreloc, sreloc->reloc_count++, indx,
3137 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32,
3138 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset);
3139 }
3140 else
3141 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - tprel_base (info),
3142 sgot->contents + offset);
3143 }
3144
3145 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_LDM)
3146 {
3147 /* The initial offset is zero, and the LD offsets will include the
3148 bias by DTP_OFFSET. */
3149 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
3150 sgot->contents + got_offset
3151 + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
3152
3153 if (!info->shared)
3154 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
3155 sgot->contents + got_offset);
3156 else
3157 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
3158 (abfd, sreloc, sreloc->reloc_count++, indx,
3159 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
3160 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + got_offset);
3161 }
3162
3163 *tls_type_p |= GOT_TLS_DONE;
3164 }
3165
3166 /* Return the GOT index to use for a relocation of type R_TYPE against
3167 a symbol accessed using TLS_TYPE models. The GOT entries for this
3168 symbol in this GOT start at GOT_INDEX. This function initializes the
3169 GOT entries and corresponding relocations. */
3170
3171 static bfd_vma
3172 mips_tls_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd_vma got_index, unsigned char *tls_type,
3173 int r_type, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3174 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, bfd_vma symbol)
3175 {
3176 BFD_ASSERT (tls_gottprel_reloc_p (r_type)
3177 || tls_gd_reloc_p (r_type)
3178 || tls_ldm_reloc_p (r_type));
3179
3180 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (abfd, got_index, tls_type, info, h, symbol);
3181
3182 if (tls_gottprel_reloc_p (r_type))
3183 {
3184 BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE);
3185 if (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
3186 return got_index + 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
3187 else
3188 return got_index;
3189 }
3190
3191 if (tls_gd_reloc_p (r_type))
3192 {
3193 BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD);
3194 return got_index;
3195 }
3196
3197 if (tls_ldm_reloc_p (r_type))
3198 {
3199 BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM);
3200 return got_index;
3201 }
3202
3203 return got_index;
3204 }
3205
3206 /* Return the offset from _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ of the .got.plt entry
3207 for global symbol H. .got.plt comes before the GOT, so the offset
3208 will be negative. */
3209
3210 static bfd_vma
3211 mips_elf_gotplt_index (struct bfd_link_info *info,
3212 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
3213 {
3214 bfd_vma plt_index, got_address, got_value;
3215 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3216
3217 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3218 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3219
3220 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1);
3221
3222 /* This function only works for VxWorks, because a non-VxWorks .got.plt
3223 section starts with reserved entries. */
3224 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
3225
3226 /* Calculate the index of the symbol's PLT entry. */
3227 plt_index = (h->plt.offset - htab->plt_header_size) / htab->plt_entry_size;
3228
3229 /* Calculate the address of the associated .got.plt entry. */
3230 got_address = (htab->sgotplt->output_section->vma
3231 + htab->sgotplt->output_offset
3232 + plt_index * 4);
3233
3234 /* Calculate the value of _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
3235 got_value = (htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
3236 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_offset
3237 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.value);
3238
3239 return got_address - got_value;
3240 }
3241
3242 /* Return the GOT offset for address VALUE. If there is not yet a GOT
3243 entry for this value, create one. If R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol,
3244 create a TLS GOT entry instead. Return -1 if no satisfactory GOT
3245 offset can be found. */
3246
3247 static bfd_vma
3248 mips_elf_local_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3249 bfd_vma value, unsigned long r_symndx,
3250 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, int r_type)
3251 {
3252 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3253 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
3254
3255 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3256 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3257
3258 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, value,
3259 r_symndx, h, r_type);
3260 if (!entry)
3261 return MINUS_ONE;
3262
3263 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
3264 {
3265 if (entry->symndx == -1 && htab->got_info->next == NULL)
3266 /* A type (3) entry in the single-GOT case. We use the symbol's
3267 hash table entry to track the index. */
3268 return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, h->tls_got_offset, &h->tls_type,
3269 r_type, info, h, value);
3270 else
3271 return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, entry->gotidx, &entry->tls_type,
3272 r_type, info, h, value);
3273 }
3274 else
3275 return entry->gotidx;
3276 }
3277
3278 /* Returns the GOT index for the global symbol indicated by H. */
3279
3280 static bfd_vma
3281 mips_elf_global_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
3282 int r_type, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3283 {
3284 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3285 bfd_vma got_index;
3286 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
3287 long global_got_dynindx = 0;
3288
3289 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3290 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3291
3292 gg = g = htab->got_info;
3293 if (g->bfd2got && ibfd)
3294 {
3295 struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
3296
3297 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= 0);
3298
3299 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
3300 if (g->next != gg || TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
3301 {
3302 e.abfd = ibfd;
3303 e.symndx = -1;
3304 e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h;
3305 e.tls_type = 0;
3306
3307 p = htab_find (g->got_entries, &e);
3308
3309 BFD_ASSERT (p->gotidx > 0);
3310
3311 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
3312 {
3313 bfd_vma value = MINUS_ONE;
3314 if ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
3315 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
3316 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section)
3317 value = (h->root.u.def.value
3318 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
3319 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
3320
3321 return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, p->gotidx, &p->tls_type, r_type,
3322 info, e.d.h, value);
3323 }
3324 else
3325 return p->gotidx;
3326 }
3327 }
3328
3329 if (gg->global_gotsym != NULL)
3330 global_got_dynindx = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
3331
3332 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
3333 {
3334 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
3335 = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
3336 bfd_vma value = MINUS_ONE;
3337
3338 if ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
3339 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
3340 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section)
3341 value = (h->root.u.def.value
3342 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
3343 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
3344
3345 got_index = mips_tls_got_index (abfd, hm->tls_got_offset, &hm->tls_type,
3346 r_type, info, hm, value);
3347 }
3348 else
3349 {
3350 /* Once we determine the global GOT entry with the lowest dynamic
3351 symbol table index, we must put all dynamic symbols with greater
3352 indices into the GOT. That makes it easy to calculate the GOT
3353 offset. */
3354 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= global_got_dynindx);
3355 got_index = ((h->dynindx - global_got_dynindx + g->local_gotno)
3356 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
3357 }
3358 BFD_ASSERT (got_index < htab->sgot->size);
3359
3360 return got_index;
3361 }
3362
3363 /* Find a GOT page entry that points to within 32KB of VALUE. These
3364 entries are supposed to be placed at small offsets in the GOT, i.e.,
3365 within 32KB of GP. Return the index of the GOT entry, or -1 if no
3366 entry could be created. If OFFSETP is nonnull, use it to return the
3367 offset of the GOT entry from VALUE. */
3368
3369 static bfd_vma
3370 mips_elf_got_page (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3371 bfd_vma value, bfd_vma *offsetp)
3372 {
3373 bfd_vma page, got_index;
3374 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
3375
3376 page = (value + 0x8000) & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
3377 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, page, 0,
3378 NULL, R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE);
3379
3380 if (!entry)
3381 return MINUS_ONE;
3382
3383 got_index = entry->gotidx;
3384
3385 if (offsetp)
3386 *offsetp = value - entry->d.address;
3387
3388 return got_index;
3389 }
3390
3391 /* Find a local GOT entry for an R_MIPS*_GOT16 relocation against VALUE.
3392 EXTERNAL is true if the relocation was originally against a global
3393 symbol that binds locally. */
3394
3395 static bfd_vma
3396 mips_elf_got16_entry (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3397 bfd_vma value, bfd_boolean external)
3398 {
3399 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
3400
3401 /* GOT16 relocations against local symbols are followed by a LO16
3402 relocation; those against global symbols are not. Thus if the
3403 symbol was originally local, the GOT16 relocation should load the
3404 equivalent of %hi(VALUE), otherwise it should load VALUE itself. */
3405 if (! external)
3406 value = mips_elf_high (value) << 16;
3407
3408 /* It doesn't matter whether the original relocation was R_MIPS_GOT16,
3409 R_MIPS16_GOT16, R_MIPS_CALL16, etc. The format of the entry is the
3410 same in all cases. */
3411 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, value, 0,
3412 NULL, R_MIPS_GOT16);
3413 if (entry)
3414 return entry->gotidx;
3415 else
3416 return MINUS_ONE;
3417 }
3418
3419 /* Returns the offset for the entry at the INDEXth position
3420 in the GOT. */
3421
3422 static bfd_vma
3423 mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd *output_bfd,
3424 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_vma got_index)
3425 {
3426 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3427 asection *sgot;
3428 bfd_vma gp;
3429
3430 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3431 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3432
3433 sgot = htab->sgot;
3434 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd)
3435 + mips_elf_adjust_gp (output_bfd, htab->got_info, input_bfd);
3436
3437 return sgot->output_section->vma + sgot->output_offset + got_index - gp;
3438 }
3439
3440 /* Create and return a local GOT entry for VALUE, which was calculated
3441 from a symbol belonging to INPUT_SECTON. Return NULL if it could not
3442 be created. If R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol, create a TLS entry
3443 instead. */
3444
3445 static struct mips_got_entry *
3446 mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3447 bfd *ibfd, bfd_vma value,
3448 unsigned long r_symndx,
3449 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
3450 int r_type)
3451 {
3452 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
3453 struct mips_got_info *g;
3454 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3455
3456 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3457 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3458
3459 entry.abfd = NULL;
3460 entry.symndx = -1;
3461 entry.d.address = value;
3462 entry.tls_type = 0;
3463
3464 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (htab->got_info, ibfd);
3465 if (g == NULL)
3466 {
3467 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (htab->got_info, abfd);
3468 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
3469 }
3470
3471 /* This function shouldn't be called for symbols that live in the global
3472 area of the GOT. */
3473 BFD_ASSERT (h == NULL || h->global_got_area == GGA_NONE);
3474 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
3475 {
3476 struct mips_got_entry *p;
3477
3478 entry.abfd = ibfd;
3479 if (tls_ldm_reloc_p (r_type))
3480 {
3481 entry.tls_type = GOT_TLS_LDM;
3482 entry.symndx = 0;
3483 entry.d.addend = 0;
3484 }
3485 else if (h == NULL)
3486 {
3487 entry.symndx = r_symndx;
3488 entry.d.addend = 0;
3489 }
3490 else
3491 entry.d.h = h;
3492
3493 p = (struct mips_got_entry *)
3494 htab_find (g->got_entries, &entry);
3495
3496 BFD_ASSERT (p);
3497 return p;
3498 }
3499
3500 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
3501 INSERT);
3502 if (*loc)
3503 return *loc;
3504
3505 entry.gotidx = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd) * g->assigned_gotno++;
3506 entry.tls_type = 0;
3507
3508 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
3509
3510 if (! *loc)
3511 return NULL;
3512
3513 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
3514
3515 if (g->assigned_gotno > g->local_gotno)
3516 {
3517 (*loc)->gotidx = -1;
3518 /* We didn't allocate enough space in the GOT. */
3519 (*_bfd_error_handler)
3520 (_("not enough GOT space for local GOT entries"));
3521 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3522 return NULL;
3523 }
3524
3525 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value,
3526 (htab->sgot->contents + entry.gotidx));
3527
3528 /* These GOT entries need a dynamic relocation on VxWorks. */
3529 if (htab->is_vxworks)
3530 {
3531 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
3532 asection *s;
3533 bfd_byte *rloc;
3534 bfd_vma got_address;
3535
3536 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
3537 got_address = (htab->sgot->output_section->vma
3538 + htab->sgot->output_offset
3539 + entry.gotidx);
3540
3541 rloc = s->contents + (s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
3542 outrel.r_offset = got_address;
3543 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_MIPS_32);
3544 outrel.r_addend = value;
3545 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (abfd, &outrel, rloc);
3546 }
3547
3548 return *loc;
3549 }
3550
3551 /* Return the number of dynamic section symbols required by OUTPUT_BFD.
3552 The number might be exact or a worst-case estimate, depending on how
3553 much information is available to elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym at
3554 the current linking stage. */
3555
3556 static bfd_size_type
3557 count_section_dynsyms (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3558 {
3559 bfd_size_type count;
3560
3561 count = 0;
3562 if (info->shared || elf_hash_table (info)->is_relocatable_executable)
3563 {
3564 asection *p;
3565 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3566
3567 bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
3568 for (p = output_bfd->sections; p ; p = p->next)
3569 if ((p->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
3570 && (p->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3571 && !(*bed->elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym) (output_bfd, info, p))
3572 ++count;
3573 }
3574 return count;
3575 }
3576
3577 /* Sort the dynamic symbol table so that symbols that need GOT entries
3578 appear towards the end. */
3579
3580 static bfd_boolean
3581 mips_elf_sort_hash_table (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3582 {
3583 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3584 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data hsd;
3585 struct mips_got_info *g;
3586
3587 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount == 0)
3588 return TRUE;
3589
3590 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3591 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3592
3593 g = htab->got_info;
3594 if (g == NULL)
3595 return TRUE;
3596
3597 hsd.low = NULL;
3598 hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx
3599 = hsd.min_got_dynindx
3600 = (elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount - g->reloc_only_gotno);
3601 hsd.max_non_got_dynindx = count_section_dynsyms (abfd, info) + 1;
3602 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *)
3603 elf_hash_table (info)),
3604 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f,
3605 &hsd);
3606
3607 /* There should have been enough room in the symbol table to
3608 accommodate both the GOT and non-GOT symbols. */
3609 BFD_ASSERT (hsd.max_non_got_dynindx <= hsd.min_got_dynindx);
3610 BFD_ASSERT ((unsigned long) hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx
3611 == elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount);
3612 BFD_ASSERT (elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount - hsd.min_got_dynindx
3613 == g->global_gotno);
3614
3615 /* Now we know which dynamic symbol has the lowest dynamic symbol
3616 table index in the GOT. */
3617 g->global_gotsym = hsd.low;
3618
3619 return TRUE;
3620 }
3621
3622 /* If H needs a GOT entry, assign it the highest available dynamic
3623 index. Otherwise, assign it the lowest available dynamic
3624 index. */
3625
3626 static bfd_boolean
3627 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
3628 {
3629 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data *hsd = data;
3630
3631 /* Symbols without dynamic symbol table entries aren't interesting
3632 at all. */
3633 if (h->root.dynindx == -1)
3634 return TRUE;
3635
3636 switch (h->global_got_area)
3637 {
3638 case GGA_NONE:
3639 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_non_got_dynindx++;
3640 break;
3641
3642 case GGA_NORMAL:
3643 BFD_ASSERT (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL);
3644
3645 h->root.dynindx = --hsd->min_got_dynindx;
3646 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
3647 break;
3648
3649 case GGA_RELOC_ONLY:
3650 BFD_ASSERT (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL);
3651
3652 if (hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx == hsd->min_got_dynindx)
3653 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
3654 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx++;
3655 break;
3656 }
3657
3658 return TRUE;
3659 }
3660
3661 /* If H is a symbol that needs a global GOT entry, but has a dynamic
3662 symbol table index lower than any we've seen to date, record it for
3663 posterity. FOR_CALL is true if the caller is only interested in
3664 using the GOT entry for calls. */
3665
3666 static bfd_boolean
3667 mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
3668 bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3669 bfd_boolean for_call,
3670 unsigned char tls_flag)
3671 {
3672 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3673 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
3674 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
3675 struct mips_got_info *g;
3676
3677 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3678 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3679
3680 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
3681 if (!for_call)
3682 hmips->got_only_for_calls = FALSE;
3683
3684 /* A global symbol in the GOT must also be in the dynamic symbol
3685 table. */
3686 if (h->dynindx == -1)
3687 {
3688 switch (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other))
3689 {
3690 case STV_INTERNAL:
3691 case STV_HIDDEN:
3692 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, h, TRUE);
3693 break;
3694 }
3695 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
3696 return FALSE;
3697 }
3698
3699 /* Make sure we have a GOT to put this entry into. */
3700 g = htab->got_info;
3701 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
3702
3703 entry.abfd = abfd;
3704 entry.symndx = -1;
3705 entry.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
3706 entry.tls_type = 0;
3707
3708 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
3709 INSERT);
3710
3711 /* If we've already marked this entry as needing GOT space, we don't
3712 need to do it again. */
3713 if (*loc)
3714 {
3715 (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
3716 return TRUE;
3717 }
3718
3719 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
3720
3721 if (! *loc)
3722 return FALSE;
3723
3724 entry.gotidx = -1;
3725 entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
3726
3727 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
3728
3729 if (tls_flag == 0)
3730 hmips->global_got_area = GGA_NORMAL;
3731
3732 return TRUE;
3733 }
3734
3735 /* Reserve space in G for a GOT entry containing the value of symbol
3736 SYMNDX in input bfd ABDF, plus ADDEND. */
3737
3738 static bfd_boolean
3739 mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (bfd *abfd, long symndx, bfd_vma addend,
3740 struct bfd_link_info *info,
3741 unsigned char tls_flag)
3742 {
3743 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3744 struct mips_got_info *g;
3745 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
3746
3747 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3748 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3749
3750 g = htab->got_info;
3751 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
3752
3753 entry.abfd = abfd;
3754 entry.symndx = symndx;
3755 entry.d.addend = addend;
3756 entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
3757 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **)
3758 htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry, INSERT);
3759
3760 if (*loc)
3761 {
3762 if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_GD && !((*loc)->tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD))
3763 {
3764 g->tls_gotno += 2;
3765 (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
3766 }
3767 else if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_IE && !((*loc)->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE))
3768 {
3769 g->tls_gotno += 1;
3770 (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
3771 }
3772 return TRUE;
3773 }
3774
3775 if (tls_flag != 0)
3776 {
3777 entry.gotidx = -1;
3778 entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
3779 if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_IE)
3780 g->tls_gotno += 1;
3781 else if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_GD)
3782 g->tls_gotno += 2;
3783 else if (g->tls_ldm_offset == MINUS_ONE)
3784 {
3785 g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_TWO;
3786 g->tls_gotno += 2;
3787 }
3788 }
3789 else
3790 {
3791 entry.gotidx = g->local_gotno++;
3792 entry.tls_type = 0;
3793 }
3794
3795 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
3796
3797 if (! *loc)
3798 return FALSE;
3799
3800 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
3801
3802 return TRUE;
3803 }
3804
3805 /* Return the maximum number of GOT page entries required for RANGE. */
3806
3807 static bfd_vma
3808 mips_elf_pages_for_range (const struct mips_got_page_range *range)
3809 {
3810 return (range->max_addend - range->min_addend + 0x1ffff) >> 16;
3811 }
3812
3813 /* Record that ABFD has a page relocation against symbol SYMNDX and
3814 that ADDEND is the addend for that relocation.
3815
3816 This function creates an upper bound on the number of GOT slots
3817 required; no attempt is made to combine references to non-overridable
3818 global symbols across multiple input files. */
3819
3820 static bfd_boolean
3821 mips_elf_record_got_page_entry (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd *abfd,
3822 long symndx, bfd_signed_vma addend)
3823 {
3824 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3825 struct mips_got_info *g;
3826 struct mips_got_page_entry lookup, *entry;
3827 struct mips_got_page_range **range_ptr, *range;
3828 bfd_vma old_pages, new_pages;
3829 void **loc;
3830
3831 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3832 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3833
3834 g = htab->got_info;
3835 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
3836
3837 /* Find the mips_got_page_entry hash table entry for this symbol. */
3838 lookup.abfd = abfd;
3839 lookup.symndx = symndx;
3840 loc = htab_find_slot (g->got_page_entries, &lookup, INSERT);
3841 if (loc == NULL)
3842 return FALSE;
3843
3844 /* Create a mips_got_page_entry if this is the first time we've
3845 seen the symbol. */
3846 entry = (struct mips_got_page_entry *) *loc;
3847 if (!entry)
3848 {
3849 entry = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*entry));
3850 if (!entry)
3851 return FALSE;
3852
3853 entry->abfd = abfd;
3854 entry->symndx = symndx;
3855 entry->ranges = NULL;
3856 entry->num_pages = 0;
3857 *loc = entry;
3858 }
3859
3860 /* Skip over ranges whose maximum extent cannot share a page entry
3861 with ADDEND. */
3862 range_ptr = &entry->ranges;
3863 while (*range_ptr && addend > (*range_ptr)->max_addend + 0xffff)
3864 range_ptr = &(*range_ptr)->next;
3865
3866 /* If we scanned to the end of the list, or found a range whose
3867 minimum extent cannot share a page entry with ADDEND, create
3868 a new singleton range. */
3869 range = *range_ptr;
3870 if (!range || addend < range->min_addend - 0xffff)
3871 {
3872 range = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*range));
3873 if (!range)
3874 return FALSE;
3875
3876 range->next = *range_ptr;
3877 range->min_addend = addend;
3878 range->max_addend = addend;
3879
3880 *range_ptr = range;
3881 entry->num_pages++;
3882 g->page_gotno++;
3883 return TRUE;
3884 }
3885
3886 /* Remember how many pages the old range contributed. */
3887 old_pages = mips_elf_pages_for_range (range);
3888
3889 /* Update the ranges. */
3890 if (addend < range->min_addend)
3891 range->min_addend = addend;
3892 else if (addend > range->max_addend)
3893 {
3894 if (range->next && addend >= range->next->min_addend - 0xffff)
3895 {
3896 old_pages += mips_elf_pages_for_range (range->next);
3897 range->max_addend = range->next->max_addend;
3898 range->next = range->next->next;
3899 }
3900 else
3901 range->max_addend = addend;
3902 }
3903
3904 /* Record any change in the total estimate. */
3905 new_pages = mips_elf_pages_for_range (range);
3906 if (old_pages != new_pages)
3907 {
3908 entry->num_pages += new_pages - old_pages;
3909 g->page_gotno += new_pages - old_pages;
3910 }
3911
3912 return TRUE;
3913 }
3914
3915 /* Add room for N relocations to the .rel(a).dyn section in ABFD. */
3916
3917 static void
3918 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3919 unsigned int n)
3920 {
3921 asection *s;
3922 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3923
3924 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3925 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3926
3927 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
3928 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
3929
3930 if (htab->is_vxworks)
3931 s->size += n * MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (abfd);
3932 else
3933 {
3934 if (s->size == 0)
3935 {
3936 /* Make room for a null element. */
3937 s->size += MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
3938 ++s->reloc_count;
3939 }
3940 s->size += n * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
3941 }
3942 }
3943 \f
3944 /* A htab_traverse callback for GOT entries. Set boolean *DATA to true
3945 if the GOT entry is for an indirect or warning symbol. */
3946
3947 static int
3948 mips_elf_check_recreate_got (void **entryp, void *data)
3949 {
3950 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
3951 bfd_boolean *must_recreate;
3952
3953 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
3954 must_recreate = (bfd_boolean *) data;
3955 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1)
3956 {
3957 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3958
3959 h = entry->d.h;
3960 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3961 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3962 {
3963 *must_recreate = TRUE;
3964 return 0;
3965 }
3966 }
3967 return 1;
3968 }
3969
3970 /* A htab_traverse callback for GOT entries. Add all entries to
3971 hash table *DATA, converting entries for indirect and warning
3972 symbols into entries for the target symbol. Set *DATA to null
3973 on error. */
3974
3975 static int
3976 mips_elf_recreate_got (void **entryp, void *data)
3977 {
3978 htab_t *new_got;
3979 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
3980 void **slot;
3981
3982 new_got = (htab_t *) data;
3983 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
3984 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1)
3985 {
3986 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3987
3988 h = entry->d.h;
3989 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3990 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3991 {
3992 BFD_ASSERT (h->global_got_area == GGA_NONE);
3993 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3994 }
3995 entry->d.h = h;
3996 }
3997 slot = htab_find_slot (*new_got, entry, INSERT);
3998 if (slot == NULL)
3999 {
4000 *new_got = NULL;
4001 return 0;
4002 }
4003 if (*slot == NULL)
4004 *slot = entry;
4005 else
4006 free (entry);
4007 return 1;
4008 }
4009
4010 /* If any entries in G->got_entries are for indirect or warning symbols,
4011 replace them with entries for the target symbol. */
4012
4013 static bfd_boolean
4014 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (struct mips_got_info *g)
4015 {
4016 bfd_boolean must_recreate;
4017 htab_t new_got;
4018
4019 must_recreate = FALSE;
4020 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_check_recreate_got, &must_recreate);
4021 if (must_recreate)
4022 {
4023 new_got = htab_create (htab_size (g->got_entries),
4024 mips_elf_got_entry_hash,
4025 mips_elf_got_entry_eq, NULL);
4026 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_recreate_got, &new_got);
4027 if (new_got == NULL)
4028 return FALSE;
4029
4030 /* Each entry in g->got_entries has either been copied to new_got
4031 or freed. Now delete the hash table itself. */
4032 htab_delete (g->got_entries);
4033 g->got_entries = new_got;
4034 }
4035 return TRUE;
4036 }
4037
4038 /* A mips_elf_link_hash_traverse callback for which DATA points
4039 to the link_info structure. Count the number of type (3) entries
4040 in the master GOT. */
4041
4042 static int
4043 mips_elf_count_got_symbols (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
4044 {
4045 struct bfd_link_info *info;
4046 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4047 struct mips_got_info *g;
4048
4049 info = (struct bfd_link_info *) data;
4050 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4051 g = htab->got_info;
4052 if (h->global_got_area != GGA_NONE)
4053 {
4054 /* Make a final decision about whether the symbol belongs in the
4055 local or global GOT. Symbols that bind locally can (and in the
4056 case of forced-local symbols, must) live in the local GOT.
4057 Those that are aren't in the dynamic symbol table must also
4058 live in the local GOT.
4059
4060 Note that the former condition does not always imply the
4061 latter: symbols do not bind locally if they are completely
4062 undefined. We'll report undefined symbols later if appropriate. */
4063 if (h->root.dynindx == -1
4064 || (h->got_only_for_calls
4065 ? SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, &h->root)
4066 : SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->root)))
4067 {
4068 /* The symbol belongs in the local GOT. We no longer need this
4069 entry if it was only used for relocations; those relocations
4070 will be against the null or section symbol instead of H. */
4071 if (h->global_got_area != GGA_RELOC_ONLY)
4072 g->local_gotno++;
4073 h->global_got_area = GGA_NONE;
4074 }
4075 else if (htab->is_vxworks
4076 && h->got_only_for_calls
4077 && h->root.plt.offset != MINUS_ONE)
4078 /* On VxWorks, calls can refer directly to the .got.plt entry;
4079 they don't need entries in the regular GOT. .got.plt entries
4080 will be allocated by _bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol. */
4081 h->global_got_area = GGA_NONE;
4082 else
4083 {
4084 g->global_gotno++;
4085 if (h->global_got_area == GGA_RELOC_ONLY)
4086 g->reloc_only_gotno++;
4087 }
4088 }
4089 return 1;
4090 }
4091 \f
4092 /* Compute the hash value of the bfd in a bfd2got hash entry. */
4093
4094 static hashval_t
4095 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
4096 {
4097 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *entry
4098 = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry_;
4099
4100 return entry->bfd->id;
4101 }
4102
4103 /* Check whether two hash entries have the same bfd. */
4104
4105 static int
4106 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
4107 {
4108 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e1
4109 = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry1;
4110 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e2
4111 = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry2;
4112
4113 return e1->bfd == e2->bfd;
4114 }
4115
4116 /* In a multi-got link, determine the GOT to be used for IBFD. G must
4117 be the master GOT data. */
4118
4119 static struct mips_got_info *
4120 mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
4121 {
4122 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash e, *p;
4123
4124 if (! g->bfd2got)
4125 return g;
4126
4127 e.bfd = ibfd;
4128 p = htab_find (g->bfd2got, &e);
4129 return p ? p->g : NULL;
4130 }
4131
4132 /* Use BFD2GOT to find ABFD's got entry, creating one if none exists.
4133 Return NULL if an error occured. */
4134
4135 static struct mips_got_info *
4136 mips_elf_get_got_for_bfd (struct htab *bfd2got, bfd *output_bfd,
4137 bfd *input_bfd)
4138 {
4139 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash bfdgot_entry, *bfdgot;
4140 struct mips_got_info *g;
4141 void **bfdgotp;
4142
4143 bfdgot_entry.bfd = input_bfd;
4144 bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (bfd2got, &bfdgot_entry, INSERT);
4145 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *) *bfdgotp;
4146
4147 if (bfdgot == NULL)
4148 {
4149 bfdgot = ((struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)
4150 bfd_alloc (output_bfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash)));
4151 if (bfdgot == NULL)
4152 return NULL;
4153
4154 *bfdgotp = bfdgot;
4155
4156 g = ((struct mips_got_info *)
4157 bfd_alloc (output_bfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info)));
4158 if (g == NULL)
4159 return NULL;
4160
4161 bfdgot->bfd = input_bfd;
4162 bfdgot->g = g;
4163
4164 g->global_gotsym = NULL;
4165 g->global_gotno = 0;
4166 g->reloc_only_gotno = 0;
4167 g->local_gotno = 0;
4168 g->page_gotno = 0;
4169 g->assigned_gotno = -1;
4170 g->tls_gotno = 0;
4171 g->tls_assigned_gotno = 0;
4172 g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
4173 g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
4174 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq, NULL);
4175 if (g->got_entries == NULL)
4176 return NULL;
4177
4178 g->got_page_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_got_page_entry_hash,
4179 mips_got_page_entry_eq, NULL);
4180 if (g->got_page_entries == NULL)
4181 return NULL;
4182
4183 g->bfd2got = NULL;
4184 g->next = NULL;
4185 }
4186
4187 return bfdgot->g;
4188 }
4189
4190 /* A htab_traverse callback for the entries in the master got.
4191 Create one separate got for each bfd that has entries in the global
4192 got, such that we can tell how many local and global entries each
4193 bfd requires. */
4194
4195 static int
4196 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd (void **entryp, void *p)
4197 {
4198 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
4199 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
4200 struct mips_got_info *g;
4201
4202 g = mips_elf_get_got_for_bfd (arg->bfd2got, arg->obfd, entry->abfd);
4203 if (g == NULL)
4204 {
4205 arg->obfd = NULL;
4206 return 0;
4207 }
4208
4209 /* Insert the GOT entry in the bfd's got entry hash table. */
4210 entryp = htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, entry, INSERT);
4211 if (*entryp != NULL)
4212 return 1;
4213
4214 *entryp = entry;
4215
4216 if (entry->tls_type)
4217 {
4218 if (entry->tls_type & (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_LDM))
4219 g->tls_gotno += 2;
4220 if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
4221 g->tls_gotno += 1;
4222 }
4223 else if (entry->symndx >= 0 || entry->d.h->global_got_area == GGA_NONE)
4224 ++g->local_gotno;
4225 else
4226 ++g->global_gotno;
4227
4228 return 1;
4229 }
4230
4231 /* A htab_traverse callback for the page entries in the master got.
4232 Associate each page entry with the bfd's got. */
4233
4234 static int
4235 mips_elf_make_got_pages_per_bfd (void **entryp, void *p)
4236 {
4237 struct mips_got_page_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_page_entry *) *entryp;
4238 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *) p;
4239 struct mips_got_info *g;
4240
4241 g = mips_elf_get_got_for_bfd (arg->bfd2got, arg->obfd, entry->abfd);
4242 if (g == NULL)
4243 {
4244 arg->obfd = NULL;
4245 return 0;
4246 }
4247
4248 /* Insert the GOT entry in the bfd's got entry hash table. */
4249 entryp = htab_find_slot (g->got_page_entries, entry, INSERT);
4250 if (*entryp != NULL)
4251 return 1;
4252
4253 *entryp = entry;
4254 g->page_gotno += entry->num_pages;
4255 return 1;
4256 }
4257
4258 /* Consider merging the got described by BFD2GOT with TO, using the
4259 information given by ARG. Return -1 if this would lead to overflow,
4260 1 if they were merged successfully, and 0 if a merge failed due to
4261 lack of memory. (These values are chosen so that nonnegative return
4262 values can be returned by a htab_traverse callback.) */
4263
4264 static int
4265 mips_elf_merge_got_with (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfd2got,
4266 struct mips_got_info *to,
4267 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg)
4268 {
4269 struct mips_got_info *from = bfd2got->g;
4270 unsigned int estimate;
4271
4272 /* Work out how many page entries we would need for the combined GOT. */
4273 estimate = arg->max_pages;
4274 if (estimate >= from->page_gotno + to->page_gotno)
4275 estimate = from->page_gotno + to->page_gotno;
4276
4277 /* And conservatively estimate how many local and TLS entries
4278 would be needed. */
4279 estimate += from->local_gotno + to->local_gotno;
4280 estimate += from->tls_gotno + to->tls_gotno;
4281
4282 /* If we're merging with the primary got, we will always have
4283 the full set of global entries. Otherwise estimate those
4284 conservatively as well. */
4285 if (to == arg->primary)
4286 estimate += arg->global_count;
4287 else
4288 estimate += from->global_gotno + to->global_gotno;
4289
4290 /* Bail out if the combined GOT might be too big. */
4291 if (estimate > arg->max_count)
4292 return -1;
4293
4294 /* Commit to the merge. Record that TO is now the bfd for this got. */
4295 bfd2got->g = to;
4296
4297 /* Transfer the bfd's got information from FROM to TO. */
4298 htab_traverse (from->got_entries, mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd, arg);
4299 if (arg->obfd == NULL)
4300 return 0;
4301
4302 htab_traverse (from->got_page_entries, mips_elf_make_got_pages_per_bfd, arg);
4303 if (arg->obfd == NULL)
4304 return 0;
4305
4306 /* We don't have to worry about releasing memory of the actual
4307 got entries, since they're all in the master got_entries hash
4308 table anyway. */
4309 htab_delete (from->got_entries);
4310 htab_delete (from->got_page_entries);
4311 return 1;
4312 }
4313
4314 /* Attempt to merge gots of different input bfds. Try to use as much
4315 as possible of the primary got, since it doesn't require explicit
4316 dynamic relocations, but don't use bfds that would reference global
4317 symbols out of the addressable range. Failing the primary got,
4318 attempt to merge with the current got, or finish the current got
4319 and then make make the new got current. */
4320
4321 static int
4322 mips_elf_merge_gots (void **bfd2got_, void *p)
4323 {
4324 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfd2got
4325 = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)*bfd2got_;
4326 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
4327 struct mips_got_info *g;
4328 unsigned int estimate;
4329 int result;
4330
4331 g = bfd2got->g;
4332
4333 /* Work out the number of page, local and TLS entries. */
4334 estimate = arg->max_pages;
4335 if (estimate > g->page_gotno)
4336 estimate = g->page_gotno;
4337 estimate += g->local_gotno + g->tls_gotno;
4338
4339 /* We place TLS GOT entries after both locals and globals. The globals
4340 for the primary GOT may overflow the normal GOT size limit, so be
4341 sure not to merge a GOT which requires TLS with the primary GOT in that
4342 case. This doesn't affect non-primary GOTs. */
4343 estimate += (g->tls_gotno > 0 ? arg->global_count : g->global_gotno);
4344
4345 if (estimate <= arg->max_count)
4346 {
4347 /* If we don't have a primary GOT, use it as
4348 a starting point for the primary GOT. */
4349 if (!arg->primary)
4350 {
4351 arg->primary = bfd2got->g;
4352 return 1;
4353 }
4354
4355 /* Try merging with the primary GOT. */
4356 result = mips_elf_merge_got_with (bfd2got, arg->primary, arg);
4357 if (result >= 0)
4358 return result;
4359 }
4360
4361 /* If we can merge with the last-created got, do it. */
4362 if (arg->current)
4363 {
4364 result = mips_elf_merge_got_with (bfd2got, arg->current, arg);
4365 if (result >= 0)
4366 return result;
4367 }
4368
4369 /* Well, we couldn't merge, so create a new GOT. Don't check if it
4370 fits; if it turns out that it doesn't, we'll get relocation
4371 overflows anyway. */
4372 g->next = arg->current;
4373 arg->current = g;
4374
4375 return 1;
4376 }
4377
4378 /* Set the TLS GOT index for the GOT entry in ENTRYP. ENTRYP's NEXT field
4379 is null iff there is just a single GOT. */
4380
4381 static int
4382 mips_elf_initialize_tls_index (void **entryp, void *p)
4383 {
4384 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
4385 struct mips_got_info *g = p;
4386 bfd_vma next_index;
4387 unsigned char tls_type;
4388
4389 /* We're only interested in TLS symbols. */
4390 if (entry->tls_type == 0)
4391 return 1;
4392
4393 next_index = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (entry->abfd) * (long) g->tls_assigned_gotno;
4394
4395 if (entry->symndx == -1 && g->next == NULL)
4396 {
4397 /* A type (3) got entry in the single-GOT case. We use the symbol's
4398 hash table entry to track its index. */
4399 if (entry->d.h->tls_type & GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE)
4400 return 1;
4401 entry->d.h->tls_type |= GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE;
4402 entry->d.h->tls_got_offset = next_index;
4403 tls_type = entry->d.h->tls_type;
4404 }
4405 else
4406 {
4407 if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
4408 {
4409 /* There are separate mips_got_entry objects for each input bfd
4410 that requires an LDM entry. Make sure that all LDM entries in
4411 a GOT resolve to the same index. */
4412 if (g->tls_ldm_offset != MINUS_TWO && g->tls_ldm_offset != MINUS_ONE)
4413 {
4414 entry->gotidx = g->tls_ldm_offset;
4415 return 1;
4416 }
4417 g->tls_ldm_offset = next_index;
4418 }
4419 entry->gotidx = next_index;
4420 tls_type = entry->tls_type;
4421 }
4422
4423 /* Account for the entries we've just allocated. */
4424 if (tls_type & (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_LDM))
4425 g->tls_assigned_gotno += 2;
4426 if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
4427 g->tls_assigned_gotno += 1;
4428
4429 return 1;
4430 }
4431
4432 /* If passed a NULL mips_got_info in the argument, set the marker used
4433 to tell whether a global symbol needs a got entry (in the primary
4434 got) to the given VALUE.
4435
4436 If passed a pointer G to a mips_got_info in the argument (it must
4437 not be the primary GOT), compute the offset from the beginning of
4438 the (primary) GOT section to the entry in G corresponding to the
4439 global symbol. G's assigned_gotno must contain the index of the
4440 first available global GOT entry in G. VALUE must contain the size
4441 of a GOT entry in bytes. For each global GOT entry that requires a
4442 dynamic relocation, NEEDED_RELOCS is incremented, and the symbol is
4443 marked as not eligible for lazy resolution through a function
4444 stub. */
4445 static int
4446 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset (void **entryp, void *p)
4447 {
4448 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
4449 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *arg
4450 = (struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *)p;
4451 struct mips_got_info *g = arg->g;
4452
4453 if (g && entry->tls_type != GOT_NORMAL)
4454 arg->needed_relocs +=
4455 mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, entry->tls_type,
4456 entry->symndx == -1 ? &entry->d.h->root : NULL);
4457
4458 if (entry->abfd != NULL
4459 && entry->symndx == -1
4460 && entry->d.h->global_got_area != GGA_NONE)
4461 {
4462 if (g)
4463 {
4464 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotsym == NULL);
4465
4466 entry->gotidx = arg->value * (long) g->assigned_gotno++;
4467 if (arg->info->shared
4468 || (elf_hash_table (arg->info)->dynamic_sections_created
4469 && entry->d.h->root.def_dynamic
4470 && !entry->d.h->root.def_regular))
4471 ++arg->needed_relocs;
4472 }
4473 else
4474 entry->d.h->global_got_area = arg->value;
4475 }
4476
4477 return 1;
4478 }
4479
4480 /* A htab_traverse callback for GOT entries for which DATA is the
4481 bfd_link_info. Forbid any global symbols from having traditional
4482 lazy-binding stubs. */
4483
4484 static int
4485 mips_elf_forbid_lazy_stubs (void **entryp, void *data)
4486 {
4487 struct bfd_link_info *info;
4488 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4489 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
4490
4491 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
4492 info = (struct bfd_link_info *) data;
4493 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4494 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
4495
4496 if (entry->abfd != NULL
4497 && entry->symndx == -1
4498 && entry->d.h->needs_lazy_stub)
4499 {
4500 entry->d.h->needs_lazy_stub = FALSE;
4501 htab->lazy_stub_count--;
4502 }
4503
4504 return 1;
4505 }
4506
4507 /* Return the offset of an input bfd IBFD's GOT from the beginning of
4508 the primary GOT. */
4509 static bfd_vma
4510 mips_elf_adjust_gp (bfd *abfd, struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
4511 {
4512 if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
4513 return 0;
4514
4515 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
4516 if (! g)
4517 return 0;
4518
4519 BFD_ASSERT (g->next);
4520
4521 g = g->next;
4522
4523 return (g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno)
4524 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
4525 }
4526
4527 /* Turn a single GOT that is too big for 16-bit addressing into
4528 a sequence of GOTs, each one 16-bit addressable. */
4529
4530 static bfd_boolean
4531 mips_elf_multi_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4532 asection *got, bfd_size_type pages)
4533 {
4534 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4535 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg got_per_bfd_arg;
4536 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg;
4537 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
4538 unsigned int assign, needed_relocs;
4539 bfd *dynobj;
4540
4541 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
4542 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4543 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
4544
4545 g = htab->got_info;
4546 g->bfd2got = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash,
4547 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq, NULL);
4548 if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
4549 return FALSE;
4550
4551 got_per_bfd_arg.bfd2got = g->bfd2got;
4552 got_per_bfd_arg.obfd = abfd;
4553 got_per_bfd_arg.info = info;
4554
4555 /* Count how many GOT entries each input bfd requires, creating a
4556 map from bfd to got info while at that. */
4557 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd, &got_per_bfd_arg);
4558 if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
4559 return FALSE;
4560
4561 /* Also count how many page entries each input bfd requires. */
4562 htab_traverse (g->got_page_entries, mips_elf_make_got_pages_per_bfd,
4563 &got_per_bfd_arg);
4564 if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
4565 return FALSE;
4566
4567 got_per_bfd_arg.current = NULL;
4568 got_per_bfd_arg.primary = NULL;
4569 got_per_bfd_arg.max_count = ((MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (info)
4570 / MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd))
4571 - htab->reserved_gotno);
4572 got_per_bfd_arg.max_pages = pages;
4573 /* The number of globals that will be included in the primary GOT.
4574 See the calls to mips_elf_set_global_got_offset below for more
4575 information. */
4576 got_per_bfd_arg.global_count = g->global_gotno;
4577
4578 /* Try to merge the GOTs of input bfds together, as long as they
4579 don't seem to exceed the maximum GOT size, choosing one of them
4580 to be the primary GOT. */
4581 htab_traverse (g->bfd2got, mips_elf_merge_gots, &got_per_bfd_arg);
4582 if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
4583 return FALSE;
4584
4585 /* If we do not find any suitable primary GOT, create an empty one. */
4586 if (got_per_bfd_arg.primary == NULL)
4587 {
4588 g->next = (struct mips_got_info *)
4589 bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info));
4590 if (g->next == NULL)
4591 return FALSE;
4592
4593 g->next->global_gotsym = NULL;
4594 g->next->global_gotno = 0;
4595 g->next->reloc_only_gotno = 0;
4596 g->next->local_gotno = 0;
4597 g->next->page_gotno = 0;
4598 g->next->tls_gotno = 0;
4599 g->next->assigned_gotno = 0;
4600 g->next->tls_assigned_gotno = 0;
4601 g->next->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
4602 g->next->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
4603 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq,
4604 NULL);
4605 if (g->next->got_entries == NULL)
4606 return FALSE;
4607 g->next->got_page_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_got_page_entry_hash,
4608 mips_got_page_entry_eq,
4609 NULL);
4610 if (g->next->got_page_entries == NULL)
4611 return FALSE;
4612 g->next->bfd2got = NULL;
4613 }
4614 else
4615 g->next = got_per_bfd_arg.primary;
4616 g->next->next = got_per_bfd_arg.current;
4617
4618 /* GG is now the master GOT, and G is the primary GOT. */
4619 gg = g;
4620 g = g->next;
4621
4622 /* Map the output bfd to the primary got. That's what we're going
4623 to use for bfds that use GOT16 or GOT_PAGE relocations that we
4624 didn't mark in check_relocs, and we want a quick way to find it.
4625 We can't just use gg->next because we're going to reverse the
4626 list. */
4627 {
4628 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfdgot;
4629 void **bfdgotp;
4630
4631 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)bfd_alloc
4632 (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash));
4633
4634 if (bfdgot == NULL)
4635 return FALSE;
4636
4637 bfdgot->bfd = abfd;
4638 bfdgot->g = g;
4639 bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (gg->bfd2got, bfdgot, INSERT);
4640
4641 BFD_ASSERT (*bfdgotp == NULL);
4642 *bfdgotp = bfdgot;
4643 }
4644
4645 /* Every symbol that is referenced in a dynamic relocation must be
4646 present in the primary GOT, so arrange for them to appear after
4647 those that are actually referenced. */
4648 gg->reloc_only_gotno = gg->global_gotno - g->global_gotno;
4649 g->global_gotno = gg->global_gotno;
4650
4651 set_got_offset_arg.g = NULL;
4652 set_got_offset_arg.value = GGA_RELOC_ONLY;
4653 htab_traverse (gg->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
4654 &set_got_offset_arg);
4655 set_got_offset_arg.value = GGA_NORMAL;
4656 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
4657 &set_got_offset_arg);
4658
4659 /* Now go through the GOTs assigning them offset ranges.
4660 [assigned_gotno, local_gotno[ will be set to the range of local
4661 entries in each GOT. We can then compute the end of a GOT by
4662 adding local_gotno to global_gotno. We reverse the list and make
4663 it circular since then we'll be able to quickly compute the
4664 beginning of a GOT, by computing the end of its predecessor. To
4665 avoid special cases for the primary GOT, while still preserving
4666 assertions that are valid for both single- and multi-got links,
4667 we arrange for the main got struct to have the right number of
4668 global entries, but set its local_gotno such that the initial
4669 offset of the primary GOT is zero. Remember that the primary GOT
4670 will become the last item in the circular linked list, so it
4671 points back to the master GOT. */
4672 gg->local_gotno = -g->global_gotno;
4673 gg->global_gotno = g->global_gotno;
4674 gg->tls_gotno = 0;
4675 assign = 0;
4676 gg->next = gg;
4677
4678 do
4679 {
4680 struct mips_got_info *gn;
4681
4682 assign += htab->reserved_gotno;
4683 g->assigned_gotno = assign;
4684 g->local_gotno += assign;
4685 g->local_gotno += (pages < g->page_gotno ? pages : g->page_gotno);
4686 assign = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno;
4687
4688 /* Take g out of the direct list, and push it onto the reversed
4689 list that gg points to. g->next is guaranteed to be nonnull after
4690 this operation, as required by mips_elf_initialize_tls_index. */
4691 gn = g->next;
4692 g->next = gg->next;
4693 gg->next = g;
4694
4695 /* Set up any TLS entries. We always place the TLS entries after
4696 all non-TLS entries. */
4697 g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno;
4698 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, g);
4699
4700 /* Move onto the next GOT. It will be a secondary GOT if nonull. */
4701 g = gn;
4702
4703 /* Forbid global symbols in every non-primary GOT from having
4704 lazy-binding stubs. */
4705 if (g)
4706 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_forbid_lazy_stubs, info);
4707 }
4708 while (g);
4709
4710 got->size = (gg->next->local_gotno
4711 + gg->next->global_gotno
4712 + gg->next->tls_gotno) * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
4713
4714 needed_relocs = 0;
4715 set_got_offset_arg.value = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
4716 set_got_offset_arg.info = info;
4717 for (g = gg->next; g && g->next != gg; g = g->next)
4718 {
4719 unsigned int save_assign;
4720
4721 /* Assign offsets to global GOT entries. */
4722 save_assign = g->assigned_gotno;
4723 g->assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno;
4724 set_got_offset_arg.g = g;
4725 set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs = 0;
4726 htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
4727 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
4728 &set_got_offset_arg);
4729 needed_relocs += set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs;
4730 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno - g->local_gotno <= g->global_gotno);
4731
4732 g->assigned_gotno = save_assign;
4733 if (info->shared)
4734 {
4735 needed_relocs += g->local_gotno - g->assigned_gotno;
4736 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno == g->next->local_gotno
4737 + g->next->global_gotno
4738 + g->next->tls_gotno
4739 + htab->reserved_gotno);
4740 }
4741 }
4742
4743 if (needed_relocs)
4744 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info,
4745 needed_relocs);
4746
4747 return TRUE;
4748 }
4749
4750 \f
4751 /* Returns the first relocation of type r_type found, beginning with
4752 RELOCATION. RELEND is one-past-the-end of the relocation table. */
4753
4754 static const Elf_Internal_Rela *
4755 mips_elf_next_relocation (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int r_type,
4756 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
4757 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend)
4758 {
4759 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocation->r_info);
4760
4761 while (relocation < relend)
4762 {
4763 if (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_type
4764 && ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_symndx)
4765 return relocation;
4766
4767 ++relocation;
4768 }
4769
4770 /* We didn't find it. */
4771 return NULL;
4772 }
4773
4774 /* Return whether an input relocation is against a local symbol. */
4775
4776 static bfd_boolean
4777 mips_elf_local_relocation_p (bfd *input_bfd,
4778 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
4779 asection **local_sections)
4780 {
4781 unsigned long r_symndx;
4782 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4783 size_t extsymoff;
4784
4785 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
4786 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
4787 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
4788
4789 if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
4790 return TRUE;
4791 if (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd) && local_sections[r_symndx] != NULL)
4792 return TRUE;
4793
4794 return FALSE;
4795 }
4796 \f
4797 /* Sign-extend VALUE, which has the indicated number of BITS. */
4798
4799 bfd_vma
4800 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (bfd_vma value, int bits)
4801 {
4802 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bits - 1)))
4803 /* VALUE is negative. */
4804 value |= ((bfd_vma) - 1) << bits;
4805
4806 return value;
4807 }
4808
4809 /* Return non-zero if the indicated VALUE has overflowed the maximum
4810 range expressible by a signed number with the indicated number of
4811 BITS. */
4812
4813 static bfd_boolean
4814 mips_elf_overflow_p (bfd_vma value, int bits)
4815 {
4816 bfd_signed_vma svalue = (bfd_signed_vma) value;
4817
4818 if (svalue > (1 << (bits - 1)) - 1)
4819 /* The value is too big. */
4820 return TRUE;
4821 else if (svalue < -(1 << (bits - 1)))
4822 /* The value is too small. */
4823 return TRUE;
4824
4825 /* All is well. */
4826 return FALSE;
4827 }
4828
4829 /* Calculate the %high function. */
4830
4831 static bfd_vma
4832 mips_elf_high (bfd_vma value)
4833 {
4834 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
4835 }
4836
4837 /* Calculate the %higher function. */
4838
4839 static bfd_vma
4840 mips_elf_higher (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4841 {
4842 #ifdef BFD64
4843 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000) >> 32) & 0xffff;
4844 #else
4845 abort ();
4846 return MINUS_ONE;
4847 #endif
4848 }
4849
4850 /* Calculate the %highest function. */
4851
4852 static bfd_vma
4853 mips_elf_highest (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4854 {
4855 #ifdef BFD64
4856 return ((value + (((bfd_vma) 0x8000 << 32) | 0x80008000)) >> 48) & 0xffff;
4857 #else
4858 abort ();
4859 return MINUS_ONE;
4860 #endif
4861 }
4862 \f
4863 /* Create the .compact_rel section. */
4864
4865 static bfd_boolean
4866 mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section
4867 (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4868 {
4869 flagword flags;
4870 register asection *s;
4871
4872 if (bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".compact_rel") == NULL)
4873 {
4874 flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
4875 | SEC_READONLY);
4876
4877 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".compact_rel", flags);
4878 if (s == NULL
4879 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
4880 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
4881 return FALSE;
4882
4883 s->size = sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel);
4884 }
4885
4886 return TRUE;
4887 }
4888
4889 /* Create the .got section to hold the global offset table. */
4890
4891 static bfd_boolean
4892 mips_elf_create_got_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4893 {
4894 flagword flags;
4895 register asection *s;
4896 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4897 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
4898 struct mips_got_info *g;
4899 bfd_size_type amt;
4900 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4901
4902 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4903 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
4904
4905 /* This function may be called more than once. */
4906 if (htab->sgot)
4907 return TRUE;
4908
4909 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
4910 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
4911
4912 /* We have to use an alignment of 2**4 here because this is hardcoded
4913 in the function stub generation and in the linker script. */
4914 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".got", flags);
4915 if (s == NULL
4916 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
4917 return FALSE;
4918 htab->sgot = s;
4919
4920 /* Define the symbol _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. We don't do this in the
4921 linker script because we don't want to define the symbol if we
4922 are not creating a global offset table. */
4923 bh = NULL;
4924 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
4925 (info, abfd, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_", BSF_GLOBAL, s,
4926 0, NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
4927 return FALSE;
4928
4929 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
4930 h->non_elf = 0;
4931 h->def_regular = 1;
4932 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
4933 elf_hash_table (info)->hgot = h;
4934
4935 if (info->shared
4936 && ! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
4937 return FALSE;
4938
4939 amt = sizeof (struct mips_got_info);
4940 g = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4941 if (g == NULL)
4942 return FALSE;
4943 g->global_gotsym = NULL;
4944 g->global_gotno = 0;
4945 g->reloc_only_gotno = 0;
4946 g->tls_gotno = 0;
4947 g->local_gotno = 0;
4948 g->page_gotno = 0;
4949 g->assigned_gotno = 0;
4950 g->bfd2got = NULL;
4951 g->next = NULL;
4952 g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
4953 g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_got_entry_hash,
4954 mips_elf_got_entry_eq, NULL);
4955 if (g->got_entries == NULL)
4956 return FALSE;
4957 g->got_page_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_got_page_entry_hash,
4958 mips_got_page_entry_eq, NULL);
4959 if (g->got_page_entries == NULL)
4960 return FALSE;
4961 htab->got_info = g;
4962 mips_elf_section_data (s)->elf.this_hdr.sh_flags
4963 |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
4964
4965 /* We also need a .got.plt section when generating PLTs. */
4966 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".got.plt",
4967 SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
4968 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
4969 | SEC_IN_MEMORY
4970 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
4971 if (s == NULL)
4972 return FALSE;
4973 htab->sgotplt = s;
4974
4975 return TRUE;
4976 }
4977 \f
4978 /* Return true if H refers to the special VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ or
4979 __GOTT_INDEX__ symbols. These symbols are only special for
4980 shared objects; they are not used in executables. */
4981
4982 static bfd_boolean
4983 is_gott_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4984 {
4985 return (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->is_vxworks
4986 && info->shared
4987 && (strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__GOTT_BASE__") == 0
4988 || strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__GOTT_INDEX__") == 0));
4989 }
4990
4991 /* Return TRUE if a relocation of type R_TYPE from INPUT_BFD might
4992 require an la25 stub. See also mips_elf_local_pic_function_p,
4993 which determines whether the destination function ever requires a
4994 stub. */
4995
4996 static bfd_boolean
4997 mips_elf_relocation_needs_la25_stub (bfd *input_bfd, int r_type,
4998 bfd_boolean target_is_16_bit_code_p)
4999 {
5000 /* We specifically ignore branches and jumps from EF_PIC objects,
5001 where the onus is on the compiler or programmer to perform any
5002 necessary initialization of $25. Sometimes such initialization
5003 is unnecessary; for example, -mno-shared functions do not use
5004 the incoming value of $25, and may therefore be called directly. */
5005 if (PIC_OBJECT_P (input_bfd))
5006 return FALSE;
5007
5008 switch (r_type)
5009 {
5010 case R_MIPS_26:
5011 case R_MIPS_PC16:
5012 case R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
5013 case R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1:
5014 case R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1:
5015 case R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1:
5016 case R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2:
5017 return TRUE;
5018
5019 case R_MIPS16_26:
5020 return !target_is_16_bit_code_p;
5021
5022 default:
5023 return FALSE;
5024 }
5025 }
5026 \f
5027 /* Calculate the value produced by the RELOCATION (which comes from
5028 the INPUT_BFD). The ADDEND is the addend to use for this
5029 RELOCATION; RELOCATION->R_ADDEND is ignored.
5030
5031 The result of the relocation calculation is stored in VALUEP.
5032 On exit, set *CROSS_MODE_JUMP_P to true if the relocation field
5033 is a MIPS16 or microMIPS jump to standard MIPS code, or vice versa.
5034
5035 This function returns bfd_reloc_continue if the caller need take no
5036 further action regarding this relocation, bfd_reloc_notsupported if
5037 something goes dramatically wrong, bfd_reloc_overflow if an
5038 overflow occurs, and bfd_reloc_ok to indicate success. */
5039
5040 static bfd_reloc_status_type
5041 mips_elf_calculate_relocation (bfd *abfd, bfd *input_bfd,
5042 asection *input_section,
5043 struct bfd_link_info *info,
5044 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
5045 bfd_vma addend, reloc_howto_type *howto,
5046 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
5047 asection **local_sections, bfd_vma *valuep,
5048 const char **namep,
5049 bfd_boolean *cross_mode_jump_p,
5050 bfd_boolean save_addend)
5051 {
5052 /* The eventual value we will return. */
5053 bfd_vma value;
5054 /* The address of the symbol against which the relocation is
5055 occurring. */
5056 bfd_vma symbol = 0;
5057 /* The final GP value to be used for the relocatable, executable, or
5058 shared object file being produced. */
5059 bfd_vma gp;
5060 /* The place (section offset or address) of the storage unit being
5061 relocated. */
5062 bfd_vma p;
5063 /* The value of GP used to create the relocatable object. */
5064 bfd_vma gp0;
5065 /* The offset into the global offset table at which the address of
5066 the relocation entry symbol, adjusted by the addend, resides
5067 during execution. */
5068 bfd_vma g = MINUS_ONE;
5069 /* The section in which the symbol referenced by the relocation is
5070 located. */
5071 asection *sec = NULL;
5072 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
5073 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is a local
5074 symbol. */
5075 bfd_boolean local_p, was_local_p;
5076 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is "_gp_disp". */
5077 bfd_boolean gp_disp_p = FALSE;
5078 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is
5079 "__gnu_local_gp". */
5080 bfd_boolean gnu_local_gp_p = FALSE;
5081 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5082 size_t extsymoff;
5083 unsigned long r_symndx;
5084 int r_type;
5085 /* TRUE if overflow occurred during the calculation of the
5086 relocation value. */
5087 bfd_boolean overflowed_p;
5088 /* TRUE if this relocation refers to a MIPS16 function. */
5089 bfd_boolean target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
5090 bfd_boolean target_is_micromips_code_p = FALSE;
5091 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5092 bfd *dynobj;
5093
5094 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
5095 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
5096 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
5097
5098 /* Parse the relocation. */
5099 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
5100 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
5101 p = (input_section->output_section->vma
5102 + input_section->output_offset
5103 + relocation->r_offset);
5104
5105 /* Assume that there will be no overflow. */
5106 overflowed_p = FALSE;
5107
5108 /* Figure out whether or not the symbol is local, and get the offset
5109 used in the array of hash table entries. */
5110 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
5111 local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
5112 local_sections);
5113 was_local_p = local_p;
5114 if (! elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
5115 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5116 else
5117 {
5118 /* The symbol table does not follow the rule that local symbols
5119 must come before globals. */
5120 extsymoff = 0;
5121 }
5122
5123 /* Figure out the value of the symbol. */
5124 if (local_p)
5125 {
5126 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
5127
5128 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
5129 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
5130
5131 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
5132 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) != STT_SECTION
5133 || (sec->flags & SEC_MERGE))
5134 symbol += sym->st_value;
5135 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
5136 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
5137 {
5138 addend = _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (abfd, sym, &sec, addend);
5139 addend -= symbol;
5140 addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
5141 }
5142
5143 /* MIPS16/microMIPS text labels should be treated as odd. */
5144 if (ELF_ST_IS_COMPRESSED (sym->st_other))
5145 ++symbol;
5146
5147 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
5148 *namep = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (input_bfd,
5149 symtab_hdr->sh_link,
5150 sym->st_name);
5151 if (*namep == '\0')
5152 *namep = bfd_section_name (input_bfd, sec);
5153
5154 target_is_16_bit_code_p = ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (sym->st_other);
5155 target_is_micromips_code_p = ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (sym->st_other);
5156 }
5157 else
5158 {
5159 /* ??? Could we use RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL here ? */
5160
5161 /* For global symbols we look up the symbol in the hash-table. */
5162 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
5163 elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
5164 /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol. */
5165 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
5166 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
5167 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
5168
5169 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
5170 *namep = h->root.root.root.string;
5171
5172 /* See if this is the special _gp_disp symbol. Note that such a
5173 symbol must always be a global symbol. */
5174 if (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0
5175 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
5176 {
5177 /* Relocations against _gp_disp are permitted only with
5178 R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16 relocations. */
5179 if (!hi16_reloc_p (r_type) && !lo16_reloc_p (r_type))
5180 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
5181
5182 gp_disp_p = TRUE;
5183 }
5184 /* See if this is the special _gp symbol. Note that such a
5185 symbol must always be a global symbol. */
5186 else if (strcmp (*namep, "__gnu_local_gp") == 0)
5187 gnu_local_gp_p = TRUE;
5188
5189
5190 /* If this symbol is defined, calculate its address. Note that
5191 _gp_disp is a magic symbol, always implicitly defined by the
5192 linker, so it's inappropriate to check to see whether or not
5193 its defined. */
5194 else if ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5195 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5196 && h->root.root.u.def.section)
5197 {
5198 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
5199 if (sec->output_section)
5200 symbol = (h->root.root.u.def.value
5201 + sec->output_section->vma
5202 + sec->output_offset);
5203 else
5204 symbol = h->root.root.u.def.value;
5205 }
5206 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5207 /* We allow relocations against undefined weak symbols, giving
5208 it the value zero, so that you can undefined weak functions
5209 and check to see if they exist by looking at their
5210 addresses. */
5211 symbol = 0;
5212 else if (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_IGNORE
5213 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5214 symbol = 0;
5215 else if (strcmp (*namep, SGI_COMPAT (input_bfd)
5216 ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
5217 {
5218 /* If this is a dynamic link, we should have created a
5219 _DYNAMIC_LINK symbol or _DYNAMIC_LINKING(for normal mips) symbol
5220 in in _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections.
5221 Otherwise, we should define the symbol with a value of 0.
5222 FIXME: It should probably get into the symbol table
5223 somehow as well. */
5224 BFD_ASSERT (! info->shared);
5225 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") == NULL);
5226 symbol = 0;
5227 }
5228 else if (ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (h->root.other))
5229 {
5230 /* This is an optional symbol - an Irix specific extension to the
5231 ELF spec. Ignore it for now.
5232 XXX - FIXME - there is more to the spec for OPTIONAL symbols
5233 than simply ignoring them, but we do not handle this for now.
5234 For information see the "64-bit ELF Object File Specification"
5235 which is available from here:
5236 http://techpubs.sgi.com/library/manuals/4000/007-4658-001/pdf/007-4658-001.pdf */
5237 symbol = 0;
5238 }
5239 else if ((*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
5240 (info, h->root.root.root.string, input_bfd,
5241 input_section, relocation->r_offset,
5242 (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_GENERATE_ERROR)
5243 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other)))
5244 {
5245 return bfd_reloc_undefined;
5246 }
5247 else
5248 {
5249 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
5250 }
5251
5252 target_is_16_bit_code_p = ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->root.other);
5253 /* If the output section is the PLT section,
5254 then the target is not microMIPS. */
5255 target_is_micromips_code_p = (htab->splt != sec
5256 && ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (h->root.other));
5257 }
5258
5259 /* If this is a reference to a 16-bit function with a stub, we need
5260 to redirect the relocation to the stub unless:
5261
5262 (a) the relocation is for a MIPS16 JAL;
5263
5264 (b) the relocation is for a MIPS16 PIC call, and there are no
5265 non-MIPS16 uses of the GOT slot; or
5266
5267 (c) the section allows direct references to MIPS16 functions. */
5268 if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26
5269 && !info->relocatable
5270 && ((h != NULL
5271 && h->fn_stub != NULL
5272 && (r_type != R_MIPS16_CALL16 || h->need_fn_stub))
5273 || (local_p
5274 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs != NULL
5275 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
5276 && !section_allows_mips16_refs_p (input_section))
5277 {
5278 /* This is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function. We should
5279 have already noticed that we were going to need the
5280 stub. */
5281 if (local_p)
5282 {
5283 sec = elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx];
5284 value = 0;
5285 }
5286 else
5287 {
5288 BFD_ASSERT (h->need_fn_stub);
5289 if (h->la25_stub)
5290 {
5291 /* If a LA25 header for the stub itself exists, point to the
5292 prepended LUI/ADDIU sequence. */
5293 sec = h->la25_stub->stub_section;
5294 value = h->la25_stub->offset;
5295 }
5296 else
5297 {
5298 sec = h->fn_stub;
5299 value = 0;
5300 }
5301 }
5302
5303 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + value;
5304 /* The target is 16-bit, but the stub isn't. */
5305 target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
5306 }
5307 /* If this is a 16-bit call to a 32- or 64-bit function with a stub, we
5308 need to redirect the call to the stub. Note that we specifically
5309 exclude R_MIPS16_CALL16 from this behavior; indirect calls should
5310 use an indirect stub instead. */
5311 else if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable
5312 && ((h != NULL && (h->call_stub != NULL || h->call_fp_stub != NULL))
5313 || (local_p
5314 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs != NULL
5315 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
5316 && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
5317 {
5318 if (local_p)
5319 sec = elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx];
5320 else
5321 {
5322 /* If both call_stub and call_fp_stub are defined, we can figure
5323 out which one to use by checking which one appears in the input
5324 file. */
5325 if (h->call_stub != NULL && h->call_fp_stub != NULL)
5326 {
5327 asection *o;
5328
5329 sec = NULL;
5330 for (o = input_bfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
5331 {
5332 if (CALL_FP_STUB_P (bfd_get_section_name (input_bfd, o)))
5333 {
5334 sec = h->call_fp_stub;
5335 break;
5336 }
5337 }
5338 if (sec == NULL)
5339 sec = h->call_stub;
5340 }
5341 else if (h->call_stub != NULL)
5342 sec = h->call_stub;
5343 else
5344 sec = h->call_fp_stub;
5345 }
5346
5347 BFD_ASSERT (sec->size > 0);
5348 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
5349 }
5350 /* If this is a direct call to a PIC function, redirect to the
5351 non-PIC stub. */
5352 else if (h != NULL && h->la25_stub
5353 && mips_elf_relocation_needs_la25_stub (input_bfd, r_type,
5354 target_is_16_bit_code_p))
5355 symbol = (h->la25_stub->stub_section->output_section->vma
5356 + h->la25_stub->stub_section->output_offset
5357 + h->la25_stub->offset);
5358
5359 /* Make sure MIPS16 and microMIPS are not used together. */
5360 if ((r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && target_is_micromips_code_p)
5361 || (micromips_branch_reloc_p (r_type) && target_is_16_bit_code_p))
5362 {
5363 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5364 (_("MIPS16 and microMIPS functions cannot call each other"));
5365 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
5366 }
5367
5368 /* Calls from 16-bit code to 32-bit code and vice versa require the
5369 mode change. However, we can ignore calls to undefined weak symbols,
5370 which should never be executed at runtime. This exception is important
5371 because the assembly writer may have "known" that any definition of the
5372 symbol would be 16-bit code, and that direct jumps were therefore
5373 acceptable. */
5374 *cross_mode_jump_p = (!info->relocatable
5375 && !(h && h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5376 && ((r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
5377 || (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_26_S1
5378 && !target_is_micromips_code_p)
5379 || ((r_type == R_MIPS_26 || r_type == R_MIPS_JALR)
5380 && (target_is_16_bit_code_p
5381 || target_is_micromips_code_p))));
5382
5383 local_p = (h == NULL
5384 || (h->got_only_for_calls
5385 ? SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, &h->root)
5386 : SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->root)));
5387
5388 gp0 = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
5389 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (abfd);
5390 if (htab->got_info)
5391 gp += mips_elf_adjust_gp (abfd, htab->got_info, input_bfd);
5392
5393 if (gnu_local_gp_p)
5394 symbol = gp;
5395
5396 /* Global R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE/R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE relocations are equivalent
5397 to R_MIPS_GOT_DISP/R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP. The addend is applied by the
5398 corresponding R_MIPS_GOT_OFST/R_MICROMIPS_GOT_OFST. */
5399 if (got_page_reloc_p (r_type) && !local_p)
5400 {
5401 r_type = (micromips_reloc_p (r_type)
5402 ? R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP : R_MIPS_GOT_DISP);
5403 addend = 0;
5404 }
5405
5406 /* If we haven't already determined the GOT offset, and we're going
5407 to need it, get it now. */
5408 switch (r_type)
5409 {
5410 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
5411 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
5412 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
5413 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
5414 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
5415 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
5416 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
5417 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
5418 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
5419 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
5420 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
5421 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP:
5422 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
5423 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
5424 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
5425 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
5426 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
5427 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
5428 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
5429 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
5430 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
5431 case R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
5432 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD:
5433 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
5434 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM:
5435 /* Find the index into the GOT where this value is located. */
5436 if (tls_ldm_reloc_p (r_type))
5437 {
5438 g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd, info,
5439 0, 0, NULL, r_type);
5440 if (g == MINUS_ONE)
5441 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
5442 }
5443 else if (!local_p)
5444 {
5445 /* On VxWorks, CALL relocations should refer to the .got.plt
5446 entry, which is initialized to point at the PLT stub. */
5447 if (htab->is_vxworks
5448 && (call_hi16_reloc_p (r_type)
5449 || call_lo16_reloc_p (r_type)
5450 || call16_reloc_p (r_type)))
5451 {
5452 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
5453 BFD_ASSERT (h->root.needs_plt);
5454 g = mips_elf_gotplt_index (info, &h->root);
5455 }
5456 else
5457 {
5458 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
5459 g = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, input_bfd,
5460 &h->root, r_type, info);
5461 if (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL
5462 && !elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5463 /* This is a static link. We must initialize the GOT entry. */
5464 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (dynobj, symbol, htab->sgot->contents + g);
5465 }
5466 }
5467 else if (!htab->is_vxworks
5468 && (call16_reloc_p (r_type) || got16_reloc_p (r_type)))
5469 /* The calculation below does not involve "g". */
5470 break;
5471 else
5472 {
5473 g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd, info,
5474 symbol + addend, r_symndx, h, r_type);
5475 if (g == MINUS_ONE)
5476 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
5477 }
5478
5479 /* Convert GOT indices to actual offsets. */
5480 g = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (info, abfd, input_bfd, g);
5481 break;
5482 }
5483
5484 /* Relocations against the VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ and __GOTT_INDEX__
5485 symbols are resolved by the loader. Add them to .rela.dyn. */
5486 if (h != NULL && is_gott_symbol (info, &h->root))
5487 {
5488 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
5489 bfd_byte *loc;
5490 asection *s;
5491
5492 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
5493 loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5494
5495 outrel.r_offset = (input_section->output_section->vma
5496 + input_section->output_offset
5497 + relocation->r_offset);
5498 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->root.dynindx, r_type);
5499 outrel.r_addend = addend;
5500 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (abfd, &outrel, loc);
5501
5502 /* If we've written this relocation for a readonly section,
5503 we need to set DF_TEXTREL again, so that we do not delete the
5504 DT_TEXTREL tag. */
5505 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (input_section))
5506 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5507
5508 *valuep = 0;
5509 return bfd_reloc_ok;
5510 }
5511
5512 /* Figure out what kind of relocation is being performed. */
5513 switch (r_type)
5514 {
5515 case R_MIPS_NONE:
5516 return bfd_reloc_continue;
5517
5518 case R_MIPS_16:
5519 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
5520 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
5521 break;
5522
5523 case R_MIPS_32:
5524 case R_MIPS_REL32:
5525 case R_MIPS_64:
5526 if ((info->shared
5527 || (htab->root.dynamic_sections_created
5528 && h != NULL
5529 && h->root.def_dynamic
5530 && !h->root.def_regular
5531 && !h->has_static_relocs))
5532 && r_symndx != STN_UNDEF
5533 && (h == NULL
5534 || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak
5535 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5536 && (input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
5537 {
5538 /* If we're creating a shared library, then we can't know
5539 where the symbol will end up. So, we create a relocation
5540 record in the output, and leave the job up to the dynamic
5541 linker. We must do the same for executable references to
5542 shared library symbols, unless we've decided to use copy
5543 relocs or PLTs instead. */
5544 value = addend;
5545 if (!mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (abfd,
5546 info,
5547 relocation,
5548 h,
5549 sec,
5550 symbol,
5551 &value,
5552 input_section))
5553 return bfd_reloc_undefined;
5554 }
5555 else
5556 {
5557 if (r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
5558 value = symbol + addend;
5559 else
5560 value = addend;
5561 }
5562 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5563 break;
5564
5565 case R_MIPS_PC32:
5566 value = symbol + addend - p;
5567 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5568 break;
5569
5570 case R_MIPS16_26:
5571 /* The calculation for R_MIPS16_26 is just the same as for an
5572 R_MIPS_26. It's only the storage of the relocated field into
5573 the output file that's different. That's handled in
5574 mips_elf_perform_relocation. So, we just fall through to the
5575 R_MIPS_26 case here. */
5576 case R_MIPS_26:
5577 case R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
5578 {
5579 unsigned int shift;
5580
5581 /* Make sure the target of JALX is word-aligned. Bit 0 must be
5582 the correct ISA mode selector and bit 1 must be 0. */
5583 if (*cross_mode_jump_p && (symbol & 3) != (r_type == R_MIPS_26))
5584 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
5585
5586 /* Shift is 2, unusually, for microMIPS JALX. */
5587 shift = (!*cross_mode_jump_p && r_type == R_MICROMIPS_26_S1) ? 1 : 2;
5588
5589 if (was_local_p)
5590 value = addend | ((p + 4) & (0xfc000000 << shift));
5591 else
5592 value = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 26 + shift);
5593 value = (value + symbol) >> shift;
5594 if (!was_local_p && h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5595 overflowed_p = (value >> 26) != ((p + 4) >> (26 + shift));
5596 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5597 }
5598 break;
5599
5600 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
5601 case R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
5602 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
5603 value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - dtprel_base (info))
5604 & howto->dst_mask);
5605 break;
5606
5607 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
5608 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32:
5609 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64:
5610 case R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
5611 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
5612 value = (symbol + addend - dtprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
5613 break;
5614
5615 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
5616 case R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
5617 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
5618 value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - tprel_base (info))
5619 & howto->dst_mask);
5620 break;
5621
5622 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
5623 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32:
5624 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64:
5625 case R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
5626 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
5627 value = (symbol + addend - tprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
5628 break;
5629
5630 case R_MIPS_HI16:
5631 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
5632 case R_MICROMIPS_HI16:
5633 if (!gp_disp_p)
5634 {
5635 value = mips_elf_high (addend + symbol);
5636 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5637 }
5638 else
5639 {
5640 /* For MIPS16 ABI code we generate this sequence
5641 0: li $v0,%hi(_gp_disp)
5642 4: addiupc $v1,%lo(_gp_disp)
5643 8: sll $v0,16
5644 12: addu $v0,$v1
5645 14: move $gp,$v0
5646 So the offsets of hi and lo relocs are the same, but the
5647 base $pc is that used by the ADDIUPC instruction at $t9 + 4.
5648 ADDIUPC clears the low two bits of the instruction address,
5649 so the base is ($t9 + 4) & ~3. */
5650 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16)
5651 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - ((p + 4) & ~(bfd_vma) 0x3));
5652 /* The microMIPS .cpload sequence uses the same assembly
5653 instructions as the traditional psABI version, but the
5654 incoming $t9 has the low bit set. */
5655 else if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_HI16)
5656 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p - 1);
5657 else
5658 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p);
5659 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
5660 }
5661 break;
5662
5663 case R_MIPS_LO16:
5664 case R_MIPS16_LO16:
5665 case R_MICROMIPS_LO16:
5666 case R_MICROMIPS_HI0_LO16:
5667 if (!gp_disp_p)
5668 value = (symbol + addend) & howto->dst_mask;
5669 else
5670 {
5671 /* See the comment for R_MIPS16_HI16 above for the reason
5672 for this conditional. */
5673 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_LO16)
5674 value = addend + gp - (p & ~(bfd_vma) 0x3);
5675 else if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_LO16
5676 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_HI0_LO16)
5677 value = addend + gp - p + 3;
5678 else
5679 value = addend + gp - p + 4;
5680 /* The MIPS ABI requires checking the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation
5681 for overflow. But, on, say, IRIX5, relocations against
5682 _gp_disp are normally generated from the .cpload
5683 pseudo-op. It generates code that normally looks like
5684 this:
5685
5686 lui $gp,%hi(_gp_disp)
5687 addiu $gp,$gp,%lo(_gp_disp)
5688 addu $gp,$gp,$t9
5689
5690 Here $t9 holds the address of the function being called,
5691 as required by the MIPS ELF ABI. The R_MIPS_LO16
5692 relocation can easily overflow in this situation, but the
5693 R_MIPS_HI16 relocation will handle the overflow.
5694 Therefore, we consider this a bug in the MIPS ABI, and do
5695 not check for overflow here. */
5696 }
5697 break;
5698
5699 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
5700 case R_MICROMIPS_LITERAL:
5701 /* Because we don't merge literal sections, we can handle this
5702 just like R_MIPS_GPREL16. In the long run, we should merge
5703 shared literals, and then we will need to additional work
5704 here. */
5705
5706 /* Fall through. */
5707
5708 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
5709 /* The R_MIPS16_GPREL performs the same calculation as
5710 R_MIPS_GPREL16, but stores the relocated bits in a different
5711 order. We don't need to do anything special here; the
5712 differences are handled in mips_elf_perform_relocation. */
5713 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
5714 case R_MICROMIPS_GPREL7_S2:
5715 case R_MICROMIPS_GPREL16:
5716 /* Only sign-extend the addend if it was extracted from the
5717 instruction. If the addend was separate, leave it alone,
5718 otherwise we may lose significant bits. */
5719 if (howto->partial_inplace)
5720 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
5721 value = symbol + addend - gp;
5722 /* If the symbol was local, any earlier relocatable links will
5723 have adjusted its addend with the gp offset, so compensate
5724 for that now. Don't do it for symbols forced local in this
5725 link, though, since they won't have had the gp offset applied
5726 to them before. */
5727 if (was_local_p)
5728 value += gp0;
5729 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
5730 break;
5731
5732 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
5733 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
5734 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
5735 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
5736 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
5737 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
5738 /* VxWorks does not have separate local and global semantics for
5739 R_MIPS*_GOT16; every relocation evaluates to "G". */
5740 if (!htab->is_vxworks && local_p)
5741 {
5742 value = mips_elf_got16_entry (abfd, input_bfd, info,
5743 symbol + addend, !was_local_p);
5744 if (value == MINUS_ONE)
5745 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
5746 value
5747 = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (info, abfd, input_bfd, value);
5748 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
5749 break;
5750 }
5751
5752 /* Fall through. */
5753
5754 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
5755 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
5756 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
5757 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
5758 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
5759 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
5760 case R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
5761 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD:
5762 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
5763 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM:
5764 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP:
5765 value = g;
5766 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
5767 break;
5768
5769 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
5770 value = (addend + symbol + gp0 - gp);
5771 if (!save_addend)
5772 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5773 break;
5774
5775 case R_MIPS_PC16:
5776 case R_MIPS_GNU_REL16_S2:
5777 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 18) - p;
5778 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 18);
5779 value >>= howto->rightshift;
5780 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5781 break;
5782
5783 case R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1:
5784 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 8) - p;
5785 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 8);
5786 value >>= howto->rightshift;
5787 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5788 break;
5789
5790 case R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1:
5791 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 11) - p;
5792 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 11);
5793 value >>= howto->rightshift;
5794 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5795 break;
5796
5797 case R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1:
5798 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 17) - p;
5799 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 17);
5800 value >>= howto->rightshift;
5801 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5802 break;
5803
5804 case R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2:
5805 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 25) - ((p | 3) ^ 3);
5806 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 25);
5807 value >>= howto->rightshift;
5808 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5809 break;
5810
5811 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
5812 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
5813 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
5814 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
5815 /* We're allowed to handle these two relocations identically.
5816 The dynamic linker is allowed to handle the CALL relocations
5817 differently by creating a lazy evaluation stub. */
5818 value = g;
5819 value = mips_elf_high (value);
5820 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5821 break;
5822
5823 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
5824 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
5825 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
5826 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
5827 value = g & howto->dst_mask;
5828 break;
5829
5830 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
5831 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE:
5832 value = mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, NULL);
5833 if (value == MINUS_ONE)
5834 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
5835 value = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (info, abfd, input_bfd, value);
5836 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
5837 break;
5838
5839 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
5840 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_OFST:
5841 if (local_p)
5842 mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, &value);
5843 else
5844 value = addend;
5845 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
5846 break;
5847
5848 case R_MIPS_SUB:
5849 case R_MICROMIPS_SUB:
5850 value = symbol - addend;
5851 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5852 break;
5853
5854 case R_MIPS_HIGHER:
5855 case R_MICROMIPS_HIGHER:
5856 value = mips_elf_higher (addend + symbol);
5857 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5858 break;
5859
5860 case R_MIPS_HIGHEST:
5861 case R_MICROMIPS_HIGHEST:
5862 value = mips_elf_highest (addend + symbol);
5863 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5864 break;
5865
5866 case R_MIPS_SCN_DISP:
5867 case R_MICROMIPS_SCN_DISP:
5868 value = symbol + addend - sec->output_offset;
5869 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5870 break;
5871
5872 case R_MIPS_JALR:
5873 case R_MICROMIPS_JALR:
5874 /* This relocation is only a hint. In some cases, we optimize
5875 it into a bal instruction. But we don't try to optimize
5876 when the symbol does not resolve locally. */
5877 if (h != NULL && !SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, &h->root))
5878 return bfd_reloc_continue;
5879 value = symbol + addend;
5880 break;
5881
5882 case R_MIPS_PJUMP:
5883 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
5884 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
5885 /* We don't do anything with these at present. */
5886 return bfd_reloc_continue;
5887
5888 default:
5889 /* An unrecognized relocation type. */
5890 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
5891 }
5892
5893 /* Store the VALUE for our caller. */
5894 *valuep = value;
5895 return overflowed_p ? bfd_reloc_overflow : bfd_reloc_ok;
5896 }
5897
5898 /* Obtain the field relocated by RELOCATION. */
5899
5900 static bfd_vma
5901 mips_elf_obtain_contents (reloc_howto_type *howto,
5902 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
5903 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_byte *contents)
5904 {
5905 bfd_vma x;
5906 bfd_byte *location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
5907
5908 /* Obtain the bytes. */
5909 x = bfd_get ((8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto)), input_bfd, location);
5910
5911 return x;
5912 }
5913
5914 /* It has been determined that the result of the RELOCATION is the
5915 VALUE. Use HOWTO to place VALUE into the output file at the
5916 appropriate position. The SECTION is the section to which the
5917 relocation applies.
5918 CROSS_MODE_JUMP_P is true if the relocation field
5919 is a MIPS16 or microMIPS jump to standard MIPS code, or vice versa.
5920
5921 Returns FALSE if anything goes wrong. */
5922
5923 static bfd_boolean
5924 mips_elf_perform_relocation (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5925 reloc_howto_type *howto,
5926 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
5927 bfd_vma value, bfd *input_bfd,
5928 asection *input_section, bfd_byte *contents,
5929 bfd_boolean cross_mode_jump_p)
5930 {
5931 bfd_vma x;
5932 bfd_byte *location;
5933 int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
5934
5935 /* Figure out where the relocation is occurring. */
5936 location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
5937
5938 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
5939
5940 /* Obtain the current value. */
5941 x = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, relocation, input_bfd, contents);
5942
5943 /* Clear the field we are setting. */
5944 x &= ~howto->dst_mask;
5945
5946 /* Set the field. */
5947 x |= (value & howto->dst_mask);
5948
5949 /* If required, turn JAL into JALX. */
5950 if (cross_mode_jump_p && jal_reloc_p (r_type))
5951 {
5952 bfd_boolean ok;
5953 bfd_vma opcode = x >> 26;
5954 bfd_vma jalx_opcode;
5955
5956 /* Check to see if the opcode is already JAL or JALX. */
5957 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
5958 {
5959 ok = ((opcode == 0x6) || (opcode == 0x7));
5960 jalx_opcode = 0x7;
5961 }
5962 else if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_26_S1)
5963 {
5964 ok = ((opcode == 0x3d) || (opcode == 0x3c));
5965 jalx_opcode = 0x3c;
5966 }
5967 else
5968 {
5969 ok = ((opcode == 0x3) || (opcode == 0x1d));
5970 jalx_opcode = 0x1d;
5971 }
5972
5973 /* If the opcode is not JAL or JALX, there's a problem. We cannot
5974 convert J or JALS to JALX. */
5975 if (!ok)
5976 {
5977 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5978 (_("%B: %A+0x%lx: Unsupported jump between ISA modes; consider recompiling with interlinking enabled."),
5979 input_bfd,
5980 input_section,
5981 (unsigned long) relocation->r_offset);
5982 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5983 return FALSE;
5984 }
5985
5986 /* Make this the JALX opcode. */
5987 x = (x & ~(0x3f << 26)) | (jalx_opcode << 26);
5988 }
5989
5990 /* Try converting JAL to BAL and J(AL)R to B(AL), if the target is in
5991 range. */
5992 if (!info->relocatable
5993 && !cross_mode_jump_p
5994 && ((JAL_TO_BAL_P (input_bfd)
5995 && r_type == R_MIPS_26
5996 && (x >> 26) == 0x3) /* jal addr */
5997 || (JALR_TO_BAL_P (input_bfd)
5998 && r_type == R_MIPS_JALR
5999 && x == 0x0320f809) /* jalr t9 */
6000 || (JR_TO_B_P (input_bfd)
6001 && r_type == R_MIPS_JALR
6002 && x == 0x03200008))) /* jr t9 */
6003 {
6004 bfd_vma addr;
6005 bfd_vma dest;
6006 bfd_signed_vma off;
6007
6008 addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
6009 + input_section->output_offset
6010 + relocation->r_offset
6011 + 4);
6012 if (r_type == R_MIPS_26)
6013 dest = (value << 2) | ((addr >> 28) << 28);
6014 else
6015 dest = value;
6016 off = dest - addr;
6017 if (off <= 0x1ffff && off >= -0x20000)
6018 {
6019 if (x == 0x03200008) /* jr t9 */
6020 x = 0x10000000 | (((bfd_vma) off >> 2) & 0xffff); /* b addr */
6021 else
6022 x = 0x04110000 | (((bfd_vma) off >> 2) & 0xffff); /* bal addr */
6023 }
6024 }
6025
6026 /* Put the value into the output. */
6027 bfd_put (8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto), input_bfd, x, location);
6028
6029 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_shuffle (input_bfd, r_type, !info->relocatable,
6030 location);
6031
6032 return TRUE;
6033 }
6034 \f
6035 /* Create a rel.dyn relocation for the dynamic linker to resolve. REL
6036 is the original relocation, which is now being transformed into a
6037 dynamic relocation. The ADDENDP is adjusted if necessary; the
6038 caller should store the result in place of the original addend. */
6039
6040 static bfd_boolean
6041 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
6042 struct bfd_link_info *info,
6043 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
6044 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6045 asection *sec, bfd_vma symbol,
6046 bfd_vma *addendp, asection *input_section)
6047 {
6048 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel[3];
6049 asection *sreloc;
6050 bfd *dynobj;
6051 int r_type;
6052 long indx;
6053 bfd_boolean defined_p;
6054 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6055
6056 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
6057 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
6058
6059 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
6060 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
6061 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
6062 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc != NULL);
6063 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->contents != NULL);
6064 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->reloc_count * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd)
6065 < sreloc->size);
6066
6067 outrel[0].r_offset =
6068 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[0].r_offset);
6069 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
6070 {
6071 outrel[1].r_offset =
6072 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[1].r_offset);
6073 outrel[2].r_offset =
6074 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[2].r_offset);
6075 }
6076
6077 if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_ONE)
6078 /* The relocation field has been deleted. */
6079 return TRUE;
6080
6081 if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_TWO)
6082 {
6083 /* The relocation field has been converted into a relative value of
6084 some sort. Functions like _bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame expect
6085 the field to be fully relocated, so add in the symbol's value. */
6086 *addendp += symbol;
6087 return TRUE;
6088 }
6089
6090 /* We must now calculate the dynamic symbol table index to use
6091 in the relocation. */
6092 if (h != NULL && ! SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->root))
6093 {
6094 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks || h->global_got_area != GGA_NONE);
6095 indx = h->root.dynindx;
6096 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
6097 defined_p = h->root.def_regular;
6098 else
6099 /* ??? glibc's ld.so just adds the final GOT entry to the
6100 relocation field. It therefore treats relocs against
6101 defined symbols in the same way as relocs against
6102 undefined symbols. */
6103 defined_p = FALSE;
6104 }
6105 else
6106 {
6107 if (sec != NULL && bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
6108 indx = 0;
6109 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
6110 {
6111 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6112 return FALSE;
6113 }
6114 else
6115 {
6116 indx = elf_section_data (sec->output_section)->dynindx;
6117 if (indx == 0)
6118 {
6119 asection *osec = htab->root.text_index_section;
6120 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
6121 }
6122 if (indx == 0)
6123 abort ();
6124 }
6125
6126 /* Instead of generating a relocation using the section
6127 symbol, we may as well make it a fully relative
6128 relocation. We want to avoid generating relocations to
6129 local symbols because we used to generate them
6130 incorrectly, without adding the original symbol value,
6131 which is mandated by the ABI for section symbols. In
6132 order to give dynamic loaders and applications time to
6133 phase out the incorrect use, we refrain from emitting
6134 section-relative relocations. It's not like they're
6135 useful, after all. This should be a bit more efficient
6136 as well. */
6137 /* ??? Although this behavior is compatible with glibc's ld.so,
6138 the ABI says that relocations against STN_UNDEF should have
6139 a symbol value of 0. Irix rld honors this, so relocations
6140 against STN_UNDEF have no effect. */
6141 if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
6142 indx = 0;
6143 defined_p = TRUE;
6144 }
6145
6146 /* If the relocation was previously an absolute relocation and
6147 this symbol will not be referred to by the relocation, we must
6148 adjust it by the value we give it in the dynamic symbol table.
6149 Otherwise leave the job up to the dynamic linker. */
6150 if (defined_p && r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
6151 *addendp += symbol;
6152
6153 if (htab->is_vxworks)
6154 /* VxWorks uses non-relative relocations for this. */
6155 outrel[0].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_MIPS_32);
6156 else
6157 /* The relocation is always an REL32 relocation because we don't
6158 know where the shared library will wind up at load-time. */
6159 outrel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, (unsigned long) indx,
6160 R_MIPS_REL32);
6161
6162 /* For strict adherence to the ABI specification, we should
6163 generate a R_MIPS_64 relocation record by itself before the
6164 _REL32/_64 record as well, such that the addend is read in as
6165 a 64-bit value (REL32 is a 32-bit relocation, after all).
6166 However, since none of the existing ELF64 MIPS dynamic
6167 loaders seems to care, we don't waste space with these
6168 artificial relocations. If this turns out to not be true,
6169 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocation() should be tweaked so
6170 as to make room for a pair of dynamic relocations per
6171 invocation if ABI_64_P, and here we should generate an
6172 additional relocation record with R_MIPS_64 by itself for a
6173 NULL symbol before this relocation record. */
6174 outrel[1].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0,
6175 ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
6176 ? R_MIPS_64
6177 : R_MIPS_NONE);
6178 outrel[2].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_NONE);
6179
6180 /* Adjust the output offset of the relocation to reference the
6181 correct location in the output file. */
6182 outrel[0].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
6183 + input_section->output_offset);
6184 outrel[1].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
6185 + input_section->output_offset);
6186 outrel[2].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
6187 + input_section->output_offset);
6188
6189 /* Put the relocation back out. We have to use the special
6190 relocation outputter in the 64-bit case since the 64-bit
6191 relocation format is non-standard. */
6192 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
6193 {
6194 (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
6195 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
6196 (sreloc->contents
6197 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
6198 }
6199 else if (htab->is_vxworks)
6200 {
6201 /* VxWorks uses RELA rather than REL dynamic relocations. */
6202 outrel[0].r_addend = *addendp;
6203 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out
6204 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
6205 (sreloc->contents
6206 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)));
6207 }
6208 else
6209 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
6210 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
6211 (sreloc->contents + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
6212
6213 /* We've now added another relocation. */
6214 ++sreloc->reloc_count;
6215
6216 /* Make sure the output section is writable. The dynamic linker
6217 will be writing to it. */
6218 elf_section_data (input_section->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_flags
6219 |= SHF_WRITE;
6220
6221 /* On IRIX5, make an entry of compact relocation info. */
6222 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5)
6223 {
6224 asection *scpt = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
6225 bfd_byte *cr;
6226
6227 if (scpt)
6228 {
6229 Elf32_crinfo cptrel;
6230
6231 mips_elf_set_cr_format (cptrel, CRF_MIPS_LONG);
6232 cptrel.vaddr = (rel->r_offset
6233 + input_section->output_section->vma
6234 + input_section->output_offset);
6235 if (r_type == R_MIPS_REL32)
6236 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_REL32);
6237 else
6238 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_WORD);
6239 mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to (cptrel, 0);
6240 cptrel.konst = *addendp;
6241
6242 cr = (scpt->contents
6243 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
6244 mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr (cptrel, 0);
6245 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (output_bfd, &cptrel,
6246 ((Elf32_External_crinfo *) cr
6247 + scpt->reloc_count));
6248 ++scpt->reloc_count;
6249 }
6250 }
6251
6252 /* If we've written this relocation for a readonly section,
6253 we need to set DF_TEXTREL again, so that we do not delete the
6254 DT_TEXTREL tag. */
6255 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (input_section))
6256 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6257
6258 return TRUE;
6259 }
6260 \f
6261 /* Return the MACH for a MIPS e_flags value. */
6262
6263 unsigned long
6264 _bfd_elf_mips_mach (flagword flags)
6265 {
6266 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_MACH)
6267 {
6268 case E_MIPS_MACH_3900:
6269 return bfd_mach_mips3900;
6270
6271 case E_MIPS_MACH_4010:
6272 return bfd_mach_mips4010;
6273
6274 case E_MIPS_MACH_4100:
6275 return bfd_mach_mips4100;
6276
6277 case E_MIPS_MACH_4111:
6278 return bfd_mach_mips4111;
6279
6280 case E_MIPS_MACH_4120:
6281 return bfd_mach_mips4120;
6282
6283 case E_MIPS_MACH_4650:
6284 return bfd_mach_mips4650;
6285
6286 case E_MIPS_MACH_5400:
6287 return bfd_mach_mips5400;
6288
6289 case E_MIPS_MACH_5500:
6290 return bfd_mach_mips5500;
6291
6292 case E_MIPS_MACH_5900:
6293 return bfd_mach_mips5900;
6294
6295 case E_MIPS_MACH_9000:
6296 return bfd_mach_mips9000;
6297
6298 case E_MIPS_MACH_SB1:
6299 return bfd_mach_mips_sb1;
6300
6301 case E_MIPS_MACH_LS2E:
6302 return bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2e;
6303
6304 case E_MIPS_MACH_LS2F:
6305 return bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2f;
6306
6307 case E_MIPS_MACH_LS3A:
6308 return bfd_mach_mips_loongson_3a;
6309
6310 case E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON2:
6311 return bfd_mach_mips_octeon2;
6312
6313 case E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON:
6314 return bfd_mach_mips_octeon;
6315
6316 case E_MIPS_MACH_XLR:
6317 return bfd_mach_mips_xlr;
6318
6319 default:
6320 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH)
6321 {
6322 default:
6323 case E_MIPS_ARCH_1:
6324 return bfd_mach_mips3000;
6325
6326 case E_MIPS_ARCH_2:
6327 return bfd_mach_mips6000;
6328
6329 case E_MIPS_ARCH_3:
6330 return bfd_mach_mips4000;
6331
6332 case E_MIPS_ARCH_4:
6333 return bfd_mach_mips8000;
6334
6335 case E_MIPS_ARCH_5:
6336 return bfd_mach_mips5;
6337
6338 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32:
6339 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32;
6340
6341 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64:
6342 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64;
6343
6344 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2:
6345 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2;
6346
6347 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2:
6348 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2;
6349 }
6350 }
6351
6352 return 0;
6353 }
6354
6355 /* Return printable name for ABI. */
6356
6357 static INLINE char *
6358 elf_mips_abi_name (bfd *abfd)
6359 {
6360 flagword flags;
6361
6362 flags = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags;
6363 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
6364 {
6365 case 0:
6366 if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
6367 return "N32";
6368 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
6369 return "64";
6370 else
6371 return "none";
6372 case E_MIPS_ABI_O32:
6373 return "O32";
6374 case E_MIPS_ABI_O64:
6375 return "O64";
6376 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32:
6377 return "EABI32";
6378 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64:
6379 return "EABI64";
6380 default:
6381 return "unknown abi";
6382 }
6383 }
6384 \f
6385 /* MIPS ELF uses two common sections. One is the usual one, and the
6386 other is for small objects. All the small objects are kept
6387 together, and then referenced via the gp pointer, which yields
6388 faster assembler code. This is what we use for the small common
6389 section. This approach is copied from ecoff.c. */
6390 static asection mips_elf_scom_section;
6391 static asymbol mips_elf_scom_symbol;
6392 static asymbol *mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
6393
6394 /* MIPS ELF also uses an acommon section, which represents an
6395 allocated common symbol which may be overridden by a
6396 definition in a shared library. */
6397 static asection mips_elf_acom_section;
6398 static asymbol mips_elf_acom_symbol;
6399 static asymbol *mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
6400
6401 /* This is used for both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
6402
6403 void
6404 _bfd_mips_elf_symbol_processing (bfd *abfd, asymbol *asym)
6405 {
6406 elf_symbol_type *elfsym;
6407
6408 /* Handle the special MIPS section numbers that a symbol may use. */
6409 elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) asym;
6410 switch (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx)
6411 {
6412 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
6413 /* This section is used in a dynamically linked executable file.
6414 It is an allocated common section. The dynamic linker can
6415 either resolve these symbols to something in a shared
6416 library, or it can just leave them here. For our purposes,
6417 we can consider these symbols to be in a new section. */
6418 if (mips_elf_acom_section.name == NULL)
6419 {
6420 /* Initialize the acommon section. */
6421 mips_elf_acom_section.name = ".acommon";
6422 mips_elf_acom_section.flags = SEC_ALLOC;
6423 mips_elf_acom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
6424 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
6425 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
6426 mips_elf_acom_symbol.name = ".acommon";
6427 mips_elf_acom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
6428 mips_elf_acom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
6429 mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
6430 }
6431 asym->section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
6432 break;
6433
6434 case SHN_COMMON:
6435 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
6436 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols on IRIX5. */
6437 if (asym->value > elf_gp_size (abfd)
6438 || ELF_ST_TYPE (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_info) == STT_TLS
6439 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
6440 break;
6441 /* Fall through. */
6442 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
6443 if (mips_elf_scom_section.name == NULL)
6444 {
6445 /* Initialize the small common section. */
6446 mips_elf_scom_section.name = ".scommon";
6447 mips_elf_scom_section.flags = SEC_IS_COMMON;
6448 mips_elf_scom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
6449 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
6450 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
6451 mips_elf_scom_symbol.name = ".scommon";
6452 mips_elf_scom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
6453 mips_elf_scom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
6454 mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
6455 }
6456 asym->section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
6457 asym->value = elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
6458 break;
6459
6460 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
6461 asym->section = bfd_und_section_ptr;
6462 break;
6463
6464 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
6465 {
6466 asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".text");
6467
6468 if (section != NULL)
6469 {
6470 asym->section = section;
6471 /* MIPS_TEXT is a bit special, the address is not an offset
6472 to the base of the .text section. So substract the section
6473 base address to make it an offset. */
6474 asym->value -= section->vma;
6475 }
6476 }
6477 break;
6478
6479 case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
6480 {
6481 asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".data");
6482
6483 if (section != NULL)
6484 {
6485 asym->section = section;
6486 /* MIPS_DATA is a bit special, the address is not an offset
6487 to the base of the .data section. So substract the section
6488 base address to make it an offset. */
6489 asym->value -= section->vma;
6490 }
6491 }
6492 break;
6493 }
6494
6495 /* If this is an odd-valued function symbol, assume it's a MIPS16
6496 or microMIPS one. */
6497 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_info) == STT_FUNC
6498 && (asym->value & 1) != 0)
6499 {
6500 asym->value--;
6501 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MICROMIPS)
6502 elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_other
6503 = ELF_ST_SET_MICROMIPS (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_other);
6504 else
6505 elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_other
6506 = ELF_ST_SET_MIPS16 (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_other);
6507 }
6508 }
6509 \f
6510 /* Implement elf_backend_eh_frame_address_size. This differs from
6511 the default in the way it handles EABI64.
6512
6513 EABI64 was originally specified as an LP64 ABI, and that is what
6514 -mabi=eabi normally gives on a 64-bit target. However, gcc has
6515 historically accepted the combination of -mabi=eabi and -mlong32,
6516 and this ILP32 variation has become semi-official over time.
6517 Both forms use elf32 and have pointer-sized FDE addresses.
6518
6519 If an EABI object was generated by GCC 4.0 or above, it will have
6520 an empty .gcc_compiled_longXX section, where XX is the size of longs
6521 in bits. Unfortunately, ILP32 objects generated by earlier compilers
6522 have no special marking to distinguish them from LP64 objects.
6523
6524 We don't want users of the official LP64 ABI to be punished for the
6525 existence of the ILP32 variant, but at the same time, we don't want
6526 to mistakenly interpret pre-4.0 ILP32 objects as being LP64 objects.
6527 We therefore take the following approach:
6528
6529 - If ABFD contains a .gcc_compiled_longXX section, use it to
6530 determine the pointer size.
6531
6532 - Otherwise check the type of the first relocation. Assume that
6533 the LP64 ABI is being used if the relocation is of type R_MIPS_64.
6534
6535 - Otherwise punt.
6536
6537 The second check is enough to detect LP64 objects generated by pre-4.0
6538 compilers because, in the kind of output generated by those compilers,
6539 the first relocation will be associated with either a CIE personality
6540 routine or an FDE start address. Furthermore, the compilers never
6541 used a special (non-pointer) encoding for this ABI.
6542
6543 Checking the relocation type should also be safe because there is no
6544 reason to use R_MIPS_64 in an ILP32 object. Pre-4.0 compilers never
6545 did so. */
6546
6547 unsigned int
6548 _bfd_mips_elf_eh_frame_address_size (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
6549 {
6550 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
6551 return 8;
6552 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
6553 {
6554 bfd_boolean long32_p, long64_p;
6555
6556 long32_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long32") != 0;
6557 long64_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long64") != 0;
6558 if (long32_p && long64_p)
6559 return 0;
6560 if (long32_p)
6561 return 4;
6562 if (long64_p)
6563 return 8;
6564
6565 if (sec->reloc_count > 0
6566 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != NULL
6567 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs[0].r_info)
6568 == R_MIPS_64))
6569 return 8;
6570
6571 return 0;
6572 }
6573 return 4;
6574 }
6575 \f
6576 /* There appears to be a bug in the MIPSpro linker that causes GOT_DISP
6577 relocations against two unnamed section symbols to resolve to the
6578 same address. For example, if we have code like:
6579
6580 lw $4,%got_disp(.data)($gp)
6581 lw $25,%got_disp(.text)($gp)
6582 jalr $25
6583
6584 then the linker will resolve both relocations to .data and the program
6585 will jump there rather than to .text.
6586
6587 We can work around this problem by giving names to local section symbols.
6588 This is also what the MIPSpro tools do. */
6589
6590 bfd_boolean
6591 _bfd_mips_elf_name_local_section_symbols (bfd *abfd)
6592 {
6593 return SGI_COMPAT (abfd);
6594 }
6595 \f
6596 /* Work over a section just before writing it out. This routine is
6597 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. FIXME: We recognize
6598 sections that need the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag by name; there has to be
6599 a better way. */
6600
6601 bfd_boolean
6602 _bfd_mips_elf_section_processing (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr)
6603 {
6604 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO
6605 && hdr->sh_size > 0)
6606 {
6607 bfd_byte buf[4];
6608
6609 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
6610 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->contents == NULL);
6611
6612 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
6613 hdr->sh_offset + sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4,
6614 SEEK_SET) != 0)
6615 return FALSE;
6616 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
6617 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
6618 return FALSE;
6619 }
6620
6621 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS
6622 && hdr->bfd_section != NULL
6623 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section) != NULL
6624 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata != NULL)
6625 {
6626 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
6627
6628 /* We stored the section contents in the tdata field in the
6629 set_section_contents routine. We save the section contents
6630 so that we don't have to read them again.
6631 At this point we know that elf_gp is set, so we can look
6632 through the section contents to see if there is an
6633 ODK_REGINFO structure. */
6634
6635 contents = mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata;
6636 l = contents;
6637 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
6638 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
6639 {
6640 Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
6641
6642 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
6643 &intopt);
6644 if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
6645 {
6646 (*_bfd_error_handler)
6647 (_("%B: Warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than its header"),
6648 abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
6649 break;
6650 }
6651 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
6652 {
6653 bfd_byte buf[8];
6654
6655 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
6656 (hdr->sh_offset
6657 + (l - contents)
6658 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
6659 + (sizeof (Elf64_External_RegInfo) - 8)),
6660 SEEK_SET) != 0)
6661 return FALSE;
6662 H_PUT_64 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
6663 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 8, abfd) != 8)
6664 return FALSE;
6665 }
6666 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
6667 {
6668 bfd_byte buf[4];
6669
6670 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
6671 (hdr->sh_offset
6672 + (l - contents)
6673 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
6674 + (sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4)),
6675 SEEK_SET) != 0)
6676 return FALSE;
6677 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
6678 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
6679 return FALSE;
6680 }
6681 l += intopt.size;
6682 }
6683 }
6684
6685 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
6686 {
6687 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, hdr->bfd_section);
6688
6689 /* .sbss is not handled specially here because the GNU/Linux
6690 prelinker can convert .sbss from NOBITS to PROGBITS and
6691 changing it back to NOBITS breaks the binary. The entry in
6692 _bfd_mips_elf_special_sections will ensure the correct flags
6693 are set on .sbss if BFD creates it without reading it from an
6694 input file, and without special handling here the flags set
6695 on it in an input file will be followed. */
6696 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
6697 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0
6698 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0)
6699 {
6700 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
6701 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
6702 }
6703 else if (strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0)
6704 {
6705 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
6706 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
6707 }
6708 else if (strcmp (name, ".compact_rel") == 0)
6709 {
6710 hdr->sh_flags = 0;
6711 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
6712 }
6713 else if (strcmp (name, ".rtproc") == 0)
6714 {
6715 if (hdr->sh_addralign != 0 && hdr->sh_entsize == 0)
6716 {
6717 unsigned int adjust;
6718
6719 adjust = hdr->sh_size % hdr->sh_addralign;
6720 if (adjust != 0)
6721 hdr->sh_size += hdr->sh_addralign - adjust;
6722 }
6723 }
6724 }
6725
6726 return TRUE;
6727 }
6728
6729 /* Handle a MIPS specific section when reading an object file. This
6730 is called when elfcode.h finds a section with an unknown type.
6731 This routine supports both the 32-bit and 64-bit ELF ABI.
6732
6733 FIXME: We need to handle the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag, but I'm not sure
6734 how to. */
6735
6736 bfd_boolean
6737 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
6738 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
6739 const char *name,
6740 int shindex)
6741 {
6742 flagword flags = 0;
6743
6744 /* There ought to be a place to keep ELF backend specific flags, but
6745 at the moment there isn't one. We just keep track of the
6746 sections by their name, instead. Fortunately, the ABI gives
6747 suggested names for all the MIPS specific sections, so we will
6748 probably get away with this. */
6749 switch (hdr->sh_type)
6750 {
6751 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
6752 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") != 0)
6753 return FALSE;
6754 break;
6755 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
6756 if (strcmp (name, ".msym") != 0)
6757 return FALSE;
6758 break;
6759 case SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT:
6760 if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") != 0)
6761 return FALSE;
6762 break;
6763 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
6764 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."))
6765 return FALSE;
6766 break;
6767 case SHT_MIPS_UCODE:
6768 if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") != 0)
6769 return FALSE;
6770 break;
6771 case SHT_MIPS_DEBUG:
6772 if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") != 0)
6773 return FALSE;
6774 flags = SEC_DEBUGGING;
6775 break;
6776 case SHT_MIPS_REGINFO:
6777 if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") != 0
6778 || hdr->sh_size != sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo))
6779 return FALSE;
6780 flags = (SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_SAME_SIZE);
6781 break;
6782 case SHT_MIPS_IFACE:
6783 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") != 0)
6784 return FALSE;
6785 break;
6786 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
6787 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"))
6788 return FALSE;
6789 break;
6790 case SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
6791 if (!MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
6792 return FALSE;
6793 break;
6794 case SHT_MIPS_DWARF:
6795 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_")
6796 && ! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".zdebug_"))
6797 return FALSE;
6798 break;
6799 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
6800 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") != 0)
6801 return FALSE;
6802 break;
6803 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
6804 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events")
6805 && ! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"))
6806 return FALSE;
6807 break;
6808 default:
6809 break;
6810 }
6811
6812 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
6813 return FALSE;
6814
6815 if (flags)
6816 {
6817 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
6818 (bfd_get_section_flags (abfd,
6819 hdr->bfd_section)
6820 | flags)))
6821 return FALSE;
6822 }
6823
6824 /* FIXME: We should record sh_info for a .gptab section. */
6825
6826 /* For a .reginfo section, set the gp value in the tdata information
6827 from the contents of this section. We need the gp value while
6828 processing relocs, so we just get it now. The .reginfo section
6829 is not used in the 64-bit MIPS ELF ABI. */
6830 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO)
6831 {
6832 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
6833 Elf32_RegInfo s;
6834
6835 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
6836 &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
6837 return FALSE;
6838 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (abfd, &ext, &s);
6839 elf_gp (abfd) = s.ri_gp_value;
6840 }
6841
6842 /* For a SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section, look for a ODK_REGINFO entry, and
6843 set the gp value based on what we find. We may see both
6844 SHT_MIPS_REGINFO and SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS/ODK_REGINFO; in that case,
6845 they should agree. */
6846 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
6847 {
6848 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
6849
6850 contents = bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
6851 if (contents == NULL)
6852 return FALSE;
6853 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section, contents,
6854 0, hdr->sh_size))
6855 {
6856 free (contents);
6857 return FALSE;
6858 }
6859 l = contents;
6860 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
6861 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
6862 {
6863 Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
6864
6865 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
6866 &intopt);
6867 if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
6868 {
6869 (*_bfd_error_handler)
6870 (_("%B: Warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than its header"),
6871 abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
6872 break;
6873 }
6874 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
6875 {
6876 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo intreg;
6877
6878 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in
6879 (abfd,
6880 ((Elf64_External_RegInfo *)
6881 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
6882 &intreg);
6883 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
6884 }
6885 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
6886 {
6887 Elf32_RegInfo intreg;
6888
6889 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in
6890 (abfd,
6891 ((Elf32_External_RegInfo *)
6892 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
6893 &intreg);
6894 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
6895 }
6896 l += intopt.size;
6897 }
6898 free (contents);
6899 }
6900
6901 return TRUE;
6902 }
6903
6904 /* Set the correct type for a MIPS ELF section. We do this by the
6905 section name, which is a hack, but ought to work. This routine is
6906 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
6907
6908 bfd_boolean
6909 _bfd_mips_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *sec)
6910 {
6911 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
6912
6913 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") == 0)
6914 {
6915 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST;
6916 hdr->sh_info = sec->size / sizeof (Elf32_Lib);
6917 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
6918 }
6919 else if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") == 0)
6920 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT;
6921 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."))
6922 {
6923 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_GPTAB;
6924 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
6925 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
6926 }
6927 else if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") == 0)
6928 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_UCODE;
6929 else if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") == 0)
6930 {
6931 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DEBUG;
6932 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .mdebug section has an
6933 entsize of 0. FIXME: Does this matter? */
6934 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
6935 hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
6936 else
6937 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
6938 }
6939 else if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") == 0)
6940 {
6941 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_REGINFO;
6942 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .reginfo section has an
6943 entsize of 0x18. FIXME: Does this matter? */
6944 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
6945 {
6946 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
6947 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
6948 else
6949 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
6950 }
6951 else
6952 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
6953 }
6954 else if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
6955 && (strcmp (name, ".hash") == 0
6956 || strcmp (name, ".dynamic") == 0
6957 || strcmp (name, ".dynstr") == 0))
6958 {
6959 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
6960 hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
6961 #if 0
6962 /* This isn't how the IRIX6 linker behaves. */
6963 hdr->sh_info = SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES;
6964 #endif
6965 }
6966 else if (strcmp (name, ".got") == 0
6967 || strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0
6968 || strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
6969 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0
6970 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0
6971 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0)
6972 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
6973 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") == 0)
6974 {
6975 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_IFACE;
6976 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
6977 }
6978 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"))
6979 {
6980 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONTENT;
6981 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
6982 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
6983 }
6984 else if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
6985 {
6986 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
6987 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
6988 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
6989 }
6990 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_")
6991 || CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".zdebug_"))
6992 {
6993 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DWARF;
6994
6995 /* Irix facilities such as libexc expect a single .debug_frame
6996 per executable, the system ones have NOSTRIP set and the linker
6997 doesn't merge sections with different flags so ... */
6998 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_frame"))
6999 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
7000 }
7001 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") == 0)
7002 {
7003 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB;
7004 /* The sh_link and sh_info fields are set in
7005 final_write_processing. */
7006 }
7007 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events")
7008 || CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"))
7009 {
7010 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_EVENTS;
7011 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
7012 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
7013 }
7014 else if (strcmp (name, ".msym") == 0)
7015 {
7016 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_MSYM;
7017 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
7018 hdr->sh_entsize = 8;
7019 }
7020
7021 /* The generic elf_fake_sections will set up REL_HDR using the default
7022 kind of relocations. We used to set up a second header for the
7023 non-default kind of relocations here, but only NewABI would use
7024 these, and the IRIX ld doesn't like resulting empty RELA sections.
7025 Thus we create those header only on demand now. */
7026
7027 return TRUE;
7028 }
7029
7030 /* Given a BFD section, try to locate the corresponding ELF section
7031 index. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI.
7032 Actually, it's not clear to me that the 64-bit ABI supports these,
7033 but for non-PIC objects we will certainly want support for at least
7034 the .scommon section. */
7035
7036 bfd_boolean
7037 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7038 asection *sec, int *retval)
7039 {
7040 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".scommon") == 0)
7041 {
7042 *retval = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
7043 return TRUE;
7044 }
7045 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".acommon") == 0)
7046 {
7047 *retval = SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON;
7048 return TRUE;
7049 }
7050 return FALSE;
7051 }
7052 \f
7053 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
7054 file. We must handle the special MIPS section numbers here. */
7055
7056 bfd_boolean
7057 _bfd_mips_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
7058 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym, const char **namep,
7059 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7060 asection **secp, bfd_vma *valp)
7061 {
7062 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
7063 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
7064 && strcmp (*namep, "_rld_new_interface") == 0)
7065 {
7066 /* Skip IRIX5 rld entry name. */
7067 *namep = NULL;
7068 return TRUE;
7069 }
7070
7071 /* Shared objects may have a dynamic symbol '_gp_disp' defined as
7072 a SECTION *ABS*. This causes ld to think it can resolve _gp_disp
7073 by setting a DT_NEEDED for the shared object. Since _gp_disp is
7074 a magic symbol resolved by the linker, we ignore this bogus definition
7075 of _gp_disp. New ABI objects do not suffer from this problem so this
7076 is not done for them. */
7077 if (!NEWABI_P(abfd)
7078 && (sym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
7079 && (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0))
7080 {
7081 *namep = NULL;
7082 return TRUE;
7083 }
7084
7085 switch (sym->st_shndx)
7086 {
7087 case SHN_COMMON:
7088 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
7089 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols. */
7090 if (sym->st_size > elf_gp_size (abfd)
7091 || ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_TLS
7092 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
7093 break;
7094 /* Fall through. */
7095 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
7096 *secp = bfd_make_section_old_way (abfd, ".scommon");
7097 (*secp)->flags |= SEC_IS_COMMON;
7098 *valp = sym->st_size;
7099 break;
7100
7101 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
7102 /* This section is used in a shared object. */
7103 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section == NULL)
7104 {
7105 asymbol *elf_text_symbol;
7106 asection *elf_text_section;
7107 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
7108
7109 elf_text_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7110 if (elf_text_section == NULL)
7111 return FALSE;
7112
7113 amt = sizeof (asymbol);
7114 elf_text_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7115 if (elf_text_symbol == NULL)
7116 return FALSE;
7117
7118 /* Initialize the section. */
7119
7120 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section = elf_text_section;
7121 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol = elf_text_symbol;
7122
7123 elf_text_section->symbol = elf_text_symbol;
7124 elf_text_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol;
7125
7126 elf_text_section->name = ".text";
7127 elf_text_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
7128 elf_text_section->output_section = NULL;
7129 elf_text_section->owner = abfd;
7130 elf_text_symbol->name = ".text";
7131 elf_text_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
7132 elf_text_symbol->section = elf_text_section;
7133 }
7134 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
7135 info->shared. I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
7136 so I took it out. */
7137 *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section;
7138 break;
7139
7140 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
7141 /* Fall through. XXX Can we treat this as allocated data? */
7142 case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
7143 /* This section is used in a shared object. */
7144 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section == NULL)
7145 {
7146 asymbol *elf_data_symbol;
7147 asection *elf_data_section;
7148 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
7149
7150 elf_data_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7151 if (elf_data_section == NULL)
7152 return FALSE;
7153
7154 amt = sizeof (asymbol);
7155 elf_data_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7156 if (elf_data_symbol == NULL)
7157 return FALSE;
7158
7159 /* Initialize the section. */
7160
7161 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section = elf_data_section;
7162 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol = elf_data_symbol;
7163
7164 elf_data_section->symbol = elf_data_symbol;
7165 elf_data_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol;
7166
7167 elf_data_section->name = ".data";
7168 elf_data_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
7169 elf_data_section->output_section = NULL;
7170 elf_data_section->owner = abfd;
7171 elf_data_symbol->name = ".data";
7172 elf_data_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
7173 elf_data_symbol->section = elf_data_section;
7174 }
7175 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
7176 info->shared. I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
7177 so I took it out. */
7178 *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section;
7179 break;
7180
7181 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
7182 *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr;
7183 break;
7184 }
7185
7186 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
7187 && ! info->shared
7188 && info->output_bfd->xvec == abfd->xvec
7189 && strcmp (*namep, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
7190 {
7191 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7192 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
7193
7194 /* Mark __rld_obj_head as dynamic. */
7195 bh = NULL;
7196 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
7197 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, *secp, *valp, NULL, FALSE,
7198 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
7199 return FALSE;
7200
7201 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
7202 h->non_elf = 0;
7203 h->def_regular = 1;
7204 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
7205
7206 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
7207 return FALSE;
7208
7209 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head = TRUE;
7210 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_symbol = h;
7211 }
7212
7213 /* If this is a mips16 text symbol, add 1 to the value to make it
7214 odd. This will cause something like .word SYM to come up with
7215 the right value when it is loaded into the PC. */
7216 if (ELF_ST_IS_COMPRESSED (sym->st_other))
7217 ++*valp;
7218
7219 return TRUE;
7220 }
7221
7222 /* This hook function is called before the linker writes out a global
7223 symbol. We mark symbols as small common if appropriate. This is
7224 also where we undo the increment of the value for a mips16 symbol. */
7225
7226 int
7227 _bfd_mips_elf_link_output_symbol_hook
7228 (struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7229 const char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
7230 asection *input_sec, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7231 {
7232 /* If we see a common symbol, which implies a relocatable link, then
7233 if a symbol was small common in an input file, mark it as small
7234 common in the output file. */
7235 if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
7236 && strcmp (input_sec->name, ".scommon") == 0)
7237 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
7238
7239 if (ELF_ST_IS_COMPRESSED (sym->st_other))
7240 sym->st_value &= ~1;
7241
7242 return 1;
7243 }
7244 \f
7245 /* Functions for the dynamic linker. */
7246
7247 /* Create dynamic sections when linking against a dynamic object. */
7248
7249 bfd_boolean
7250 _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
7251 {
7252 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7253 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
7254 flagword flags;
7255 register asection *s;
7256 const char * const *namep;
7257 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7258
7259 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
7260 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
7261
7262 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
7263 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
7264
7265 /* The psABI requires a read-only .dynamic section, but the VxWorks
7266 EABI doesn't. */
7267 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
7268 {
7269 s = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".dynamic");
7270 if (s != NULL)
7271 {
7272 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags))
7273 return FALSE;
7274 }
7275 }
7276
7277 /* We need to create .got section. */
7278 if (!mips_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
7279 return FALSE;
7280
7281 if (! mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE))
7282 return FALSE;
7283
7284 /* Create .stub section. */
7285 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd,
7286 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd),
7287 flags | SEC_CODE);
7288 if (s == NULL
7289 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
7290 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
7291 return FALSE;
7292 htab->sstubs = s;
7293
7294 if (!mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
7295 && !info->shared
7296 && bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".rld_map") == NULL)
7297 {
7298 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rld_map",
7299 flags &~ (flagword) SEC_READONLY);
7300 if (s == NULL
7301 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
7302 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
7303 return FALSE;
7304 }
7305
7306 /* On IRIX5, we adjust add some additional symbols and change the
7307 alignments of several sections. There is no ABI documentation
7308 indicating that this is necessary on IRIX6, nor any evidence that
7309 the linker takes such action. */
7310 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
7311 {
7312 for (namep = mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names; *namep != NULL; namep++)
7313 {
7314 bh = NULL;
7315 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
7316 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_und_section_ptr, 0,
7317 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
7318 return FALSE;
7319
7320 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
7321 h->non_elf = 0;
7322 h->def_regular = 1;
7323 h->type = STT_SECTION;
7324
7325 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
7326 return FALSE;
7327 }
7328
7329 /* We need to create a .compact_rel section. */
7330 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
7331 {
7332 if (!mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section (abfd, info))
7333 return FALSE;
7334 }
7335
7336 /* Change alignments of some sections. */
7337 s = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".hash");
7338 if (s != NULL)
7339 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
7340 s = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".dynsym");
7341 if (s != NULL)
7342 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
7343 s = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".dynstr");
7344 if (s != NULL)
7345 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
7346 /* ??? */
7347 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
7348 if (s != NULL)
7349 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
7350 s = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".dynamic");
7351 if (s != NULL)
7352 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
7353 }
7354
7355 if (!info->shared)
7356 {
7357 const char *name;
7358
7359 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING";
7360 bh = NULL;
7361 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
7362 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_abs_section_ptr, 0,
7363 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
7364 return FALSE;
7365
7366 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
7367 h->non_elf = 0;
7368 h->def_regular = 1;
7369 h->type = STT_SECTION;
7370
7371 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
7372 return FALSE;
7373
7374 if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head)
7375 {
7376 /* __rld_map is a four byte word located in the .data section
7377 and is filled in by the rtld to contain a pointer to
7378 the _r_debug structure. Its symbol value will be set in
7379 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol. */
7380 s = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".rld_map");
7381 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
7382
7383 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "__rld_map" : "__RLD_MAP";
7384 bh = NULL;
7385 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
7386 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, s, 0, NULL, FALSE,
7387 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
7388 return FALSE;
7389
7390 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
7391 h->non_elf = 0;
7392 h->def_regular = 1;
7393 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
7394
7395 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
7396 return FALSE;
7397 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_symbol = h;
7398 }
7399 }
7400
7401 /* Create the .plt, .rel(a).plt, .dynbss and .rel(a).bss sections.
7402 Also create the _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE symbol. */
7403 if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
7404 return FALSE;
7405
7406 /* Cache the sections created above. */
7407 htab->splt = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".plt");
7408 htab->sdynbss = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".dynbss");
7409 if (htab->is_vxworks)
7410 {
7411 htab->srelbss = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".rela.bss");
7412 htab->srelplt = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".rela.plt");
7413 }
7414 else
7415 htab->srelplt = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".rel.plt");
7416 if (!htab->sdynbss
7417 || (htab->is_vxworks && !htab->srelbss && !info->shared)
7418 || !htab->srelplt
7419 || !htab->splt)
7420 abort ();
7421
7422 if (htab->is_vxworks)
7423 {
7424 /* Do the usual VxWorks handling. */
7425 if (!elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
7426 return FALSE;
7427
7428 /* Work out the PLT sizes. */
7429 if (info->shared)
7430 {
7431 htab->plt_header_size
7432 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry);
7433 htab->plt_entry_size
7434 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry);
7435 }
7436 else
7437 {
7438 htab->plt_header_size
7439 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry);
7440 htab->plt_entry_size
7441 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry);
7442 }
7443 }
7444 else if (!info->shared)
7445 {
7446 /* All variants of the plt0 entry are the same size. */
7447 htab->plt_header_size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_o32_exec_plt0_entry);
7448 htab->plt_entry_size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_exec_plt_entry);
7449 }
7450
7451 return TRUE;
7452 }
7453 \f
7454 /* Return true if relocation REL against section SEC is a REL rather than
7455 RELA relocation. RELOCS is the first relocation in the section and
7456 ABFD is the bfd that contains SEC. */
7457
7458 static bfd_boolean
7459 mips_elf_rel_relocation_p (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
7460 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
7461 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
7462 {
7463 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
7464 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7465
7466 /* To determine which flavor of relocation this is, we depend on the
7467 fact that the INPUT_SECTION's REL_HDR is read before RELA_HDR. */
7468 rel_hdr = elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
7469 if (rel_hdr == NULL)
7470 return FALSE;
7471 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7472 return ((size_t) (rel - relocs)
7473 < NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (rel_hdr) * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel);
7474 }
7475
7476 /* Read the addend for REL relocation REL, which belongs to bfd ABFD.
7477 HOWTO is the relocation's howto and CONTENTS points to the contents
7478 of the section that REL is against. */
7479
7480 static bfd_vma
7481 mips_elf_read_rel_addend (bfd *abfd, const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
7482 reloc_howto_type *howto, bfd_byte *contents)
7483 {
7484 bfd_byte *location;
7485 unsigned int r_type;
7486 bfd_vma addend;
7487
7488 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
7489 location = contents + rel->r_offset;
7490
7491 /* Get the addend, which is stored in the input file. */
7492 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
7493 addend = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, rel, abfd, contents);
7494 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
7495
7496 return addend & howto->src_mask;
7497 }
7498
7499 /* REL is a relocation in ABFD that needs a partnering LO16 relocation
7500 and *ADDEND is the addend for REL itself. Look for the LO16 relocation
7501 and update *ADDEND with the final addend. Return true on success
7502 or false if the LO16 could not be found. RELEND is the exclusive
7503 upper bound on the relocations for REL's section. */
7504
7505 static bfd_boolean
7506 mips_elf_add_lo16_rel_addend (bfd *abfd,
7507 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
7508 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend,
7509 bfd_byte *contents, bfd_vma *addend)
7510 {
7511 unsigned int r_type, lo16_type;
7512 const Elf_Internal_Rela *lo16_relocation;
7513 reloc_howto_type *lo16_howto;
7514 bfd_vma l;
7515
7516 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
7517 if (mips16_reloc_p (r_type))
7518 lo16_type = R_MIPS16_LO16;
7519 else if (micromips_reloc_p (r_type))
7520 lo16_type = R_MICROMIPS_LO16;
7521 else
7522 lo16_type = R_MIPS_LO16;
7523
7524 /* The combined value is the sum of the HI16 addend, left-shifted by
7525 sixteen bits, and the LO16 addend, sign extended. (Usually, the
7526 code does a `lui' of the HI16 value, and then an `addiu' of the
7527 LO16 value.)
7528
7529 Scan ahead to find a matching LO16 relocation.
7530
7531 According to the MIPS ELF ABI, the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation must
7532 be immediately following. However, for the IRIX6 ABI, the next
7533 relocation may be a composed relocation consisting of several
7534 relocations for the same address. In that case, the R_MIPS_LO16
7535 relocation may occur as one of these. We permit a similar
7536 extension in general, as that is useful for GCC.
7537
7538 In some cases GCC dead code elimination removes the LO16 but keeps
7539 the corresponding HI16. This is strictly speaking a violation of
7540 the ABI but not immediately harmful. */
7541 lo16_relocation = mips_elf_next_relocation (abfd, lo16_type, rel, relend);
7542 if (lo16_relocation == NULL)
7543 return FALSE;
7544
7545 /* Obtain the addend kept there. */
7546 lo16_howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, lo16_type, FALSE);
7547 l = mips_elf_read_rel_addend (abfd, lo16_relocation, lo16_howto, contents);
7548
7549 l <<= lo16_howto->rightshift;
7550 l = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (l, 16);
7551
7552 *addend <<= 16;
7553 *addend += l;
7554 return TRUE;
7555 }
7556
7557 /* Try to read the contents of section SEC in bfd ABFD. Return true and
7558 store the contents in *CONTENTS on success. Assume that *CONTENTS
7559 already holds the contents if it is nonull on entry. */
7560
7561 static bfd_boolean
7562 mips_elf_get_section_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, bfd_byte **contents)
7563 {
7564 if (*contents)
7565 return TRUE;
7566
7567 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
7568 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
7569 {
7570 *contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
7571 return TRUE;
7572 }
7573
7574 return bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, sec, contents);
7575 }
7576
7577 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
7578 allocate space in the global offset table. */
7579
7580 bfd_boolean
7581 _bfd_mips_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
7582 asection *sec, const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
7583 {
7584 const char *name;
7585 bfd *dynobj;
7586 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7587 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
7588 size_t extsymoff;
7589 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
7590 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
7591 asection *sreloc;
7592 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7593 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7594 bfd_byte *contents;
7595 bfd_vma addend;
7596 reloc_howto_type *howto;
7597
7598 if (info->relocatable)
7599 return TRUE;
7600
7601 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
7602 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
7603
7604 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7605 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
7606 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
7607 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7608
7609 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7610 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
7611
7612 /* Check for the mips16 stub sections. */
7613
7614 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
7615 if (FN_STUB_P (name))
7616 {
7617 unsigned long r_symndx;
7618
7619 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
7620 this is for. */
7621
7622 r_symndx = mips16_stub_symndx (bed, sec, relocs, rel_end);
7623 if (r_symndx == 0)
7624 {
7625 (*_bfd_error_handler)
7626 (_("%B: Warning: cannot determine the target function for"
7627 " stub section `%s'"),
7628 abfd, name);
7629 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7630 return FALSE;
7631 }
7632
7633 if (r_symndx < extsymoff
7634 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
7635 {
7636 asection *o;
7637
7638 /* This stub is for a local symbol. This stub will only be
7639 needed if there is some relocation in this BFD, other
7640 than a 16 bit function call, which refers to this symbol. */
7641 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
7642 {
7643 Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
7644 const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
7645
7646 /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs. */
7647 if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
7648 || o->reloc_count == 0
7649 || section_allows_mips16_refs_p (o))
7650 continue;
7651
7652 sec_relocs
7653 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
7654 info->keep_memory);
7655 if (sec_relocs == NULL)
7656 return FALSE;
7657
7658 rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
7659 for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
7660 if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
7661 && !mips16_call_reloc_p (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info)))
7662 break;
7663
7664 if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
7665 free (sec_relocs);
7666
7667 if (r < rend)
7668 break;
7669 }
7670
7671 if (o == NULL)
7672 {
7673 /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
7674 not need it. Since this function is called before
7675 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
7676 can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
7677 flag. */
7678 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7679 return TRUE;
7680 }
7681
7682 /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol stubs for
7683 this BFD. */
7684 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs == NULL)
7685 {
7686 unsigned long symcount;
7687 asection **n;
7688 bfd_size_type amt;
7689
7690 if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
7691 symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
7692 else
7693 symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7694 amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
7695 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7696 if (n == NULL)
7697 return FALSE;
7698 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs = n;
7699 }
7700
7701 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
7702 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
7703
7704 /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
7705 That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
7706 the global symbol table for stubs. We don't need to set
7707 it here, because we just have a local stub. */
7708 }
7709 else
7710 {
7711 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7712
7713 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
7714 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
7715
7716 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
7717 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
7718 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
7719
7720 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
7721
7722 /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
7723 don't need another one, so we can discard this one. Since
7724 this function is called before the linker maps input sections
7725 to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
7726 SEC_EXCLUDE flag. */
7727 if (h->fn_stub != NULL)
7728 {
7729 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7730 return TRUE;
7731 }
7732
7733 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
7734 h->fn_stub = sec;
7735 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
7736 }
7737 }
7738 else if (CALL_STUB_P (name) || CALL_FP_STUB_P (name))
7739 {
7740 unsigned long r_symndx;
7741 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7742 asection **loc;
7743
7744 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
7745 this is for. */
7746
7747 r_symndx = mips16_stub_symndx (bed, sec, relocs, rel_end);
7748 if (r_symndx == 0)
7749 {
7750 (*_bfd_error_handler)
7751 (_("%B: Warning: cannot determine the target function for"
7752 " stub section `%s'"),
7753 abfd, name);
7754 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7755 return FALSE;
7756 }
7757
7758 if (r_symndx < extsymoff
7759 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
7760 {
7761 asection *o;
7762
7763 /* This stub is for a local symbol. This stub will only be
7764 needed if there is some relocation (R_MIPS16_26) in this BFD
7765 that refers to this symbol. */
7766 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
7767 {
7768 Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
7769 const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
7770
7771 /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs. */
7772 if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
7773 || o->reloc_count == 0
7774 || section_allows_mips16_refs_p (o))
7775 continue;
7776
7777 sec_relocs
7778 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
7779 info->keep_memory);
7780 if (sec_relocs == NULL)
7781 return FALSE;
7782
7783 rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
7784 for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
7785 if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
7786 && ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info) == R_MIPS16_26)
7787 break;
7788
7789 if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
7790 free (sec_relocs);
7791
7792 if (r < rend)
7793 break;
7794 }
7795
7796 if (o == NULL)
7797 {
7798 /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
7799 not need it. Since this function is called before
7800 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
7801 can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
7802 flag. */
7803 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7804 return TRUE;
7805 }
7806
7807 /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol call_stubs for
7808 this BFD. */
7809 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs == NULL)
7810 {
7811 unsigned long symcount;
7812 asection **n;
7813 bfd_size_type amt;
7814
7815 if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
7816 symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
7817 else
7818 symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7819 amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
7820 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7821 if (n == NULL)
7822 return FALSE;
7823 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs = n;
7824 }
7825
7826 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
7827 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
7828
7829 /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
7830 That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
7831 the global symbol table for stubs. We don't need to set
7832 it here, because we just have a local stub. */
7833 }
7834 else
7835 {
7836 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
7837 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
7838
7839 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
7840
7841 if (CALL_FP_STUB_P (name))
7842 loc = &h->call_fp_stub;
7843 else
7844 loc = &h->call_stub;
7845
7846 /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
7847 don't need another one, so we can discard this one. Since
7848 this function is called before the linker maps input sections
7849 to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
7850 SEC_EXCLUDE flag. */
7851 if (*loc != NULL)
7852 {
7853 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7854 return TRUE;
7855 }
7856
7857 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
7858 *loc = sec;
7859 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
7860 }
7861 }
7862
7863 sreloc = NULL;
7864 contents = NULL;
7865 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; ++rel)
7866 {
7867 unsigned long r_symndx;
7868 unsigned int r_type;
7869 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7870 bfd_boolean can_make_dynamic_p;
7871
7872 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, rel->r_info);
7873 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
7874
7875 if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
7876 h = NULL;
7877 else if (r_symndx >= extsymoff + NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr))
7878 {
7879 (*_bfd_error_handler)
7880 (_("%B: Malformed reloc detected for section %s"),
7881 abfd, name);
7882 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7883 return FALSE;
7884 }
7885 else
7886 {
7887 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff];
7888 while (h != NULL
7889 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
7890 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning))
7891 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
7892 }
7893
7894 /* Set CAN_MAKE_DYNAMIC_P to true if we can convert this
7895 relocation into a dynamic one. */
7896 can_make_dynamic_p = FALSE;
7897 switch (r_type)
7898 {
7899 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
7900 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
7901 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
7902 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
7903 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
7904 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
7905 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
7906 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
7907 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
7908 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
7909 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
7910 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
7911 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
7912 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
7913 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
7914 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
7915 case R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
7916 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
7917 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
7918 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
7919 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
7920 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
7921 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
7922 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE:
7923 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_OFST:
7924 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP:
7925 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
7926 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD:
7927 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM:
7928 if (dynobj == NULL)
7929 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
7930 if (!mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info))
7931 return FALSE;
7932 if (htab->is_vxworks && !info->shared)
7933 {
7934 (*_bfd_error_handler)
7935 (_("%B: GOT reloc at 0x%lx not expected in executables"),
7936 abfd, (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
7937 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7938 return FALSE;
7939 }
7940 break;
7941
7942 /* This is just a hint; it can safely be ignored. Don't set
7943 has_static_relocs for the corresponding symbol. */
7944 case R_MIPS_JALR:
7945 case R_MICROMIPS_JALR:
7946 break;
7947
7948 case R_MIPS_32:
7949 case R_MIPS_REL32:
7950 case R_MIPS_64:
7951 /* In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
7952 must be handled using copy relocs or PLT entries; it is not
7953 possible to convert this relocation into a dynamic one.
7954
7955 For executables that use PLTs and copy-relocs, we have a
7956 choice between converting the relocation into a dynamic
7957 one or using copy relocations or PLT entries. It is
7958 usually better to do the former, unless the relocation is
7959 against a read-only section. */
7960 if ((info->shared
7961 || (h != NULL
7962 && !htab->is_vxworks
7963 && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__gnu_local_gp") != 0
7964 && !(!info->nocopyreloc
7965 && !PIC_OBJECT_P (abfd)
7966 && MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))))
7967 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7968 {
7969 can_make_dynamic_p = TRUE;
7970 if (dynobj == NULL)
7971 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
7972 break;
7973 }
7974 /* For sections that are not SEC_ALLOC a copy reloc would be
7975 output if possible (implying questionable semantics for
7976 read-only data objects) or otherwise the final link would
7977 fail as ld.so will not process them and could not therefore
7978 handle any outstanding dynamic relocations.
7979
7980 For such sections that are also SEC_DEBUGGING, we can avoid
7981 these problems by simply ignoring any relocs as these
7982 sections have a predefined use and we know it is safe to do
7983 so.
7984
7985 This is needed in cases such as a global symbol definition
7986 in a shared library causing a common symbol from an object
7987 file to be converted to an undefined reference. If that
7988 happens, then all the relocations against this symbol from
7989 SEC_DEBUGGING sections in the object file will resolve to
7990 nil. */
7991 if ((sec->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0)
7992 break;
7993 /* Fall through. */
7994
7995 default:
7996 /* Most static relocations require pointer equality, except
7997 for branches. */
7998 if (h)
7999 h->pointer_equality_needed = TRUE;
8000 /* Fall through. */
8001
8002 case R_MIPS_26:
8003 case R_MIPS_PC16:
8004 case R_MIPS16_26:
8005 case R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
8006 case R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1:
8007 case R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1:
8008 case R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1:
8009 case R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2:
8010 if (h)
8011 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->has_static_relocs = TRUE;
8012 break;
8013 }
8014
8015 if (h)
8016 {
8017 /* Relocations against the special VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ and
8018 __GOTT_INDEX__ symbols must be left to the loader. Allocate
8019 room for them in .rela.dyn. */
8020 if (is_gott_symbol (info, h))
8021 {
8022 if (sreloc == NULL)
8023 {
8024 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE);
8025 if (sreloc == NULL)
8026 return FALSE;
8027 }
8028 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
8029 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
8030 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
8031 relocations against the text segment. */
8032 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
8033 }
8034 }
8035 else if (call_lo16_reloc_p (r_type)
8036 || got_lo16_reloc_p (r_type)
8037 || got_disp_reloc_p (r_type)
8038 || (got16_reloc_p (r_type) && htab->is_vxworks))
8039 {
8040 /* We may need a local GOT entry for this relocation. We
8041 don't count R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE because we can estimate the
8042 maximum number of pages needed by looking at the size of
8043 the segment. Similar comments apply to R_MIPS*_GOT16 and
8044 R_MIPS*_CALL16, except on VxWorks, where GOT relocations
8045 always evaluate to "G". We don't count R_MIPS_GOT_HI16, or
8046 R_MIPS_CALL_HI16 because these are always followed by an
8047 R_MIPS_GOT_LO16 or R_MIPS_CALL_LO16. */
8048 if (!mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
8049 rel->r_addend, info, 0))
8050 return FALSE;
8051 }
8052
8053 if (h != NULL
8054 && mips_elf_relocation_needs_la25_stub (abfd, r_type,
8055 ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->other)))
8056 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->has_nonpic_branches = TRUE;
8057
8058 switch (r_type)
8059 {
8060 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
8061 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
8062 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
8063 if (h == NULL)
8064 {
8065 (*_bfd_error_handler)
8066 (_("%B: CALL16 reloc at 0x%lx not against global symbol"),
8067 abfd, (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
8068 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8069 return FALSE;
8070 }
8071 /* Fall through. */
8072
8073 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
8074 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
8075 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
8076 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
8077 if (h != NULL)
8078 {
8079 /* Make sure there is room in the regular GOT to hold the
8080 function's address. We may eliminate it in favour of
8081 a .got.plt entry later; see mips_elf_count_got_symbols. */
8082 if (!mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, TRUE, 0))
8083 return FALSE;
8084
8085 /* We need a stub, not a plt entry for the undefined
8086 function. But we record it as if it needs plt. See
8087 _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol. */
8088 h->needs_plt = 1;
8089 h->type = STT_FUNC;
8090 }
8091 break;
8092
8093 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
8094 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE:
8095 /* If this is a global, overridable symbol, GOT_PAGE will
8096 decay to GOT_DISP, so we'll need a GOT entry for it. */
8097 if (h)
8098 {
8099 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
8100 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
8101
8102 /* This symbol is definitely not overridable. */
8103 if (hmips->root.def_regular
8104 && ! (info->shared && ! info->symbolic
8105 && ! hmips->root.forced_local))
8106 h = NULL;
8107 }
8108 /* Fall through. */
8109
8110 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
8111 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
8112 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
8113 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
8114 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
8115 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
8116 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
8117 if (!h || got_page_reloc_p (r_type))
8118 {
8119 /* This relocation needs (or may need, if h != NULL) a
8120 page entry in the GOT. For R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE we do not
8121 know for sure until we know whether the symbol is
8122 preemptible. */
8123 if (mips_elf_rel_relocation_p (abfd, sec, relocs, rel))
8124 {
8125 if (!mips_elf_get_section_contents (abfd, sec, &contents))
8126 return FALSE;
8127 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, r_type, FALSE);
8128 addend = mips_elf_read_rel_addend (abfd, rel,
8129 howto, contents);
8130 if (got16_reloc_p (r_type))
8131 mips_elf_add_lo16_rel_addend (abfd, rel, rel_end,
8132 contents, &addend);
8133 else
8134 addend <<= howto->rightshift;
8135 }
8136 else
8137 addend = rel->r_addend;
8138 if (!mips_elf_record_got_page_entry (info, abfd, r_symndx,
8139 addend))
8140 return FALSE;
8141 }
8142 /* Fall through. */
8143
8144 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
8145 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP:
8146 if (h && !mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info,
8147 FALSE, 0))
8148 return FALSE;
8149 break;
8150
8151 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
8152 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
8153 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
8154 if (info->shared)
8155 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
8156 /* Fall through */
8157
8158 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
8159 case R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
8160 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM:
8161 if (tls_ldm_reloc_p (r_type))
8162 {
8163 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
8164 h = NULL;
8165 }
8166 /* Fall through */
8167
8168 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
8169 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
8170 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD:
8171 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry, or two
8172 for TLS GD relocations. */
8173 {
8174 unsigned char flag;
8175
8176 flag = (tls_gd_reloc_p (r_type)
8177 ? GOT_TLS_GD
8178 : tls_ldm_reloc_p (r_type) ? GOT_TLS_LDM : GOT_TLS_IE);
8179 if (h != NULL)
8180 {
8181 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
8182 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
8183 hmips->tls_type |= flag;
8184
8185 if (h && !mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info,
8186 FALSE, flag))
8187 return FALSE;
8188 }
8189 else
8190 {
8191 BFD_ASSERT (flag == GOT_TLS_LDM || r_symndx != STN_UNDEF);
8192
8193 if (!mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
8194 rel->r_addend,
8195 info, flag))
8196 return FALSE;
8197 }
8198 }
8199 break;
8200
8201 case R_MIPS_32:
8202 case R_MIPS_REL32:
8203 case R_MIPS_64:
8204 /* In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
8205 are handled using copy relocs or PLT stubs, so there's
8206 no need to add a .rela.dyn entry for this relocation. */
8207 if (can_make_dynamic_p)
8208 {
8209 if (sreloc == NULL)
8210 {
8211 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE);
8212 if (sreloc == NULL)
8213 return FALSE;
8214 }
8215 if (info->shared && h == NULL)
8216 {
8217 /* When creating a shared object, we must copy these
8218 reloc types into the output file as R_MIPS_REL32
8219 relocs. Make room for this reloc in .rel(a).dyn. */
8220 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
8221 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
8222 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
8223 relocations against the text segment. */
8224 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
8225 }
8226 else
8227 {
8228 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
8229
8230 /* For a shared object, we must copy this relocation
8231 unless the symbol turns out to be undefined and
8232 weak with non-default visibility, in which case
8233 it will be left as zero.
8234
8235 We could elide R_MIPS_REL32 for locally binding symbols
8236 in shared libraries, but do not yet do so.
8237
8238 For an executable, we only need to copy this
8239 reloc if the symbol is defined in a dynamic
8240 object. */
8241 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
8242 ++hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
8243 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
8244 /* We need it to tell the dynamic linker if there
8245 are relocations against the text segment. */
8246 hmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
8247 }
8248 }
8249
8250 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
8251 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
8252 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
8253 break;
8254
8255 case R_MIPS_26:
8256 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
8257 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
8258 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
8259 case R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
8260 case R_MICROMIPS_GPREL16:
8261 case R_MICROMIPS_LITERAL:
8262 case R_MICROMIPS_GPREL7_S2:
8263 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
8264 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
8265 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
8266 break;
8267
8268 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
8269 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
8270 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
8271 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
8272 return FALSE;
8273 break;
8274
8275 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
8276 used. Record for later use during GC. */
8277 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
8278 BFD_ASSERT (h != NULL);
8279 if (h != NULL
8280 && !bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
8281 return FALSE;
8282 break;
8283
8284 default:
8285 break;
8286 }
8287
8288 /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations
8289 related to taking the function's address. This doesn't apply to
8290 VxWorks, where CALL relocs refer to a .got.plt entry instead of
8291 a normal .got entry. */
8292 if (!htab->is_vxworks && h != NULL)
8293 switch (r_type)
8294 {
8295 default:
8296 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
8297 break;
8298 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
8299 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
8300 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
8301 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
8302 case R_MIPS_JALR:
8303 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
8304 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
8305 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
8306 case R_MICROMIPS_JALR:
8307 break;
8308 }
8309
8310 /* See if this reloc would need to refer to a MIPS16 hard-float stub,
8311 if there is one. We only need to handle global symbols here;
8312 we decide whether to keep or delete stubs for local symbols
8313 when processing the stub's relocations. */
8314 if (h != NULL
8315 && !mips16_call_reloc_p (r_type)
8316 && !section_allows_mips16_refs_p (sec))
8317 {
8318 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *mh;
8319
8320 mh = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
8321 mh->need_fn_stub = TRUE;
8322 }
8323
8324 /* Refuse some position-dependent relocations when creating a
8325 shared library. Do not refuse R_MIPS_32 / R_MIPS_64; they're
8326 not PIC, but we can create dynamic relocations and the result
8327 will be fine. Also do not refuse R_MIPS_LO16, which can be
8328 combined with R_MIPS_GOT16. */
8329 if (info->shared)
8330 {
8331 switch (r_type)
8332 {
8333 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
8334 case R_MIPS_HI16:
8335 case R_MIPS_HIGHER:
8336 case R_MIPS_HIGHEST:
8337 case R_MICROMIPS_HI16:
8338 case R_MICROMIPS_HIGHER:
8339 case R_MICROMIPS_HIGHEST:
8340 /* Don't refuse a high part relocation if it's against
8341 no symbol (e.g. part of a compound relocation). */
8342 if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF)
8343 break;
8344
8345 /* R_MIPS_HI16 against _gp_disp is used for $gp setup,
8346 and has a special meaning. */
8347 if (!NEWABI_P (abfd) && h != NULL
8348 && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_gp_disp") == 0)
8349 break;
8350
8351 /* Likewise __GOTT_BASE__ and __GOTT_INDEX__ on VxWorks. */
8352 if (is_gott_symbol (info, h))
8353 break;
8354
8355 /* FALLTHROUGH */
8356
8357 case R_MIPS16_26:
8358 case R_MIPS_26:
8359 case R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
8360 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, r_type, FALSE);
8361 (*_bfd_error_handler)
8362 (_("%B: relocation %s against `%s' can not be used when making a shared object; recompile with -fPIC"),
8363 abfd, howto->name,
8364 (h) ? h->root.root.string : "a local symbol");
8365 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8366 return FALSE;
8367 default:
8368 break;
8369 }
8370 }
8371 }
8372
8373 return TRUE;
8374 }
8375 \f
8376 bfd_boolean
8377 _bfd_mips_relax_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
8378 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
8379 bfd_boolean *again)
8380 {
8381 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
8382 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend;
8383 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
8384 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
8385 size_t extsymoff;
8386 bfd_boolean changed_contents = FALSE;
8387 bfd_vma sec_start = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
8388 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
8389
8390 /* We are not currently changing any sizes, so only one pass. */
8391 *again = FALSE;
8392
8393 if (link_info->relocatable)
8394 return TRUE;
8395
8396 internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
8397 link_info->keep_memory);
8398 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
8399 return TRUE;
8400
8401 irelend = internal_relocs + sec->reloc_count
8402 * get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
8403 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
8404 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
8405
8406 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
8407 {
8408 bfd_vma symval;
8409 bfd_signed_vma sym_offset;
8410 unsigned int r_type;
8411 unsigned long r_symndx;
8412 asection *sym_sec;
8413 unsigned long instruction;
8414
8415 /* Turn jalr into bgezal, and jr into beq, if they're marked
8416 with a JALR relocation, that indicate where they jump to.
8417 This saves some pipeline bubbles. */
8418 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, irel->r_info);
8419 if (r_type != R_MIPS_JALR)
8420 continue;
8421
8422 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, irel->r_info);
8423 /* Compute the address of the jump target. */
8424 if (r_symndx >= extsymoff)
8425 {
8426 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h
8427 = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
8428 elf_sym_hashes (abfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
8429
8430 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
8431 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
8432 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
8433
8434 /* If a symbol is undefined, or if it may be overridden,
8435 skip it. */
8436 if (! ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
8437 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
8438 && h->root.root.u.def.section)
8439 || (link_info->shared && ! link_info->symbolic
8440 && !h->root.forced_local))
8441 continue;
8442
8443 sym_sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
8444 if (sym_sec->output_section)
8445 symval = (h->root.root.u.def.value
8446 + sym_sec->output_section->vma
8447 + sym_sec->output_offset);
8448 else
8449 symval = h->root.root.u.def.value;
8450 }
8451 else
8452 {
8453 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
8454
8455 /* Read this BFD's symbols if we haven't done so already. */
8456 if (isymbuf == NULL && symtab_hdr->sh_info != 0)
8457 {
8458 isymbuf = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
8459 if (isymbuf == NULL)
8460 isymbuf = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr,
8461 symtab_hdr->sh_info, 0,
8462 NULL, NULL, NULL);
8463 if (isymbuf == NULL)
8464 goto relax_return;
8465 }
8466
8467 isym = isymbuf + r_symndx;
8468 if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_UNDEF)
8469 continue;
8470 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
8471 sym_sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
8472 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON)
8473 sym_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
8474 else
8475 sym_sec
8476 = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
8477 symval = isym->st_value
8478 + sym_sec->output_section->vma
8479 + sym_sec->output_offset;
8480 }
8481
8482 /* Compute branch offset, from delay slot of the jump to the
8483 branch target. */
8484 sym_offset = (symval + irel->r_addend)
8485 - (sec_start + irel->r_offset + 4);
8486
8487 /* Branch offset must be properly aligned. */
8488 if ((sym_offset & 3) != 0)
8489 continue;
8490
8491 sym_offset >>= 2;
8492
8493 /* Check that it's in range. */
8494 if (sym_offset < -0x8000 || sym_offset >= 0x8000)
8495 continue;
8496
8497 /* Get the section contents if we haven't done so already. */
8498 if (!mips_elf_get_section_contents (abfd, sec, &contents))
8499 goto relax_return;
8500
8501 instruction = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + irel->r_offset);
8502
8503 /* If it was jalr <reg>, turn it into bgezal $zero, <target>. */
8504 if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x0000f809)
8505 instruction = 0x04110000;
8506 /* If it was jr <reg>, turn it into b <target>. */
8507 else if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x00000008)
8508 instruction = 0x10000000;
8509 else
8510 continue;
8511
8512 instruction |= (sym_offset & 0xffff);
8513 bfd_put_32 (abfd, instruction, contents + irel->r_offset);
8514 changed_contents = TRUE;
8515 }
8516
8517 if (contents != NULL
8518 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
8519 {
8520 if (!changed_contents && !link_info->keep_memory)
8521 free (contents);
8522 else
8523 {
8524 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
8525 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
8526 }
8527 }
8528 return TRUE;
8529
8530 relax_return:
8531 if (contents != NULL
8532 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
8533 free (contents);
8534 return FALSE;
8535 }
8536 \f
8537 /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
8538
8539 static bfd_boolean
8540 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
8541 {
8542 struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
8543 bfd *dynobj;
8544 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
8545 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8546
8547 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8548 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
8549
8550 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8551 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
8552
8553 /* VxWorks executables are handled elsewhere; we only need to
8554 allocate relocations in shared objects. */
8555 if (htab->is_vxworks && !info->shared)
8556 return TRUE;
8557
8558 /* Ignore indirect symbols. All relocations against such symbols
8559 will be redirected to the target symbol. */
8560 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
8561 return TRUE;
8562
8563 /* If this symbol is defined in a dynamic object, or we are creating
8564 a shared library, we will need to copy any R_MIPS_32 or
8565 R_MIPS_REL32 relocs against it into the output file. */
8566 if (! info->relocatable
8567 && hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs != 0
8568 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
8569 || (!h->def_regular && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h))
8570 || info->shared))
8571 {
8572 bfd_boolean do_copy = TRUE;
8573
8574 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
8575 {
8576 /* Do not copy relocations for undefined weak symbols with
8577 non-default visibility. */
8578 if (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
8579 do_copy = FALSE;
8580
8581 /* Make sure undefined weak symbols are output as a dynamic
8582 symbol in PIEs. */
8583 else if (h->dynindx == -1 && !h->forced_local)
8584 {
8585 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
8586 return FALSE;
8587 }
8588 }
8589
8590 if (do_copy)
8591 {
8592 /* Even though we don't directly need a GOT entry for this symbol,
8593 the SVR4 psABI requires it to have a dynamic symbol table
8594 index greater that DT_MIPS_GOTSYM if there are dynamic
8595 relocations against it.
8596
8597 VxWorks does not enforce the same mapping between the GOT
8598 and the symbol table, so the same requirement does not
8599 apply there. */
8600 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
8601 {
8602 if (hmips->global_got_area > GGA_RELOC_ONLY)
8603 hmips->global_got_area = GGA_RELOC_ONLY;
8604 hmips->got_only_for_calls = FALSE;
8605 }
8606
8607 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations
8608 (dynobj, info, hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs);
8609 if (hmips->readonly_reloc)
8610 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are relocations
8611 against the text segment. */
8612 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
8613 }
8614 }
8615
8616 return TRUE;
8617 }
8618
8619 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
8620 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
8621 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
8622 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
8623 understand. */
8624
8625 bfd_boolean
8626 _bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
8627 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
8628 {
8629 bfd *dynobj;
8630 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
8631 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8632
8633 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8634 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
8635
8636 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8637 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
8638
8639 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
8640 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL
8641 && (h->needs_plt
8642 || h->u.weakdef != NULL
8643 || (h->def_dynamic
8644 && h->ref_regular
8645 && !h->def_regular)));
8646
8647 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
8648
8649 /* If there are call relocations against an externally-defined symbol,
8650 see whether we can create a MIPS lazy-binding stub for it. We can
8651 only do this if all references to the function are through call
8652 relocations, and in that case, the traditional lazy-binding stubs
8653 are much more efficient than PLT entries.
8654
8655 Traditional stubs are only available on SVR4 psABI-based systems;
8656 VxWorks always uses PLTs instead. */
8657 if (!htab->is_vxworks && h->needs_plt && !hmips->no_fn_stub)
8658 {
8659 if (! elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
8660 return TRUE;
8661
8662 /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular file, then set
8663 the symbol to the stub location. This is required to make
8664 function pointers compare as equal between the normal
8665 executable and the shared library. */
8666 if (!h->def_regular)
8667 {
8668 hmips->needs_lazy_stub = TRUE;
8669 htab->lazy_stub_count++;
8670 return TRUE;
8671 }
8672 }
8673 /* As above, VxWorks requires PLT entries for externally-defined
8674 functions that are only accessed through call relocations.
8675
8676 Both VxWorks and non-VxWorks targets also need PLT entries if there
8677 are static-only relocations against an externally-defined function.
8678 This can technically occur for shared libraries if there are
8679 branches to the symbol, although it is unlikely that this will be
8680 used in practice due to the short ranges involved. It can occur
8681 for any relative or absolute relocation in executables; in that
8682 case, the PLT entry becomes the function's canonical address. */
8683 else if (((h->needs_plt && !hmips->no_fn_stub)
8684 || (h->type == STT_FUNC && hmips->has_static_relocs))
8685 && htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs
8686 && !SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
8687 && !(ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT
8688 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
8689 {
8690 /* If this is the first symbol to need a PLT entry, allocate room
8691 for the header. */
8692 if (htab->splt->size == 0)
8693 {
8694 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sgotplt->size == 0);
8695
8696 /* If we're using the PLT additions to the psABI, each PLT
8697 entry is 16 bytes and the PLT0 entry is 32 bytes.
8698 Encourage better cache usage by aligning. We do this
8699 lazily to avoid pessimizing traditional objects. */
8700 if (!htab->is_vxworks
8701 && !bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->splt, 5))
8702 return FALSE;
8703
8704 /* Make sure that .got.plt is word-aligned. We do this lazily
8705 for the same reason as above. */
8706 if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->sgotplt,
8707 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (dynobj)))
8708 return FALSE;
8709
8710 htab->splt->size += htab->plt_header_size;
8711
8712 /* On non-VxWorks targets, the first two entries in .got.plt
8713 are reserved. */
8714 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
8715 htab->sgotplt->size
8716 += get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->got_header_size;
8717
8718 /* On VxWorks, also allocate room for the header's
8719 .rela.plt.unloaded entries. */
8720 if (htab->is_vxworks && !info->shared)
8721 htab->srelplt2->size += 2 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8722 }
8723
8724 /* Assign the next .plt entry to this symbol. */
8725 h->plt.offset = htab->splt->size;
8726 htab->splt->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
8727
8728 /* If the output file has no definition of the symbol, set the
8729 symbol's value to the address of the stub. */
8730 if (!info->shared && !h->def_regular)
8731 {
8732 h->root.u.def.section = htab->splt;
8733 h->root.u.def.value = h->plt.offset;
8734 /* For VxWorks, point at the PLT load stub rather than the
8735 lazy resolution stub; this stub will become the canonical
8736 function address. */
8737 if (htab->is_vxworks)
8738 h->root.u.def.value += 8;
8739 }
8740
8741 /* Make room for the .got.plt entry and the R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT
8742 relocation. */
8743 htab->sgotplt->size += MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (dynobj);
8744 htab->srelplt->size += (htab->is_vxworks
8745 ? MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (dynobj)
8746 : MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (dynobj));
8747
8748 /* Make room for the .rela.plt.unloaded relocations. */
8749 if (htab->is_vxworks && !info->shared)
8750 htab->srelplt2->size += 3 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8751
8752 /* All relocations against this symbol that could have been made
8753 dynamic will now refer to the PLT entry instead. */
8754 hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0;
8755
8756 return TRUE;
8757 }
8758
8759 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
8760 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
8761 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
8762 if (h->u.weakdef != NULL)
8763 {
8764 BFD_ASSERT (h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
8765 || h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
8766 h->root.u.def.section = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.section;
8767 h->root.u.def.value = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.value;
8768 return TRUE;
8769 }
8770
8771 /* Otherwise, there is nothing further to do for symbols defined
8772 in regular objects. */
8773 if (h->def_regular)
8774 return TRUE;
8775
8776 /* There's also nothing more to do if we'll convert all relocations
8777 against this symbol into dynamic relocations. */
8778 if (!hmips->has_static_relocs)
8779 return TRUE;
8780
8781 /* We're now relying on copy relocations. Complain if we have
8782 some that we can't convert. */
8783 if (!htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs || info->shared)
8784 {
8785 (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("non-dynamic relocations refer to "
8786 "dynamic symbol %s"),
8787 h->root.root.string);
8788 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8789 return FALSE;
8790 }
8791
8792 /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
8793 become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
8794 an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
8795 object will contain position independent code, so all references
8796 from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
8797 offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
8798 determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
8799 both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
8800 same memory location for the variable. */
8801
8802 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
8803 {
8804 if (htab->is_vxworks)
8805 htab->srelbss->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8806 else
8807 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
8808 h->needs_copy = 1;
8809 }
8810
8811 /* All relocations against this symbol that could have been made
8812 dynamic will now refer to the local copy instead. */
8813 hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0;
8814
8815 return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (h, htab->sdynbss);
8816 }
8817 \f
8818 /* This function is called after all the input files have been read,
8819 and the input sections have been assigned to output sections. We
8820 check for any mips16 stub sections that we can discard. */
8821
8822 bfd_boolean
8823 _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
8824 struct bfd_link_info *info)
8825 {
8826 asection *ri;
8827 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8828 struct mips_htab_traverse_info hti;
8829
8830 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8831 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
8832
8833 /* The .reginfo section has a fixed size. */
8834 ri = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".reginfo");
8835 if (ri != NULL)
8836 bfd_set_section_size (output_bfd, ri, sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
8837
8838 hti.info = info;
8839 hti.output_bfd = output_bfd;
8840 hti.error = FALSE;
8841 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
8842 mips_elf_check_symbols, &hti);
8843 if (hti.error)
8844 return FALSE;
8845
8846 return TRUE;
8847 }
8848
8849 /* If the link uses a GOT, lay it out and work out its size. */
8850
8851 static bfd_boolean
8852 mips_elf_lay_out_got (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8853 {
8854 bfd *dynobj;
8855 asection *s;
8856 struct mips_got_info *g;
8857 bfd_size_type loadable_size = 0;
8858 bfd_size_type page_gotno;
8859 bfd *sub;
8860 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg count_tls_arg;
8861 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8862
8863 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8864 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
8865
8866 s = htab->sgot;
8867 if (s == NULL)
8868 return TRUE;
8869
8870 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8871 g = htab->got_info;
8872
8873 /* Allocate room for the reserved entries. VxWorks always reserves
8874 3 entries; other objects only reserve 2 entries. */
8875 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno == 0);
8876 if (htab->is_vxworks)
8877 htab->reserved_gotno = 3;
8878 else
8879 htab->reserved_gotno = 2;
8880 g->local_gotno += htab->reserved_gotno;
8881 g->assigned_gotno = htab->reserved_gotno;
8882
8883 /* Replace entries for indirect and warning symbols with entries for
8884 the target symbol. */
8885 if (!mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g))
8886 return FALSE;
8887
8888 /* Count the number of GOT symbols. */
8889 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (htab, mips_elf_count_got_symbols, info);
8890
8891 /* Calculate the total loadable size of the output. That
8892 will give us the maximum number of GOT_PAGE entries
8893 required. */
8894 for (sub = info->input_bfds; sub; sub = sub->link_next)
8895 {
8896 asection *subsection;
8897
8898 for (subsection = sub->sections;
8899 subsection;
8900 subsection = subsection->next)
8901 {
8902 if ((subsection->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
8903 continue;
8904 loadable_size += ((subsection->size + 0xf)
8905 &~ (bfd_size_type) 0xf);
8906 }
8907 }
8908
8909 if (htab->is_vxworks)
8910 /* There's no need to allocate page entries for VxWorks; R_MIPS*_GOT16
8911 relocations against local symbols evaluate to "G", and the EABI does
8912 not include R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE. */
8913 page_gotno = 0;
8914 else
8915 /* Assume there are two loadable segments consisting of contiguous
8916 sections. Is 5 enough? */
8917 page_gotno = (loadable_size >> 16) + 5;
8918
8919 /* Choose the smaller of the two estimates; both are intended to be
8920 conservative. */
8921 if (page_gotno > g->page_gotno)
8922 page_gotno = g->page_gotno;
8923
8924 g->local_gotno += page_gotno;
8925 s->size += g->local_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
8926 s->size += g->global_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
8927
8928 /* We need to calculate tls_gotno for global symbols at this point
8929 instead of building it up earlier, to avoid doublecounting
8930 entries for one global symbol from multiple input files. */
8931 count_tls_arg.info = info;
8932 count_tls_arg.needed = 0;
8933 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info),
8934 mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries,
8935 &count_tls_arg);
8936 g->tls_gotno += count_tls_arg.needed;
8937 s->size += g->tls_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
8938
8939 /* VxWorks does not support multiple GOTs. It initializes $gp to
8940 __GOTT_BASE__[__GOTT_INDEX__], the value of which is set by the
8941 dynamic loader. */
8942 if (htab->is_vxworks)
8943 {
8944 /* VxWorks executables do not need a GOT. */
8945 if (info->shared)
8946 {
8947 /* Each VxWorks GOT entry needs an explicit relocation. */
8948 unsigned int count;
8949
8950 count = g->global_gotno + g->local_gotno - htab->reserved_gotno;
8951 if (count)
8952 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, count);
8953 }
8954 }
8955 else if (s->size > MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (info))
8956 {
8957 if (!mips_elf_multi_got (output_bfd, info, s, page_gotno))
8958 return FALSE;
8959 }
8960 else
8961 {
8962 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg arg;
8963
8964 /* Set up TLS entries. */
8965 g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->global_gotno + g->local_gotno;
8966 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, g);
8967
8968 /* Allocate room for the TLS relocations. */
8969 arg.info = info;
8970 arg.needed = 0;
8971 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs, &arg);
8972 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info),
8973 mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs,
8974 &arg);
8975 if (arg.needed)
8976 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, arg.needed);
8977 }
8978
8979 return TRUE;
8980 }
8981
8982 /* Estimate the size of the .MIPS.stubs section. */
8983
8984 static void
8985 mips_elf_estimate_stub_size (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8986 {
8987 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8988 bfd_size_type dynsymcount;
8989
8990 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8991 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
8992
8993 if (htab->lazy_stub_count == 0)
8994 return;
8995
8996 /* IRIX rld assumes that a function stub isn't at the end of the .text
8997 section, so add a dummy entry to the end. */
8998 htab->lazy_stub_count++;
8999
9000 /* Get a worst-case estimate of the number of dynamic symbols needed.
9001 At this point, dynsymcount does not account for section symbols
9002 and count_section_dynsyms may overestimate the number that will
9003 be needed. */
9004 dynsymcount = (elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
9005 + count_section_dynsyms (output_bfd, info));
9006
9007 /* Determine the size of one stub entry. */
9008 htab->function_stub_size = (dynsymcount > 0x10000
9009 ? MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE
9010 : MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE);
9011
9012 htab->sstubs->size = htab->lazy_stub_count * htab->function_stub_size;
9013 }
9014
9015 /* A mips_elf_link_hash_traverse callback for which DATA points to the
9016 MIPS hash table. If H needs a traditional MIPS lazy-binding stub,
9017 allocate an entry in the stubs section. */
9018
9019 static bfd_boolean
9020 mips_elf_allocate_lazy_stub (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void **data)
9021 {
9022 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9023
9024 htab = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) data;
9025 if (h->needs_lazy_stub)
9026 {
9027 h->root.root.u.def.section = htab->sstubs;
9028 h->root.root.u.def.value = htab->sstubs->size;
9029 h->root.plt.offset = htab->sstubs->size;
9030 htab->sstubs->size += htab->function_stub_size;
9031 }
9032 return TRUE;
9033 }
9034
9035 /* Allocate offsets in the stubs section to each symbol that needs one.
9036 Set the final size of the .MIPS.stub section. */
9037
9038 static void
9039 mips_elf_lay_out_lazy_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info)
9040 {
9041 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9042
9043 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9044 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9045
9046 if (htab->lazy_stub_count == 0)
9047 return;
9048
9049 htab->sstubs->size = 0;
9050 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (htab, mips_elf_allocate_lazy_stub, htab);
9051 htab->sstubs->size += htab->function_stub_size;
9052 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sstubs->size
9053 == htab->lazy_stub_count * htab->function_stub_size);
9054 }
9055
9056 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
9057
9058 bfd_boolean
9059 _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9060 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9061 {
9062 bfd *dynobj;
9063 asection *s, *sreldyn;
9064 bfd_boolean reltext;
9065 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9066
9067 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9068 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9069 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
9070 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL);
9071
9072 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
9073 {
9074 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
9075 if (info->executable)
9076 {
9077 s = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".interp");
9078 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9079 s->size
9080 = strlen (ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd)) + 1;
9081 s->contents
9082 = (bfd_byte *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd);
9083 }
9084
9085 /* Create a symbol for the PLT, if we know that we are using it. */
9086 if (htab->splt && htab->splt->size > 0 && htab->root.hplt == NULL)
9087 {
9088 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9089
9090 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
9091
9092 h = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (dynobj, info, htab->splt,
9093 "_PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_");
9094 htab->root.hplt = h;
9095 if (h == NULL)
9096 return FALSE;
9097 h->type = STT_FUNC;
9098 }
9099 }
9100
9101 /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
9102 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->root, allocate_dynrelocs, info);
9103
9104 mips_elf_estimate_stub_size (output_bfd, info);
9105
9106 if (!mips_elf_lay_out_got (output_bfd, info))
9107 return FALSE;
9108
9109 mips_elf_lay_out_lazy_stubs (info);
9110
9111 /* The check_relocs and adjust_dynamic_symbol entry points have
9112 determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections. Allocate
9113 memory for them. */
9114 reltext = FALSE;
9115 for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
9116 {
9117 const char *name;
9118
9119 /* It's OK to base decisions on the section name, because none
9120 of the dynobj section names depend upon the input files. */
9121 name = bfd_get_section_name (dynobj, s);
9122
9123 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
9124 continue;
9125
9126 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".rel"))
9127 {
9128 if (s->size != 0)
9129 {
9130 const char *outname;
9131 asection *target;
9132
9133 /* If this relocation section applies to a read only
9134 section, then we probably need a DT_TEXTREL entry.
9135 If the relocation section is .rel(a).dyn, we always
9136 assert a DT_TEXTREL entry rather than testing whether
9137 there exists a relocation to a read only section or
9138 not. */
9139 outname = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd,
9140 s->output_section);
9141 target = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, outname + 4);
9142 if ((target != NULL
9143 && (target->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0
9144 && (target->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
9145 || strcmp (outname, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) == 0)
9146 reltext = TRUE;
9147
9148 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
9149 to copy relocs into the output file. */
9150 if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) != 0)
9151 s->reloc_count = 0;
9152
9153 /* If combreloc is enabled, elf_link_sort_relocs() will
9154 sort relocations, but in a different way than we do,
9155 and before we're done creating relocations. Also, it
9156 will move them around between input sections'
9157 relocation's contents, so our sorting would be
9158 broken, so don't let it run. */
9159 info->combreloc = 0;
9160 }
9161 }
9162 else if (! info->shared
9163 && ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
9164 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".rld_map"))
9165 {
9166 /* We add a room for __rld_map. It will be filled in by the
9167 rtld to contain a pointer to the _r_debug structure. */
9168 s->size += MIPS_ELF_RLD_MAP_SIZE (output_bfd);
9169 }
9170 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
9171 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".compact_rel"))
9172 s->size += mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size;
9173 else if (s == htab->splt)
9174 {
9175 /* If the last PLT entry has a branch delay slot, allocate
9176 room for an extra nop to fill the delay slot. This is
9177 for CPUs without load interlocking. */
9178 if (! LOAD_INTERLOCKS_P (output_bfd)
9179 && ! htab->is_vxworks && s->size > 0)
9180 s->size += 4;
9181 }
9182 else if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".init")
9183 && s != htab->sgot
9184 && s != htab->sgotplt
9185 && s != htab->sstubs
9186 && s != htab->sdynbss)
9187 {
9188 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
9189 continue;
9190 }
9191
9192 if (s->size == 0)
9193 {
9194 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
9195 continue;
9196 }
9197
9198 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
9199 continue;
9200
9201 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
9202 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->size);
9203 if (s->contents == NULL)
9204 {
9205 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
9206 return FALSE;
9207 }
9208 }
9209
9210 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
9211 {
9212 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
9213 values later, in _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
9214 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
9215 the .dynamic section. */
9216
9217 /* SGI object has the equivalence of DT_DEBUG in the
9218 DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP entry. This must come first because glibc
9219 only fills in DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP (not DT_DEBUG) and some tools
9220 may only look at the first one they see. */
9221 if (!info->shared
9222 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP, 0))
9223 return FALSE;
9224
9225 /* The DT_DEBUG entry may be filled in by the dynamic linker and
9226 used by the debugger. */
9227 if (info->executable
9228 && !SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
9229 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_DEBUG, 0))
9230 return FALSE;
9231
9232 if (reltext && (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd) || htab->is_vxworks))
9233 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
9234
9235 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
9236 {
9237 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_TEXTREL, 0))
9238 return FALSE;
9239
9240 /* Clear the DF_TEXTREL flag. It will be set again if we
9241 write out an actual text relocation; we may not, because
9242 at this point we do not know whether e.g. any .eh_frame
9243 absolute relocations have been converted to PC-relative. */
9244 info->flags &= ~DF_TEXTREL;
9245 }
9246
9247 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTGOT, 0))
9248 return FALSE;
9249
9250 sreldyn = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
9251 if (htab->is_vxworks)
9252 {
9253 /* VxWorks uses .rela.dyn instead of .rel.dyn. It does not
9254 use any of the DT_MIPS_* tags. */
9255 if (sreldyn && sreldyn->size > 0)
9256 {
9257 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELA, 0))
9258 return FALSE;
9259
9260 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELASZ, 0))
9261 return FALSE;
9262
9263 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELAENT, 0))
9264 return FALSE;
9265 }
9266 }
9267 else
9268 {
9269 if (sreldyn && sreldyn->size > 0)
9270 {
9271 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_REL, 0))
9272 return FALSE;
9273
9274 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELSZ, 0))
9275 return FALSE;
9276
9277 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELENT, 0))
9278 return FALSE;
9279 }
9280
9281 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION, 0))
9282 return FALSE;
9283
9284 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_FLAGS, 0))
9285 return FALSE;
9286
9287 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS, 0))
9288 return FALSE;
9289
9290 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO, 0))
9291 return FALSE;
9292
9293 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, 0))
9294 return FALSE;
9295
9296 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO, 0))
9297 return FALSE;
9298
9299 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_GOTSYM, 0))
9300 return FALSE;
9301
9302 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix5
9303 && ! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO, 0))
9304 return FALSE;
9305
9306 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix6
9307 && (bfd_get_section_by_name
9308 (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (dynobj)))
9309 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_OPTIONS, 0))
9310 return FALSE;
9311 }
9312 if (htab->splt->size > 0)
9313 {
9314 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTREL, 0))
9315 return FALSE;
9316
9317 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_JMPREL, 0))
9318 return FALSE;
9319
9320 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTRELSZ, 0))
9321 return FALSE;
9322
9323 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_PLTGOT, 0))
9324 return FALSE;
9325 }
9326 if (htab->is_vxworks
9327 && !elf_vxworks_add_dynamic_entries (output_bfd, info))
9328 return FALSE;
9329 }
9330
9331 return TRUE;
9332 }
9333 \f
9334 /* REL is a relocation in INPUT_BFD that is being copied to OUTPUT_BFD.
9335 Adjust its R_ADDEND field so that it is correct for the output file.
9336 LOCAL_SYMS and LOCAL_SECTIONS are arrays of INPUT_BFD's local symbols
9337 and sections respectively; both use symbol indexes. */
9338
9339 static void
9340 mips_elf_adjust_addend (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
9341 bfd *input_bfd, Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
9342 asection **local_sections, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
9343 {
9344 unsigned int r_type, r_symndx;
9345 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9346 asection *sec;
9347
9348 if (mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections))
9349 {
9350 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
9351 if (gprel16_reloc_p (r_type)
9352 || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL32
9353 || literal_reloc_p (r_type))
9354 {
9355 rel->r_addend += _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
9356 rel->r_addend -= _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd);
9357 }
9358
9359 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
9360 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
9361
9362 /* Adjust REL's addend to account for section merging. */
9363 if (!info->relocatable)
9364 {
9365 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
9366 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
9367 }
9368
9369 /* This would normally be done by the rela_normal code in elflink.c. */
9370 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
9371 rel->r_addend += local_sections[r_symndx]->output_offset;
9372 }
9373 }
9374
9375 /* Handle relocations against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
9376 or sections discarded by a linker script. We use this wrapper around
9377 RELOC_AGAINST_DISCARDED_SECTION to handle triplets of compound relocs
9378 on 64-bit ELF targets. In this case for any relocation handled, which
9379 always be the first in a triplet, the remaining two have to be processed
9380 together with the first, even if they are R_MIPS_NONE. It is the symbol
9381 index referred by the first reloc that applies to all the three and the
9382 remaining two never refer to an object symbol. And it is the final
9383 relocation (the last non-null one) that determines the output field of
9384 the whole relocation so retrieve the corresponding howto structure for
9385 the relocatable field to be cleared by RELOC_AGAINST_DISCARDED_SECTION.
9386
9387 Note that RELOC_AGAINST_DISCARDED_SECTION is a macro that uses "continue"
9388 and therefore requires to be pasted in a loop. It also defines a block
9389 and does not protect any of its arguments, hence the extra brackets. */
9390
9391 static void
9392 mips_reloc_against_discarded_section (bfd *output_bfd,
9393 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9394 bfd *input_bfd, asection *input_section,
9395 Elf_Internal_Rela **rel,
9396 const Elf_Internal_Rela **relend,
9397 bfd_boolean rel_reloc,
9398 reloc_howto_type *howto,
9399 bfd_byte *contents)
9400 {
9401 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
9402 int count = bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
9403 unsigned int r_type;
9404 int i;
9405
9406 for (i = count - 1; i > 0; i--)
9407 {
9408 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, (*rel)[i].r_info);
9409 if (r_type != R_MIPS_NONE)
9410 {
9411 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, r_type, !rel_reloc);
9412 break;
9413 }
9414 }
9415 do
9416 {
9417 RELOC_AGAINST_DISCARDED_SECTION (info, input_bfd, input_section,
9418 (*rel), count, (*relend),
9419 howto, i, contents);
9420 }
9421 while (0);
9422 }
9423
9424 /* Relocate a MIPS ELF section. */
9425
9426 bfd_boolean
9427 _bfd_mips_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
9428 bfd *input_bfd, asection *input_section,
9429 bfd_byte *contents, Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
9430 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
9431 asection **local_sections)
9432 {
9433 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
9434 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
9435 bfd_vma addend = 0;
9436 bfd_boolean use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
9437 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
9438
9439 bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
9440 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
9441 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; ++rel)
9442 {
9443 const char *name;
9444 bfd_vma value = 0;
9445 reloc_howto_type *howto;
9446 bfd_boolean cross_mode_jump_p;
9447 /* TRUE if the relocation is a RELA relocation, rather than a
9448 REL relocation. */
9449 bfd_boolean rela_relocation_p = TRUE;
9450 unsigned int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
9451 const char *msg;
9452 unsigned long r_symndx;
9453 asection *sec;
9454 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9455 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9456 bfd_boolean rel_reloc;
9457
9458 rel_reloc = (NEWABI_P (input_bfd)
9459 && mips_elf_rel_relocation_p (input_bfd, input_section,
9460 relocs, rel));
9461 /* Find the relocation howto for this relocation. */
9462 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, r_type, !rel_reloc);
9463
9464 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, rel->r_info);
9465 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
9466 if (mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections))
9467 {
9468 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
9469 h = NULL;
9470 }
9471 else
9472 {
9473 unsigned long extsymoff;
9474
9475 extsymoff = 0;
9476 if (!elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
9477 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9478 h = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff];
9479 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
9480 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
9481 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
9482
9483 sec = NULL;
9484 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
9485 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
9486 sec = h->root.u.def.section;
9487 }
9488
9489 if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
9490 {
9491 mips_reloc_against_discarded_section (output_bfd, info, input_bfd,
9492 input_section, &rel, &relend,
9493 rel_reloc, howto, contents);
9494 continue;
9495 }
9496
9497 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
9498 {
9499 /* Some 32-bit code uses R_MIPS_64. In particular, people use
9500 64-bit code, but make sure all their addresses are in the
9501 lowermost or uppermost 32-bit section of the 64-bit address
9502 space. Thus, when they use an R_MIPS_64 they mean what is
9503 usually meant by R_MIPS_32, with the exception that the
9504 stored value is sign-extended to 64 bits. */
9505 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, R_MIPS_32, FALSE);
9506
9507 /* On big-endian systems, we need to lie about the position
9508 of the reloc. */
9509 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
9510 rel->r_offset += 4;
9511 }
9512
9513 if (!use_saved_addend_p)
9514 {
9515 /* If these relocations were originally of the REL variety,
9516 we must pull the addend out of the field that will be
9517 relocated. Otherwise, we simply use the contents of the
9518 RELA relocation. */
9519 if (mips_elf_rel_relocation_p (input_bfd, input_section,
9520 relocs, rel))
9521 {
9522 rela_relocation_p = FALSE;
9523 addend = mips_elf_read_rel_addend (input_bfd, rel,
9524 howto, contents);
9525 if (hi16_reloc_p (r_type)
9526 || (got16_reloc_p (r_type)
9527 && mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel,
9528 local_sections)))
9529 {
9530 if (!mips_elf_add_lo16_rel_addend (input_bfd, rel, relend,
9531 contents, &addend))
9532 {
9533 if (h)
9534 name = h->root.root.string;
9535 else
9536 name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr,
9537 local_syms + r_symndx,
9538 sec);
9539 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9540 (_("%B: Can't find matching LO16 reloc against `%s' for %s at 0x%lx in section `%A'"),
9541 input_bfd, input_section, name, howto->name,
9542 rel->r_offset);
9543 }
9544 }
9545 else
9546 addend <<= howto->rightshift;
9547 }
9548 else
9549 addend = rel->r_addend;
9550 mips_elf_adjust_addend (output_bfd, info, input_bfd,
9551 local_syms, local_sections, rel);
9552 }
9553
9554 if (info->relocatable)
9555 {
9556 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd)
9557 && bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
9558 rel->r_offset -= 4;
9559
9560 if (!rela_relocation_p && rel->r_addend)
9561 {
9562 addend += rel->r_addend;
9563 if (hi16_reloc_p (r_type) || got16_reloc_p (r_type))
9564 addend = mips_elf_high (addend);
9565 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHER)
9566 addend = mips_elf_higher (addend);
9567 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHEST)
9568 addend = mips_elf_highest (addend);
9569 else
9570 addend >>= howto->rightshift;
9571
9572 /* We use the source mask, rather than the destination
9573 mask because the place to which we are writing will be
9574 source of the addend in the final link. */
9575 addend &= howto->src_mask;
9576
9577 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
9578 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
9579 ABI. Here, we need to update the addend. It would be
9580 possible to get away with just using the R_MIPS_32 reloc
9581 but for endianness. */
9582 {
9583 bfd_vma sign_bits;
9584 bfd_vma low_bits;
9585 bfd_vma high_bits;
9586
9587 if (addend & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
9588 #ifdef BFD64
9589 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
9590 #else
9591 sign_bits = -1;
9592 #endif
9593 else
9594 sign_bits = 0;
9595
9596 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
9597 do two separate stores. */
9598 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
9599 {
9600 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
9601 first. */
9602 low_bits = sign_bits;
9603 high_bits = addend;
9604 }
9605 else
9606 {
9607 low_bits = addend;
9608 high_bits = sign_bits;
9609 }
9610 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
9611 contents + rel->r_offset);
9612 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
9613 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
9614 continue;
9615 }
9616
9617 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, addend,
9618 input_bfd, input_section,
9619 contents, FALSE))
9620 return FALSE;
9621 }
9622
9623 /* Go on to the next relocation. */
9624 continue;
9625 }
9626
9627 /* In the N32 and 64-bit ABIs there may be multiple consecutive
9628 relocations for the same offset. In that case we are
9629 supposed to treat the output of each relocation as the addend
9630 for the next. */
9631 if (rel + 1 < relend
9632 && rel->r_offset == rel[1].r_offset
9633 && ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, rel[1].r_info) != R_MIPS_NONE)
9634 use_saved_addend_p = TRUE;
9635 else
9636 use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
9637
9638 /* Figure out what value we are supposed to relocate. */
9639 switch (mips_elf_calculate_relocation (output_bfd, input_bfd,
9640 input_section, info, rel,
9641 addend, howto, local_syms,
9642 local_sections, &value,
9643 &name, &cross_mode_jump_p,
9644 use_saved_addend_p))
9645 {
9646 case bfd_reloc_continue:
9647 /* There's nothing to do. */
9648 continue;
9649
9650 case bfd_reloc_undefined:
9651 /* mips_elf_calculate_relocation already called the
9652 undefined_symbol callback. There's no real point in
9653 trying to perform the relocation at this point, so we
9654 just skip ahead to the next relocation. */
9655 continue;
9656
9657 case bfd_reloc_notsupported:
9658 msg = _("internal error: unsupported relocation error");
9659 info->callbacks->warning
9660 (info, msg, name, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
9661 return FALSE;
9662
9663 case bfd_reloc_overflow:
9664 if (use_saved_addend_p)
9665 /* Ignore overflow until we reach the last relocation for
9666 a given location. */
9667 ;
9668 else
9669 {
9670 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9671
9672 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9673 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9674 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
9675 if (!htab->small_data_overflow_reported
9676 && (gprel16_reloc_p (howto->type)
9677 || literal_reloc_p (howto->type)))
9678 {
9679 msg = _("small-data section exceeds 64KB;"
9680 " lower small-data size limit (see option -G)");
9681
9682 htab->small_data_overflow_reported = TRUE;
9683 (*info->callbacks->einfo) ("%P: %s\n", msg);
9684 }
9685 if (! ((*info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
9686 (info, NULL, name, howto->name, (bfd_vma) 0,
9687 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset)))
9688 return FALSE;
9689 }
9690 break;
9691
9692 case bfd_reloc_ok:
9693 break;
9694
9695 case bfd_reloc_outofrange:
9696 if (jal_reloc_p (howto->type))
9697 {
9698 msg = _("JALX to a non-word-aligned address");
9699 info->callbacks->warning
9700 (info, msg, name, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
9701 return FALSE;
9702 }
9703 /* Fall through. */
9704
9705 default:
9706 abort ();
9707 break;
9708 }
9709
9710 /* If we've got another relocation for the address, keep going
9711 until we reach the last one. */
9712 if (use_saved_addend_p)
9713 {
9714 addend = value;
9715 continue;
9716 }
9717
9718 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
9719 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
9720 ABI. Until now, we've been using the HOWTO for R_MIPS_32;
9721 that calculated the right value. Now, however, we
9722 sign-extend the 32-bit result to 64-bits, and store it as a
9723 64-bit value. We are especially generous here in that we
9724 go to extreme lengths to support this usage on systems with
9725 only a 32-bit VMA. */
9726 {
9727 bfd_vma sign_bits;
9728 bfd_vma low_bits;
9729 bfd_vma high_bits;
9730
9731 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
9732 #ifdef BFD64
9733 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
9734 #else
9735 sign_bits = -1;
9736 #endif
9737 else
9738 sign_bits = 0;
9739
9740 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
9741 do two separate stores. */
9742 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
9743 {
9744 /* Undo what we did above. */
9745 rel->r_offset -= 4;
9746 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
9747 first. */
9748 low_bits = sign_bits;
9749 high_bits = value;
9750 }
9751 else
9752 {
9753 low_bits = value;
9754 high_bits = sign_bits;
9755 }
9756 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
9757 contents + rel->r_offset);
9758 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
9759 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
9760 continue;
9761 }
9762
9763 /* Actually perform the relocation. */
9764 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, value,
9765 input_bfd, input_section,
9766 contents, cross_mode_jump_p))
9767 return FALSE;
9768 }
9769
9770 return TRUE;
9771 }
9772 \f
9773 /* A function that iterates over each entry in la25_stubs and fills
9774 in the code for each one. DATA points to a mips_htab_traverse_info. */
9775
9776 static int
9777 mips_elf_create_la25_stub (void **slot, void *data)
9778 {
9779 struct mips_htab_traverse_info *hti;
9780 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9781 struct mips_elf_la25_stub *stub;
9782 asection *s;
9783 bfd_byte *loc;
9784 bfd_vma offset, target, target_high, target_low;
9785
9786 stub = (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *) *slot;
9787 hti = (struct mips_htab_traverse_info *) data;
9788 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (hti->info);
9789 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9790
9791 /* Create the section contents, if we haven't already. */
9792 s = stub->stub_section;
9793 loc = s->contents;
9794 if (loc == NULL)
9795 {
9796 loc = bfd_malloc (s->size);
9797 if (loc == NULL)
9798 {
9799 hti->error = TRUE;
9800 return FALSE;
9801 }
9802 s->contents = loc;
9803 }
9804
9805 /* Work out where in the section this stub should go. */
9806 offset = stub->offset;
9807
9808 /* Work out the target address. */
9809 target = mips_elf_get_la25_target (stub, &s);
9810 target += s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9811
9812 target_high = ((target + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
9813 target_low = (target & 0xffff);
9814
9815 if (stub->stub_section != htab->strampoline)
9816 {
9817 /* This is a simple LUI/ADDIU stub. Zero out the beginning
9818 of the section and write the two instructions at the end. */
9819 memset (loc, 0, offset);
9820 loc += offset;
9821 if (ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (stub->h->root.other))
9822 {
9823 bfd_put_micromips_32 (hti->output_bfd,
9824 LA25_LUI_MICROMIPS (target_high),
9825 loc);
9826 bfd_put_micromips_32 (hti->output_bfd,
9827 LA25_ADDIU_MICROMIPS (target_low),
9828 loc + 4);
9829 }
9830 else
9831 {
9832 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_LUI (target_high), loc);
9833 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_ADDIU (target_low), loc + 4);
9834 }
9835 }
9836 else
9837 {
9838 /* This is trampoline. */
9839 loc += offset;
9840 if (ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (stub->h->root.other))
9841 {
9842 bfd_put_micromips_32 (hti->output_bfd,
9843 LA25_LUI_MICROMIPS (target_high), loc);
9844 bfd_put_micromips_32 (hti->output_bfd,
9845 LA25_J_MICROMIPS (target), loc + 4);
9846 bfd_put_micromips_32 (hti->output_bfd,
9847 LA25_ADDIU_MICROMIPS (target_low), loc + 8);
9848 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, 0, loc + 12);
9849 }
9850 else
9851 {
9852 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_LUI (target_high), loc);
9853 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_J (target), loc + 4);
9854 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_ADDIU (target_low), loc + 8);
9855 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, 0, loc + 12);
9856 }
9857 }
9858 return TRUE;
9859 }
9860
9861 /* If NAME is one of the special IRIX6 symbols defined by the linker,
9862 adjust it appropriately now. */
9863
9864 static void
9865 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9866 const char *name, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9867 {
9868 /* The linker script takes care of providing names and values for
9869 these, but we must place them into the right sections. */
9870 static const char* const text_section_symbols[] = {
9871 "_ftext",
9872 "_etext",
9873 "__dso_displacement",
9874 "__elf_header",
9875 "__program_header_table",
9876 NULL
9877 };
9878
9879 static const char* const data_section_symbols[] = {
9880 "_fdata",
9881 "_edata",
9882 "_end",
9883 "_fbss",
9884 NULL
9885 };
9886
9887 const char* const *p;
9888 int i;
9889
9890 for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
9891 for (p = (i == 0) ? text_section_symbols : data_section_symbols;
9892 *p;
9893 ++p)
9894 if (strcmp (*p, name) == 0)
9895 {
9896 /* All of these symbols are given type STT_SECTION by the
9897 IRIX6 linker. */
9898 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
9899 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
9900
9901 /* The IRIX linker puts these symbols in special sections. */
9902 if (i == 0)
9903 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
9904 else
9905 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
9906
9907 break;
9908 }
9909 }
9910
9911 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
9912 dynamic sections here. */
9913
9914 bfd_boolean
9915 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
9916 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9917 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9918 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9919 {
9920 bfd *dynobj;
9921 asection *sgot;
9922 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
9923 const char *name;
9924 int idx;
9925 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9926 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
9927
9928 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9929 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9930 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
9931 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
9932
9933 BFD_ASSERT (!htab->is_vxworks);
9934
9935 if (h->plt.offset != MINUS_ONE && hmips->no_fn_stub)
9936 {
9937 /* We've decided to create a PLT entry for this symbol. */
9938 bfd_byte *loc;
9939 bfd_vma header_address, plt_index, got_address;
9940 bfd_vma got_address_high, got_address_low, load;
9941 const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
9942
9943 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
9944 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9945 BFD_ASSERT (htab->splt != NULL);
9946 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset <= htab->splt->size);
9947 BFD_ASSERT (!h->def_regular);
9948
9949 /* Calculate the address of the PLT header. */
9950 header_address = (htab->splt->output_section->vma
9951 + htab->splt->output_offset);
9952
9953 /* Calculate the index of the entry. */
9954 plt_index = ((h->plt.offset - htab->plt_header_size)
9955 / htab->plt_entry_size);
9956
9957 /* Calculate the address of the .got.plt entry. */
9958 got_address = (htab->sgotplt->output_section->vma
9959 + htab->sgotplt->output_offset
9960 + (2 + plt_index) * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (dynobj));
9961 got_address_high = ((got_address + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
9962 got_address_low = got_address & 0xffff;
9963
9964 /* Initially point the .got.plt entry at the PLT header. */
9965 loc = (htab->sgotplt->contents
9966 + (2 + plt_index) * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (dynobj));
9967 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
9968 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, header_address, loc);
9969 else
9970 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, header_address, loc);
9971
9972 /* Find out where the .plt entry should go. */
9973 loc = htab->splt->contents + h->plt.offset;
9974
9975 /* Pick the load opcode. */
9976 load = MIPS_ELF_LOAD_WORD (output_bfd);
9977
9978 /* Fill in the PLT entry itself. */
9979 plt_entry = mips_exec_plt_entry;
9980 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | got_address_high, loc);
9981 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | got_address_low | load, loc + 4);
9982
9983 if (! LOAD_INTERLOCKS_P (output_bfd))
9984 {
9985 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2] | got_address_low, loc + 8);
9986 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 12);
9987 }
9988 else
9989 {
9990 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 8);
9991 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2] | got_address_low, loc + 12);
9992 }
9993
9994 /* Emit an R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT relocation against the .got.plt entry. */
9995 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation (output_bfd, htab->srelplt,
9996 plt_index, h->dynindx,
9997 R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT, got_address);
9998
9999 /* We distinguish between PLT entries and lazy-binding stubs by
10000 giving the former an st_other value of STO_MIPS_PLT. Set the
10001 flag and leave the value if there are any relocations in the
10002 binary where pointer equality matters. */
10003 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
10004 if (h->pointer_equality_needed)
10005 sym->st_other = STO_MIPS_PLT;
10006 else
10007 sym->st_value = 0;
10008 }
10009 else if (h->plt.offset != MINUS_ONE)
10010 {
10011 /* We've decided to create a lazy-binding stub. */
10012 bfd_byte stub[MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE];
10013
10014 /* This symbol has a stub. Set it up. */
10015
10016 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
10017
10018 BFD_ASSERT ((htab->function_stub_size == MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE)
10019 || (h->dynindx <= 0xffff));
10020
10021 /* Values up to 2^31 - 1 are allowed. Larger values would cause
10022 sign extension at runtime in the stub, resulting in a negative
10023 index value. */
10024 if (h->dynindx & ~0x7fffffff)
10025 return FALSE;
10026
10027 /* Fill the stub. */
10028 idx = 0;
10029 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LW (output_bfd), stub + idx);
10030 idx += 4;
10031 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_MOVE (output_bfd), stub + idx);
10032 idx += 4;
10033 if (htab->function_stub_size == MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE)
10034 {
10035 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LUI ((h->dynindx >> 16) & 0x7fff),
10036 stub + idx);
10037 idx += 4;
10038 }
10039 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_JALR, stub + idx);
10040 idx += 4;
10041
10042 /* If a large stub is not required and sign extension is not a
10043 problem, then use legacy code in the stub. */
10044 if (htab->function_stub_size == MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE)
10045 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_ORI (h->dynindx & 0xffff), stub + idx);
10046 else if (h->dynindx & ~0x7fff)
10047 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16U (h->dynindx & 0xffff), stub + idx);
10048 else
10049 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16S (output_bfd, h->dynindx),
10050 stub + idx);
10051
10052 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset <= htab->sstubs->size);
10053 memcpy (htab->sstubs->contents + h->plt.offset,
10054 stub, htab->function_stub_size);
10055
10056 /* Mark the symbol as undefined. plt.offset != -1 occurs
10057 only for the referenced symbol. */
10058 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
10059
10060 /* The run-time linker uses the st_value field of the symbol
10061 to reset the global offset table entry for this external
10062 to its stub address when unlinking a shared object. */
10063 sym->st_value = (htab->sstubs->output_section->vma
10064 + htab->sstubs->output_offset
10065 + h->plt.offset);
10066 }
10067
10068 /* If we have a MIPS16 function with a stub, the dynamic symbol must
10069 refer to the stub, since only the stub uses the standard calling
10070 conventions. */
10071 if (h->dynindx != -1 && hmips->fn_stub != NULL)
10072 {
10073 BFD_ASSERT (hmips->need_fn_stub);
10074 sym->st_value = (hmips->fn_stub->output_section->vma
10075 + hmips->fn_stub->output_offset);
10076 sym->st_size = hmips->fn_stub->size;
10077 sym->st_other = ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (sym->st_other);
10078 }
10079
10080 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1
10081 || h->forced_local);
10082
10083 sgot = htab->sgot;
10084 g = htab->got_info;
10085 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
10086
10087 /* Run through the global symbol table, creating GOT entries for all
10088 the symbols that need them. */
10089 if (hmips->global_got_area != GGA_NONE)
10090 {
10091 bfd_vma offset;
10092 bfd_vma value;
10093
10094 value = sym->st_value;
10095 offset = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, output_bfd, h,
10096 R_MIPS_GOT16, info);
10097 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, value, sgot->contents + offset);
10098 }
10099
10100 if (hmips->global_got_area != GGA_NONE && g->next && h->type != STT_TLS)
10101 {
10102 struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
10103 bfd_vma entry;
10104 bfd_vma offset;
10105
10106 gg = g;
10107
10108 e.abfd = output_bfd;
10109 e.symndx = -1;
10110 e.d.h = hmips;
10111 e.tls_type = 0;
10112
10113 for (g = g->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
10114 {
10115 if (g->got_entries
10116 && (p = (struct mips_got_entry *) htab_find (g->got_entries,
10117 &e)))
10118 {
10119 offset = p->gotidx;
10120 if (info->shared
10121 || (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
10122 && p->d.h != NULL
10123 && p->d.h->root.def_dynamic
10124 && !p->d.h->root.def_regular))
10125 {
10126 /* Create an R_MIPS_REL32 relocation for this entry. Due to
10127 the various compatibility problems, it's easier to mock
10128 up an R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_64 relocation and leave
10129 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation to calculate the
10130 appropriate addend. */
10131 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
10132
10133 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
10134 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
10135 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_64);
10136 else
10137 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_32);
10138 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
10139
10140 entry = 0;
10141 if (! (mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
10142 (output_bfd, info, rel,
10143 e.d.h, NULL, sym->st_value, &entry, sgot)))
10144 return FALSE;
10145 }
10146 else
10147 entry = sym->st_value;
10148 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, entry, sgot->contents + offset);
10149 }
10150 }
10151 }
10152
10153 /* Mark _DYNAMIC and _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ as absolute. */
10154 name = h->root.root.string;
10155 if (h == elf_hash_table (info)->hdynamic
10156 || h == elf_hash_table (info)->hgot)
10157 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
10158 else if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINK") == 0
10159 || strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
10160 {
10161 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
10162 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
10163 sym->st_value = 1;
10164 }
10165 else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
10166 {
10167 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
10168 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
10169 sym->st_value = elf_gp (output_bfd);
10170 }
10171 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
10172 {
10173 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
10174 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
10175 {
10176 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
10177 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
10178 sym->st_value = 0;
10179 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
10180 }
10181 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
10182 {
10183 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
10184 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
10185 sym->st_value = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count;
10186 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
10187 }
10188 else if (sym->st_shndx != SHN_UNDEF && sym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
10189 {
10190 if (h->type == STT_FUNC)
10191 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
10192 else if (h->type == STT_OBJECT)
10193 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
10194 }
10195 }
10196
10197 /* Emit a copy reloc, if needed. */
10198 if (h->needs_copy)
10199 {
10200 asection *s;
10201 bfd_vma symval;
10202
10203 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
10204 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
10205
10206 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
10207 symval = (h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
10208 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
10209 + h->root.u.def.value);
10210 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation (output_bfd, s, s->reloc_count++,
10211 h->dynindx, R_MIPS_COPY, symval);
10212 }
10213
10214 /* Handle the IRIX6-specific symbols. */
10215 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix6)
10216 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (output_bfd, name, sym);
10217
10218 /* Keep dynamic MIPS16 symbols odd. This allows the dynamic linker to
10219 treat MIPS16 symbols like any other. */
10220 if (ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (sym->st_other))
10221 {
10222 BFD_ASSERT (sym->st_value & 1);
10223 sym->st_other -= STO_MIPS16;
10224 }
10225
10226 return TRUE;
10227 }
10228
10229 /* Likewise, for VxWorks. */
10230
10231 bfd_boolean
10232 _bfd_mips_vxworks_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
10233 struct bfd_link_info *info,
10234 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
10235 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
10236 {
10237 bfd *dynobj;
10238 asection *sgot;
10239 struct mips_got_info *g;
10240 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10241 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
10242
10243 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
10244 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
10245 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
10246 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
10247
10248 if (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
10249 {
10250 bfd_byte *loc;
10251 bfd_vma plt_address, plt_index, got_address, got_offset, branch_offset;
10252 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
10253 static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
10254
10255 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
10256 BFD_ASSERT (htab->splt != NULL);
10257 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset <= htab->splt->size);
10258
10259 /* Calculate the address of the .plt entry. */
10260 plt_address = (htab->splt->output_section->vma
10261 + htab->splt->output_offset
10262 + h->plt.offset);
10263
10264 /* Calculate the index of the entry. */
10265 plt_index = ((h->plt.offset - htab->plt_header_size)
10266 / htab->plt_entry_size);
10267
10268 /* Calculate the address of the .got.plt entry. */
10269 got_address = (htab->sgotplt->output_section->vma
10270 + htab->sgotplt->output_offset
10271 + plt_index * 4);
10272
10273 /* Calculate the offset of the .got.plt entry from
10274 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
10275 got_offset = mips_elf_gotplt_index (info, h);
10276
10277 /* Calculate the offset for the branch at the start of the PLT
10278 entry. The branch jumps to the beginning of .plt. */
10279 branch_offset = -(h->plt.offset / 4 + 1) & 0xffff;
10280
10281 /* Fill in the initial value of the .got.plt entry. */
10282 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_address,
10283 htab->sgotplt->contents + plt_index * 4);
10284
10285 /* Find out where the .plt entry should go. */
10286 loc = htab->splt->contents + h->plt.offset;
10287
10288 if (info->shared)
10289 {
10290 plt_entry = mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry;
10291 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | branch_offset, loc);
10292 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | plt_index, loc + 4);
10293 }
10294 else
10295 {
10296 bfd_vma got_address_high, got_address_low;
10297
10298 plt_entry = mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry;
10299 got_address_high = ((got_address + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
10300 got_address_low = got_address & 0xffff;
10301
10302 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | branch_offset, loc);
10303 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | plt_index, loc + 4);
10304 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2] | got_address_high, loc + 8);
10305 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3] | got_address_low, loc + 12);
10306 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
10307 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
10308 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], loc + 24);
10309 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], loc + 28);
10310
10311 loc = (htab->srelplt2->contents
10312 + (plt_index * 3 + 2) * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
10313
10314 /* Emit a relocation for the .got.plt entry. */
10315 rel.r_offset = got_address;
10316 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hplt->indx, R_MIPS_32);
10317 rel.r_addend = h->plt.offset;
10318 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10319
10320 /* Emit a relocation for the lui of %hi(<.got.plt slot>). */
10321 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10322 rel.r_offset = plt_address + 8;
10323 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
10324 rel.r_addend = got_offset;
10325 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10326
10327 /* Emit a relocation for the addiu of %lo(<.got.plt slot>). */
10328 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10329 rel.r_offset += 4;
10330 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
10331 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10332 }
10333
10334 /* Emit an R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT relocation against the .got.plt entry. */
10335 loc = htab->srelplt->contents + plt_index * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10336 rel.r_offset = got_address;
10337 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT);
10338 rel.r_addend = 0;
10339 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10340
10341 if (!h->def_regular)
10342 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
10343 }
10344
10345 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1 || h->forced_local);
10346
10347 sgot = htab->sgot;
10348 g = htab->got_info;
10349 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
10350
10351 /* See if this symbol has an entry in the GOT. */
10352 if (hmips->global_got_area != GGA_NONE)
10353 {
10354 bfd_vma offset;
10355 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
10356 bfd_byte *loc;
10357 asection *s;
10358
10359 /* Install the symbol value in the GOT. */
10360 offset = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, output_bfd, h,
10361 R_MIPS_GOT16, info);
10362 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, sym->st_value, sgot->contents + offset);
10363
10364 /* Add a dynamic relocation for it. */
10365 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
10366 loc = s->contents + (s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
10367 outrel.r_offset = (sgot->output_section->vma
10368 + sgot->output_offset
10369 + offset);
10370 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_32);
10371 outrel.r_addend = 0;
10372 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (dynobj, &outrel, loc);
10373 }
10374
10375 /* Emit a copy reloc, if needed. */
10376 if (h->needs_copy)
10377 {
10378 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
10379
10380 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
10381
10382 rel.r_offset = (h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
10383 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
10384 + h->root.u.def.value);
10385 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_COPY);
10386 rel.r_addend = 0;
10387 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel,
10388 htab->srelbss->contents
10389 + (htab->srelbss->reloc_count
10390 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)));
10391 ++htab->srelbss->reloc_count;
10392 }
10393
10394 /* If this is a mips16/microMIPS symbol, force the value to be even. */
10395 if (ELF_ST_IS_COMPRESSED (sym->st_other))
10396 sym->st_value &= ~1;
10397
10398 return TRUE;
10399 }
10400
10401 /* Write out a plt0 entry to the beginning of .plt. */
10402
10403 static void
10404 mips_finish_exec_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
10405 {
10406 bfd_byte *loc;
10407 bfd_vma gotplt_value, gotplt_value_high, gotplt_value_low;
10408 static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
10409 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10410
10411 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
10412 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
10413
10414 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
10415 plt_entry = mips_n64_exec_plt0_entry;
10416 else if (ABI_N32_P (output_bfd))
10417 plt_entry = mips_n32_exec_plt0_entry;
10418 else
10419 plt_entry = mips_o32_exec_plt0_entry;
10420
10421 /* Calculate the value of .got.plt. */
10422 gotplt_value = (htab->sgotplt->output_section->vma
10423 + htab->sgotplt->output_offset);
10424 gotplt_value_high = ((gotplt_value + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
10425 gotplt_value_low = gotplt_value & 0xffff;
10426
10427 /* The PLT sequence is not safe for N64 if .got.plt's address can
10428 not be loaded in two instructions. */
10429 BFD_ASSERT ((gotplt_value & ~(bfd_vma) 0x7fffffff) == 0
10430 || ~(gotplt_value | 0x7fffffff) == 0);
10431
10432 /* Install the PLT header. */
10433 loc = htab->splt->contents;
10434 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | gotplt_value_high, loc);
10435 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | gotplt_value_low, loc + 4);
10436 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2] | gotplt_value_low, loc + 8);
10437 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 12);
10438 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
10439 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
10440 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], loc + 24);
10441 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], loc + 28);
10442 }
10443
10444 /* Install the PLT header for a VxWorks executable and finalize the
10445 contents of .rela.plt.unloaded. */
10446
10447 static void
10448 mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
10449 {
10450 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
10451 bfd_byte *loc;
10452 bfd_vma got_value, got_value_high, got_value_low, plt_address;
10453 static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
10454 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10455
10456 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
10457 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
10458
10459 plt_entry = mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry;
10460
10461 /* Calculate the value of _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
10462 got_value = (htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
10463 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_offset
10464 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.value);
10465
10466 got_value_high = ((got_value + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
10467 got_value_low = got_value & 0xffff;
10468
10469 /* Calculate the address of the PLT header. */
10470 plt_address = htab->splt->output_section->vma + htab->splt->output_offset;
10471
10472 /* Install the PLT header. */
10473 loc = htab->splt->contents;
10474 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | got_value_high, loc);
10475 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | got_value_low, loc + 4);
10476 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], loc + 8);
10477 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 12);
10478 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
10479 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
10480
10481 /* Output the relocation for the lui of %hi(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_). */
10482 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
10483 rela.r_offset = plt_address;
10484 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
10485 rela.r_addend = 0;
10486 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10487 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10488
10489 /* Output the relocation for the following addiu of
10490 %lo(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_). */
10491 rela.r_offset += 4;
10492 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
10493 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10494 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10495
10496 /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong
10497 symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
10498 in which symbols were output. */
10499 while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
10500 {
10501 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
10502
10503 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10504 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hplt->indx, R_MIPS_32);
10505 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10506 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10507
10508 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10509 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
10510 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10511 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10512
10513 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10514 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
10515 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10516 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10517 }
10518 }
10519
10520 /* Install the PLT header for a VxWorks shared library. */
10521
10522 static void
10523 mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
10524 {
10525 unsigned int i;
10526 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10527
10528 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
10529 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
10530
10531 /* We just need to copy the entry byte-by-byte. */
10532 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry); i++)
10533 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry[i],
10534 htab->splt->contents + i * 4);
10535 }
10536
10537 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
10538
10539 bfd_boolean
10540 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
10541 struct bfd_link_info *info)
10542 {
10543 bfd *dynobj;
10544 asection *sdyn;
10545 asection *sgot;
10546 struct mips_got_info *gg, *g;
10547 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10548
10549 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
10550 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
10551
10552 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
10553
10554 sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
10555
10556 sgot = htab->sgot;
10557 gg = htab->got_info;
10558
10559 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
10560 {
10561 bfd_byte *b;
10562 int dyn_to_skip = 0, dyn_skipped = 0;
10563
10564 BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
10565 BFD_ASSERT (gg != NULL);
10566
10567 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, output_bfd);
10568 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
10569
10570 for (b = sdyn->contents;
10571 b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
10572 b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
10573 {
10574 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
10575 const char *name;
10576 size_t elemsize;
10577 asection *s;
10578 bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
10579
10580 /* Read in the current dynamic entry. */
10581 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
10582
10583 /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out. */
10584 swap_out_p = TRUE;
10585
10586 switch (dyn.d_tag)
10587 {
10588 case DT_RELENT:
10589 dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (dynobj);
10590 break;
10591
10592 case DT_RELAENT:
10593 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
10594 dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (dynobj);
10595 break;
10596
10597 case DT_STRSZ:
10598 /* Rewrite DT_STRSZ. */
10599 dyn.d_un.d_val =
10600 _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr);
10601 break;
10602
10603 case DT_PLTGOT:
10604 s = htab->sgot;
10605 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
10606 break;
10607
10608 case DT_MIPS_PLTGOT:
10609 s = htab->sgotplt;
10610 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
10611 break;
10612
10613 case DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION:
10614 dyn.d_un.d_val = 1; /* XXX */
10615 break;
10616
10617 case DT_MIPS_FLAGS:
10618 dyn.d_un.d_val = RHF_NOTPOT; /* XXX */
10619 break;
10620
10621 case DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP:
10622 {
10623 time_t t;
10624 time (&t);
10625 dyn.d_un.d_val = t;
10626 }
10627 break;
10628
10629 case DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM:
10630 /* XXX FIXME: */
10631 swap_out_p = FALSE;
10632 break;
10633
10634 case DT_MIPS_IVERSION:
10635 /* XXX FIXME: */
10636 swap_out_p = FALSE;
10637 break;
10638
10639 case DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS:
10640 s = output_bfd->sections;
10641 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
10642 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
10643 break;
10644
10645 case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO:
10646 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno;
10647 break;
10648
10649 case DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO:
10650 /* The index into the dynamic symbol table which is the
10651 entry of the first external symbol that is not
10652 referenced within the same object. */
10653 dyn.d_un.d_val = bfd_count_sections (output_bfd) + 1;
10654 break;
10655
10656 case DT_MIPS_GOTSYM:
10657 if (gg->global_gotsym)
10658 {
10659 dyn.d_un.d_val = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
10660 break;
10661 }
10662 /* In case if we don't have global got symbols we default
10663 to setting DT_MIPS_GOTSYM to the same value as
10664 DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, so we just fall through. */
10665
10666 case DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO:
10667 name = ".dynsym";
10668 elemsize = MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE (output_bfd);
10669 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name);
10670 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
10671
10672 dyn.d_un.d_val = s->size / elemsize;
10673 break;
10674
10675 case DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO:
10676 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno - htab->reserved_gotno;
10677 break;
10678
10679 case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP:
10680 {
10681 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
10682 h = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_symbol;
10683 if (!h)
10684 {
10685 dyn_to_skip = MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj);
10686 swap_out_p = FALSE;
10687 break;
10688 }
10689 s = h->root.u.def.section;
10690 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = (s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset
10691 + h->root.u.def.value);
10692 }
10693 break;
10694
10695 case DT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
10696 s = (bfd_get_section_by_name
10697 (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)));
10698 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
10699 break;
10700
10701 case DT_RELASZ:
10702 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
10703 /* The count does not include the JUMP_SLOT relocations. */
10704 if (htab->srelplt)
10705 dyn.d_un.d_val -= htab->srelplt->size;
10706 break;
10707
10708 case DT_PLTREL:
10709 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
10710 if (htab->is_vxworks)
10711 dyn.d_un.d_val = DT_RELA;
10712 else
10713 dyn.d_un.d_val = DT_REL;
10714 break;
10715
10716 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
10717 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
10718 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->srelplt->size;
10719 break;
10720
10721 case DT_JMPREL:
10722 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
10723 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = (htab->srelplt->output_section->vma
10724 + htab->srelplt->output_offset);
10725 break;
10726
10727 case DT_TEXTREL:
10728 /* If we didn't need any text relocations after all, delete
10729 the dynamic tag. */
10730 if (!(info->flags & DF_TEXTREL))
10731 {
10732 dyn_to_skip = MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj);
10733 swap_out_p = FALSE;
10734 }
10735 break;
10736
10737 case DT_FLAGS:
10738 /* If we didn't need any text relocations after all, clear
10739 DF_TEXTREL from DT_FLAGS. */
10740 if (!(info->flags & DF_TEXTREL))
10741 dyn.d_un.d_val &= ~DF_TEXTREL;
10742 else
10743 swap_out_p = FALSE;
10744 break;
10745
10746 default:
10747 swap_out_p = FALSE;
10748 if (htab->is_vxworks
10749 && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
10750 swap_out_p = TRUE;
10751 break;
10752 }
10753
10754 if (swap_out_p || dyn_skipped)
10755 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
10756 (dynobj, &dyn, b - dyn_skipped);
10757
10758 if (dyn_to_skip)
10759 {
10760 dyn_skipped += dyn_to_skip;
10761 dyn_to_skip = 0;
10762 }
10763 }
10764
10765 /* Wipe out any trailing entries if we shifted down a dynamic tag. */
10766 if (dyn_skipped > 0)
10767 memset (b - dyn_skipped, 0, dyn_skipped);
10768 }
10769
10770 if (sgot != NULL && sgot->size > 0
10771 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sgot->output_section))
10772 {
10773 if (htab->is_vxworks)
10774 {
10775 /* The first entry of the global offset table points to the
10776 ".dynamic" section. The second is initialized by the
10777 loader and contains the shared library identifier.
10778 The third is also initialized by the loader and points
10779 to the lazy resolution stub. */
10780 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd,
10781 sdyn->output_offset + sdyn->output_section->vma,
10782 sgot->contents);
10783 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0,
10784 sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
10785 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0,
10786 sgot->contents
10787 + 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
10788 }
10789 else
10790 {
10791 /* The first entry of the global offset table will be filled at
10792 runtime. The second entry will be used by some runtime loaders.
10793 This isn't the case of IRIX rld. */
10794 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) 0, sgot->contents);
10795 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_GNU_GOT1_MASK (output_bfd),
10796 sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
10797 }
10798
10799 elf_section_data (sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
10800 = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
10801 }
10802
10803 /* Generate dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots. */
10804 if (gg != NULL && gg->next)
10805 {
10806 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
10807 bfd_vma addend = 0;
10808
10809 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
10810 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_REL32);
10811
10812 for (g = gg->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
10813 {
10814 bfd_vma got_index = g->next->local_gotno + g->next->global_gotno
10815 + g->next->tls_gotno;
10816
10817 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents
10818 + got_index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
10819 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_GNU_GOT1_MASK (output_bfd),
10820 sgot->contents
10821 + got_index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
10822
10823 if (! info->shared)
10824 continue;
10825
10826 while (got_index < g->assigned_gotno)
10827 {
10828 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset
10829 = got_index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
10830 if (!(mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
10831 (output_bfd, info, rel, NULL,
10832 bfd_abs_section_ptr,
10833 0, &addend, sgot)))
10834 return FALSE;
10835 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
10836 }
10837 }
10838 }
10839
10840 /* The generation of dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots
10841 adds more dynamic relocations. We cannot count them until
10842 here. */
10843
10844 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
10845 {
10846 bfd_byte *b;
10847 bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
10848
10849 BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
10850
10851 for (b = sdyn->contents;
10852 b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
10853 b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
10854 {
10855 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
10856 asection *s;
10857
10858 /* Read in the current dynamic entry. */
10859 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
10860
10861 /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out. */
10862 swap_out_p = TRUE;
10863
10864 switch (dyn.d_tag)
10865 {
10866 case DT_RELSZ:
10867 /* Reduce DT_RELSZ to account for any relocations we
10868 decided not to make. This is for the n64 irix rld,
10869 which doesn't seem to apply any relocations if there
10870 are trailing null entries. */
10871 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
10872 dyn.d_un.d_val = (s->reloc_count
10873 * (ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
10874 ? sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)
10875 : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
10876 /* Adjust the section size too. Tools like the prelinker
10877 can reasonably expect the values to the same. */
10878 elf_section_data (s->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_size
10879 = dyn.d_un.d_val;
10880 break;
10881
10882 default:
10883 swap_out_p = FALSE;
10884 break;
10885 }
10886
10887 if (swap_out_p)
10888 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
10889 (dynobj, &dyn, b);
10890 }
10891 }
10892
10893 {
10894 asection *s;
10895 Elf32_compact_rel cpt;
10896
10897 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
10898 {
10899 /* Write .compact_rel section out. */
10900 s = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
10901 if (s != NULL)
10902 {
10903 cpt.id1 = 1;
10904 cpt.num = s->reloc_count;
10905 cpt.id2 = 2;
10906 cpt.offset = (s->output_section->filepos
10907 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
10908 cpt.reserved0 = 0;
10909 cpt.reserved1 = 0;
10910 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (output_bfd, &cpt,
10911 ((Elf32_External_compact_rel *)
10912 s->contents));
10913
10914 /* Clean up a dummy stub function entry in .text. */
10915 if (htab->sstubs != NULL)
10916 {
10917 file_ptr dummy_offset;
10918
10919 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sstubs->size >= htab->function_stub_size);
10920 dummy_offset = htab->sstubs->size - htab->function_stub_size;
10921 memset (htab->sstubs->contents + dummy_offset, 0,
10922 htab->function_stub_size);
10923 }
10924 }
10925 }
10926
10927 /* The psABI says that the dynamic relocations must be sorted in
10928 increasing order of r_symndx. The VxWorks EABI doesn't require
10929 this, and because the code below handles REL rather than RELA
10930 relocations, using it for VxWorks would be outright harmful. */
10931 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
10932 {
10933 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
10934 if (s != NULL
10935 && s->size > (bfd_vma)2 * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd))
10936 {
10937 reldyn_sorting_bfd = output_bfd;
10938
10939 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
10940 qsort ((Elf64_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1,
10941 s->reloc_count - 1, sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel),
10942 sort_dynamic_relocs_64);
10943 else
10944 qsort ((Elf32_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1,
10945 s->reloc_count - 1, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel),
10946 sort_dynamic_relocs);
10947 }
10948 }
10949 }
10950
10951 if (htab->splt && htab->splt->size > 0)
10952 {
10953 if (htab->is_vxworks)
10954 {
10955 if (info->shared)
10956 mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt (output_bfd, info);
10957 else
10958 mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt (output_bfd, info);
10959 }
10960 else
10961 {
10962 BFD_ASSERT (!info->shared);
10963 mips_finish_exec_plt (output_bfd, info);
10964 }
10965 }
10966 return TRUE;
10967 }
10968
10969
10970 /* Set ABFD's EF_MIPS_ARCH and EF_MIPS_MACH flags. */
10971
10972 static void
10973 mips_set_isa_flags (bfd *abfd)
10974 {
10975 flagword val;
10976
10977 switch (bfd_get_mach (abfd))
10978 {
10979 default:
10980 case bfd_mach_mips3000:
10981 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1;
10982 break;
10983
10984 case bfd_mach_mips3900:
10985 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1 | E_MIPS_MACH_3900;
10986 break;
10987
10988 case bfd_mach_mips6000:
10989 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_2;
10990 break;
10991
10992 case bfd_mach_mips4000:
10993 case bfd_mach_mips4300:
10994 case bfd_mach_mips4400:
10995 case bfd_mach_mips4600:
10996 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3;
10997 break;
10998
10999 case bfd_mach_mips4010:
11000 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4010;
11001 break;
11002
11003 case bfd_mach_mips4100:
11004 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4100;
11005 break;
11006
11007 case bfd_mach_mips4111:
11008 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4111;
11009 break;
11010
11011 case bfd_mach_mips4120:
11012 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4120;
11013 break;
11014
11015 case bfd_mach_mips4650:
11016 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4650;
11017 break;
11018
11019 case bfd_mach_mips5400:
11020 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5400;
11021 break;
11022
11023 case bfd_mach_mips5500:
11024 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5500;
11025 break;
11026
11027 case bfd_mach_mips5900:
11028 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_5900;
11029 break;
11030
11031 case bfd_mach_mips9000:
11032 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_9000;
11033 break;
11034
11035 case bfd_mach_mips5000:
11036 case bfd_mach_mips7000:
11037 case bfd_mach_mips8000:
11038 case bfd_mach_mips10000:
11039 case bfd_mach_mips12000:
11040 case bfd_mach_mips14000:
11041 case bfd_mach_mips16000:
11042 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4;
11043 break;
11044
11045 case bfd_mach_mips5:
11046 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_5;
11047 break;
11048
11049 case bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2e:
11050 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_LS2E;
11051 break;
11052
11053 case bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2f:
11054 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_LS2F;
11055 break;
11056
11057 case bfd_mach_mips_sb1:
11058 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64 | E_MIPS_MACH_SB1;
11059 break;
11060
11061 case bfd_mach_mips_loongson_3a:
11062 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64 | E_MIPS_MACH_LS3A;
11063 break;
11064
11065 case bfd_mach_mips_octeon:
11066 case bfd_mach_mips_octeonp:
11067 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2 | E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON;
11068 break;
11069
11070 case bfd_mach_mips_xlr:
11071 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64 | E_MIPS_MACH_XLR;
11072 break;
11073
11074 case bfd_mach_mips_octeon2:
11075 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2 | E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON2;
11076 break;
11077
11078 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32:
11079 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32;
11080 break;
11081
11082 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64:
11083 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64;
11084 break;
11085
11086 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2:
11087 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2;
11088 break;
11089
11090 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2:
11091 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2;
11092 break;
11093 }
11094 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
11095 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= val;
11096
11097 }
11098
11099
11100 /* The final processing done just before writing out a MIPS ELF object
11101 file. This gets the MIPS architecture right based on the machine
11102 number. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
11103
11104 void
11105 _bfd_mips_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd,
11106 bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11107 {
11108 unsigned int i;
11109 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
11110 const char *name;
11111 asection *sec;
11112
11113 /* Keep the existing EF_MIPS_MACH and EF_MIPS_ARCH flags if the former
11114 is nonzero. This is for compatibility with old objects, which used
11115 a combination of a 32-bit EF_MIPS_ARCH and a 64-bit EF_MIPS_MACH. */
11116 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == 0)
11117 mips_set_isa_flags (abfd);
11118
11119 /* Set the sh_info field for .gptab sections and other appropriate
11120 info for each special section. */
11121 for (i = 1, hdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd) + 1;
11122 i < elf_numsections (abfd);
11123 i++, hdrpp++)
11124 {
11125 switch ((*hdrpp)->sh_type)
11126 {
11127 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
11128 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
11129 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
11130 if (sec != NULL)
11131 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
11132 break;
11133
11134 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
11135 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
11136 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
11137 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
11138 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."));
11139 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1);
11140 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
11141 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
11142 break;
11143
11144 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
11145 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
11146 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
11147 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
11148 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"));
11149 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
11150 name + sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1);
11151 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
11152 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
11153 break;
11154
11155 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
11156 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
11157 if (sec != NULL)
11158 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
11159 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".liblist");
11160 if (sec != NULL)
11161 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
11162 break;
11163
11164 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
11165 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
11166 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
11167 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
11168 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events"))
11169 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
11170 name + sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1);
11171 else
11172 {
11173 BFD_ASSERT (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"));
11174 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
11175 (name
11176 + sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1));
11177 }
11178 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
11179 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
11180 break;
11181
11182 }
11183 }
11184 }
11185 \f
11186 /* When creating an IRIX5 executable, we need REGINFO and RTPROC
11187 segments. */
11188
11189 int
11190 _bfd_mips_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
11191 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11192 {
11193 asection *s;
11194 int ret = 0;
11195
11196 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO segment. */
11197 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
11198 if (s && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD))
11199 ++ret;
11200
11201 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment. */
11202 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6
11203 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
11204 MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)))
11205 ++ret;
11206
11207 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_RTPROC segment. */
11208 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5
11209 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic")
11210 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug"))
11211 ++ret;
11212
11213 /* Allocate a PT_NULL header in dynamic objects. See
11214 _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map for details. */
11215 if (!SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
11216 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic"))
11217 ++ret;
11218
11219 return ret;
11220 }
11221
11222 /* Modify the segment map for an IRIX5 executable. */
11223
11224 bfd_boolean
11225 _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
11226 struct bfd_link_info *info)
11227 {
11228 asection *s;
11229 struct elf_segment_map *m, **pm;
11230 bfd_size_type amt;
11231
11232 /* If there is a .reginfo section, we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO
11233 segment. */
11234 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
11235 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
11236 {
11237 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
11238 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_REGINFO)
11239 break;
11240 if (m == NULL)
11241 {
11242 amt = sizeof *m;
11243 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
11244 if (m == NULL)
11245 return FALSE;
11246
11247 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_REGINFO;
11248 m->count = 1;
11249 m->sections[0] = s;
11250
11251 /* We want to put it after the PHDR and INTERP segments. */
11252 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
11253 while (*pm != NULL
11254 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
11255 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
11256 pm = &(*pm)->next;
11257
11258 m->next = *pm;
11259 *pm = m;
11260 }
11261 }
11262
11263 /* For IRIX 6, we don't have .mdebug sections, nor does anything but
11264 .dynamic end up in PT_DYNAMIC. However, we do have to insert a
11265 PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment immediately following the program header
11266 table. */
11267 if (NEWABI_P (abfd)
11268 /* On non-IRIX6 new abi, we'll have already created a segment
11269 for this section, so don't create another. I'm not sure this
11270 is not also the case for IRIX 6, but I can't test it right
11271 now. */
11272 && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
11273 {
11274 for (s = abfd->sections; s; s = s->next)
11275 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
11276 break;
11277
11278 if (s)
11279 {
11280 struct elf_segment_map *options_segment;
11281
11282 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
11283 while (*pm != NULL
11284 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
11285 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
11286 pm = &(*pm)->next;
11287
11288 if (*pm == NULL || (*pm)->p_type != PT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
11289 {
11290 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
11291 options_segment = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
11292 options_segment->next = *pm;
11293 options_segment->p_type = PT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
11294 options_segment->p_flags = PF_R;
11295 options_segment->p_flags_valid = TRUE;
11296 options_segment->count = 1;
11297 options_segment->sections[0] = s;
11298 *pm = options_segment;
11299 }
11300 }
11301 }
11302 else
11303 {
11304 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
11305 {
11306 /* If there are .dynamic and .mdebug sections, we make a room
11307 for the RTPROC header. FIXME: Rewrite without section names. */
11308 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp") == NULL
11309 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL
11310 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug") != NULL)
11311 {
11312 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
11313 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_RTPROC)
11314 break;
11315 if (m == NULL)
11316 {
11317 amt = sizeof *m;
11318 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
11319 if (m == NULL)
11320 return FALSE;
11321
11322 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_RTPROC;
11323
11324 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
11325 if (s == NULL)
11326 {
11327 m->count = 0;
11328 m->p_flags = 0;
11329 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
11330 }
11331 else
11332 {
11333 m->count = 1;
11334 m->sections[0] = s;
11335 }
11336
11337 /* We want to put it after the DYNAMIC segment. */
11338 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
11339 while (*pm != NULL && (*pm)->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC)
11340 pm = &(*pm)->next;
11341 if (*pm != NULL)
11342 pm = &(*pm)->next;
11343
11344 m->next = *pm;
11345 *pm = m;
11346 }
11347 }
11348 }
11349 /* On IRIX5, the PT_DYNAMIC segment includes the .dynamic,
11350 .dynstr, .dynsym, and .hash sections, and everything in
11351 between. */
11352 for (pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; *pm != NULL;
11353 pm = &(*pm)->next)
11354 if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC)
11355 break;
11356 m = *pm;
11357 if (m != NULL && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
11358 {
11359 /* For a normal mips executable the permissions for the PT_DYNAMIC
11360 segment are read, write and execute. We do that here since
11361 the code in elf.c sets only the read permission. This matters
11362 sometimes for the dynamic linker. */
11363 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
11364 {
11365 m->p_flags = PF_R | PF_W | PF_X;
11366 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
11367 }
11368 }
11369 /* GNU/Linux binaries do not need the extended PT_DYNAMIC section.
11370 glibc's dynamic linker has traditionally derived the number of
11371 tags from the p_filesz field, and sometimes allocates stack
11372 arrays of that size. An overly-big PT_DYNAMIC segment can
11373 be actively harmful in such cases. Making PT_DYNAMIC contain
11374 other sections can also make life hard for the prelinker,
11375 which might move one of the other sections to a different
11376 PT_LOAD segment. */
11377 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
11378 && m != NULL
11379 && m->count == 1
11380 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") == 0)
11381 {
11382 static const char *sec_names[] =
11383 {
11384 ".dynamic", ".dynstr", ".dynsym", ".hash"
11385 };
11386 bfd_vma low, high;
11387 unsigned int i, c;
11388 struct elf_segment_map *n;
11389
11390 low = ~(bfd_vma) 0;
11391 high = 0;
11392 for (i = 0; i < sizeof sec_names / sizeof sec_names[0]; i++)
11393 {
11394 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec_names[i]);
11395 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
11396 {
11397 bfd_size_type sz;
11398
11399 if (low > s->vma)
11400 low = s->vma;
11401 sz = s->size;
11402 if (high < s->vma + sz)
11403 high = s->vma + sz;
11404 }
11405 }
11406
11407 c = 0;
11408 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
11409 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
11410 && s->vma >= low
11411 && s->vma + s->size <= high)
11412 ++c;
11413
11414 amt = sizeof *n + (bfd_size_type) (c - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
11415 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
11416 if (n == NULL)
11417 return FALSE;
11418 *n = *m;
11419 n->count = c;
11420
11421 i = 0;
11422 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
11423 {
11424 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
11425 && s->vma >= low
11426 && s->vma + s->size <= high)
11427 {
11428 n->sections[i] = s;
11429 ++i;
11430 }
11431 }
11432
11433 *pm = n;
11434 }
11435 }
11436
11437 /* Allocate a spare program header in dynamic objects so that tools
11438 like the prelinker can add an extra PT_LOAD entry.
11439
11440 If the prelinker needs to make room for a new PT_LOAD entry, its
11441 standard procedure is to move the first (read-only) sections into
11442 the new (writable) segment. However, the MIPS ABI requires
11443 .dynamic to be in a read-only segment, and the section will often
11444 start within sizeof (ElfNN_Phdr) bytes of the last program header.
11445
11446 Although the prelinker could in principle move .dynamic to a
11447 writable segment, it seems better to allocate a spare program
11448 header instead, and avoid the need to move any sections.
11449 There is a long tradition of allocating spare dynamic tags,
11450 so allocating a spare program header seems like a natural
11451 extension.
11452
11453 If INFO is NULL, we may be copying an already prelinked binary
11454 with objcopy or strip, so do not add this header. */
11455 if (info != NULL
11456 && !SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
11457 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic"))
11458 {
11459 for (pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; *pm != NULL; pm = &(*pm)->next)
11460 if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_NULL)
11461 break;
11462 if (*pm == NULL)
11463 {
11464 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*m));
11465 if (m == NULL)
11466 return FALSE;
11467
11468 m->p_type = PT_NULL;
11469 *pm = m;
11470 }
11471 }
11472
11473 return TRUE;
11474 }
11475 \f
11476 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
11477 relocation. */
11478
11479 asection *
11480 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
11481 struct bfd_link_info *info,
11482 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
11483 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
11484 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
11485 {
11486 /* ??? Do mips16 stub sections need to be handled special? */
11487
11488 if (h != NULL)
11489 switch (ELF_R_TYPE (sec->owner, rel->r_info))
11490 {
11491 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
11492 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
11493 return NULL;
11494 }
11495
11496 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
11497 }
11498
11499 /* Update the got entry reference counts for the section being removed. */
11500
11501 bfd_boolean
11502 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_sweep_hook (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11503 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11504 asection *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11505 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11506 {
11507 #if 0
11508 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
11509 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
11510 bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts;
11511 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, *relend;
11512 unsigned long r_symndx;
11513 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
11514
11515 if (info->relocatable)
11516 return TRUE;
11517
11518 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
11519 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
11520 local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
11521
11522 relend = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
11523 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; rel++)
11524 switch (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info))
11525 {
11526 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
11527 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
11528 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
11529 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
11530 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
11531 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
11532 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
11533 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
11534 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
11535 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
11536 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
11537 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
11538 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
11539 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
11540 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
11541 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
11542 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
11543 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP:
11544 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE:
11545 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_OFST:
11546 /* ??? It would seem that the existing MIPS code does no sort
11547 of reference counting or whatnot on its GOT and PLT entries,
11548 so it is not possible to garbage collect them at this time. */
11549 break;
11550
11551 default:
11552 break;
11553 }
11554 #endif
11555
11556 return TRUE;
11557 }
11558 \f
11559 /* Copy data from a MIPS ELF indirect symbol to its direct symbol,
11560 hiding the old indirect symbol. Process additional relocation
11561 information. Also called for weakdefs, in which case we just let
11562 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect copy the flags for us. */
11563
11564 void
11565 _bfd_mips_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
11566 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
11567 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
11568 {
11569 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *dirmips, *indmips;
11570
11571 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect (info, dir, ind);
11572
11573 dirmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
11574 indmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
11575 /* Any absolute non-dynamic relocations against an indirect or weak
11576 definition will be against the target symbol. */
11577 if (indmips->has_static_relocs)
11578 dirmips->has_static_relocs = TRUE;
11579
11580 if (ind->root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
11581 return;
11582
11583 dirmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs += indmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
11584 if (indmips->readonly_reloc)
11585 dirmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
11586 if (indmips->no_fn_stub)
11587 dirmips->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
11588 if (indmips->fn_stub)
11589 {
11590 dirmips->fn_stub = indmips->fn_stub;
11591 indmips->fn_stub = NULL;
11592 }
11593 if (indmips->need_fn_stub)
11594 {
11595 dirmips->need_fn_stub = TRUE;
11596 indmips->need_fn_stub = FALSE;
11597 }
11598 if (indmips->call_stub)
11599 {
11600 dirmips->call_stub = indmips->call_stub;
11601 indmips->call_stub = NULL;
11602 }
11603 if (indmips->call_fp_stub)
11604 {
11605 dirmips->call_fp_stub = indmips->call_fp_stub;
11606 indmips->call_fp_stub = NULL;
11607 }
11608 if (indmips->global_got_area < dirmips->global_got_area)
11609 dirmips->global_got_area = indmips->global_got_area;
11610 if (indmips->global_got_area < GGA_NONE)
11611 indmips->global_got_area = GGA_NONE;
11612 if (indmips->has_nonpic_branches)
11613 dirmips->has_nonpic_branches = TRUE;
11614
11615 if (dirmips->tls_type == 0)
11616 dirmips->tls_type = indmips->tls_type;
11617 }
11618 \f
11619 #define PDR_SIZE 32
11620
11621 bfd_boolean
11622 _bfd_mips_elf_discard_info (bfd *abfd, struct elf_reloc_cookie *cookie,
11623 struct bfd_link_info *info)
11624 {
11625 asection *o;
11626 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
11627 unsigned char *tdata;
11628 size_t i, skip;
11629
11630 o = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".pdr");
11631 if (! o)
11632 return FALSE;
11633 if (o->size == 0)
11634 return FALSE;
11635 if (o->size % PDR_SIZE != 0)
11636 return FALSE;
11637 if (o->output_section != NULL
11638 && bfd_is_abs_section (o->output_section))
11639 return FALSE;
11640
11641 tdata = bfd_zmalloc (o->size / PDR_SIZE);
11642 if (! tdata)
11643 return FALSE;
11644
11645 cookie->rels = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
11646 info->keep_memory);
11647 if (!cookie->rels)
11648 {
11649 free (tdata);
11650 return FALSE;
11651 }
11652
11653 cookie->rel = cookie->rels;
11654 cookie->relend = cookie->rels + o->reloc_count;
11655
11656 for (i = 0, skip = 0; i < o->size / PDR_SIZE; i ++)
11657 {
11658 if (bfd_elf_reloc_symbol_deleted_p (i * PDR_SIZE, cookie))
11659 {
11660 tdata[i] = 1;
11661 skip ++;
11662 }
11663 }
11664
11665 if (skip != 0)
11666 {
11667 mips_elf_section_data (o)->u.tdata = tdata;
11668 o->size -= skip * PDR_SIZE;
11669 ret = TRUE;
11670 }
11671 else
11672 free (tdata);
11673
11674 if (! info->keep_memory)
11675 free (cookie->rels);
11676
11677 return ret;
11678 }
11679
11680 bfd_boolean
11681 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_discarded_relocs (asection *sec)
11682 {
11683 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") == 0)
11684 return TRUE;
11685 return FALSE;
11686 }
11687
11688 bfd_boolean
11689 _bfd_mips_elf_write_section (bfd *output_bfd,
11690 struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11691 asection *sec, bfd_byte *contents)
11692 {
11693 bfd_byte *to, *from, *end;
11694 int i;
11695
11696 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") != 0)
11697 return FALSE;
11698
11699 if (mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata == NULL)
11700 return FALSE;
11701
11702 to = contents;
11703 end = contents + sec->size;
11704 for (from = contents, i = 0;
11705 from < end;
11706 from += PDR_SIZE, i++)
11707 {
11708 if ((mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata)[i] == 1)
11709 continue;
11710 if (to != from)
11711 memcpy (to, from, PDR_SIZE);
11712 to += PDR_SIZE;
11713 }
11714 bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, sec->output_section, contents,
11715 sec->output_offset, sec->size);
11716 return TRUE;
11717 }
11718 \f
11719 /* microMIPS code retains local labels for linker relaxation. Omit them
11720 from output by default for clarity. */
11721
11722 bfd_boolean
11723 _bfd_mips_elf_is_target_special_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
11724 {
11725 return _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (abfd, sym->name);
11726 }
11727
11728 /* MIPS ELF uses a special find_nearest_line routine in order the
11729 handle the ECOFF debugging information. */
11730
11731 struct mips_elf_find_line
11732 {
11733 struct ecoff_debug_info d;
11734 struct ecoff_find_line i;
11735 };
11736
11737 bfd_boolean
11738 _bfd_mips_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
11739 asymbol **symbols, bfd_vma offset,
11740 const char **filename_ptr,
11741 const char **functionname_ptr,
11742 unsigned int *line_ptr)
11743 {
11744 asection *msec;
11745
11746 if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
11747 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
11748 line_ptr))
11749 return TRUE;
11750
11751 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, dwarf_debug_sections,
11752 section, symbols, offset,
11753 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
11754 line_ptr, NULL, ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 8 : 0,
11755 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
11756 return TRUE;
11757
11758 msec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug");
11759 if (msec != NULL)
11760 {
11761 flagword origflags;
11762 struct mips_elf_find_line *fi;
11763 const struct ecoff_debug_swap * const swap =
11764 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
11765
11766 /* If we are called during a link, mips_elf_final_link may have
11767 cleared the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS field. We force it back on here
11768 if appropriate (which it normally will be). */
11769 origflags = msec->flags;
11770 if (elf_section_data (msec)->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
11771 msec->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
11772
11773 fi = elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info;
11774 if (fi == NULL)
11775 {
11776 bfd_size_type external_fdr_size;
11777 char *fraw_src;
11778 char *fraw_end;
11779 struct fdr *fdr_ptr;
11780 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_find_line);
11781
11782 fi = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
11783 if (fi == NULL)
11784 {
11785 msec->flags = origflags;
11786 return FALSE;
11787 }
11788
11789 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (abfd, msec, &fi->d))
11790 {
11791 msec->flags = origflags;
11792 return FALSE;
11793 }
11794
11795 /* Swap in the FDR information. */
11796 amt = fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * sizeof (struct fdr);
11797 fi->d.fdr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
11798 if (fi->d.fdr == NULL)
11799 {
11800 msec->flags = origflags;
11801 return FALSE;
11802 }
11803 external_fdr_size = swap->external_fdr_size;
11804 fdr_ptr = fi->d.fdr;
11805 fraw_src = (char *) fi->d.external_fdr;
11806 fraw_end = (fraw_src
11807 + fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * external_fdr_size);
11808 for (; fraw_src < fraw_end; fraw_src += external_fdr_size, fdr_ptr++)
11809 (*swap->swap_fdr_in) (abfd, fraw_src, fdr_ptr);
11810
11811 elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info = fi;
11812
11813 /* Note that we don't bother to ever free this information.
11814 find_nearest_line is either called all the time, as in
11815 objdump -l, so the information should be saved, or it is
11816 rarely called, as in ld error messages, so the memory
11817 wasted is unimportant. Still, it would probably be a
11818 good idea for free_cached_info to throw it away. */
11819 }
11820
11821 if (_bfd_ecoff_locate_line (abfd, section, offset, &fi->d, swap,
11822 &fi->i, filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
11823 line_ptr))
11824 {
11825 msec->flags = origflags;
11826 return TRUE;
11827 }
11828
11829 msec->flags = origflags;
11830 }
11831
11832 /* Fall back on the generic ELF find_nearest_line routine. */
11833
11834 return _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
11835 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
11836 line_ptr);
11837 }
11838
11839 bfd_boolean
11840 _bfd_mips_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
11841 const char **filename_ptr,
11842 const char **functionname_ptr,
11843 unsigned int *line_ptr)
11844 {
11845 bfd_boolean found;
11846 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
11847 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
11848 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
11849 return found;
11850 }
11851
11852 \f
11853 /* When are writing out the .options or .MIPS.options section,
11854 remember the bytes we are writing out, so that we can install the
11855 GP value in the section_processing routine. */
11856
11857 bfd_boolean
11858 _bfd_mips_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd, sec_ptr section,
11859 const void *location,
11860 file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type count)
11861 {
11862 if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (section->name))
11863 {
11864 bfd_byte *c;
11865
11866 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
11867 {
11868 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct bfd_elf_section_data);
11869 section->used_by_bfd = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
11870 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
11871 return FALSE;
11872 }
11873 c = mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata;
11874 if (c == NULL)
11875 {
11876 c = bfd_zalloc (abfd, section->size);
11877 if (c == NULL)
11878 return FALSE;
11879 mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata = c;
11880 }
11881
11882 memcpy (c + offset, location, count);
11883 }
11884
11885 return _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (abfd, section, location, offset,
11886 count);
11887 }
11888
11889 /* This is almost identical to bfd_generic_get_... except that some
11890 MIPS relocations need to be handled specially. Sigh. */
11891
11892 bfd_byte *
11893 _bfd_elf_mips_get_relocated_section_contents
11894 (bfd *abfd,
11895 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
11896 struct bfd_link_order *link_order,
11897 bfd_byte *data,
11898 bfd_boolean relocatable,
11899 asymbol **symbols)
11900 {
11901 /* Get enough memory to hold the stuff */
11902 bfd *input_bfd = link_order->u.indirect.section->owner;
11903 asection *input_section = link_order->u.indirect.section;
11904 bfd_size_type sz;
11905
11906 long reloc_size = bfd_get_reloc_upper_bound (input_bfd, input_section);
11907 arelent **reloc_vector = NULL;
11908 long reloc_count;
11909
11910 if (reloc_size < 0)
11911 goto error_return;
11912
11913 reloc_vector = bfd_malloc (reloc_size);
11914 if (reloc_vector == NULL && reloc_size != 0)
11915 goto error_return;
11916
11917 /* read in the section */
11918 sz = input_section->rawsize ? input_section->rawsize : input_section->size;
11919 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section, data, 0, sz))
11920 goto error_return;
11921
11922 reloc_count = bfd_canonicalize_reloc (input_bfd,
11923 input_section,
11924 reloc_vector,
11925 symbols);
11926 if (reloc_count < 0)
11927 goto error_return;
11928
11929 if (reloc_count > 0)
11930 {
11931 arelent **parent;
11932 /* for mips */
11933 int gp_found;
11934 bfd_vma gp = 0x12345678; /* initialize just to shut gcc up */
11935
11936 {
11937 struct bfd_hash_entry *h;
11938 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *lh;
11939 /* Skip all this stuff if we aren't mixing formats. */
11940 if (abfd && input_bfd
11941 && abfd->xvec == input_bfd->xvec)
11942 lh = 0;
11943 else
11944 {
11945 h = bfd_hash_lookup (&link_info->hash->table, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE);
11946 lh = (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *) h;
11947 }
11948 lookup:
11949 if (lh)
11950 {
11951 switch (lh->type)
11952 {
11953 case bfd_link_hash_undefined:
11954 case bfd_link_hash_undefweak:
11955 case bfd_link_hash_common:
11956 gp_found = 0;
11957 break;
11958 case bfd_link_hash_defined:
11959 case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
11960 gp_found = 1;
11961 gp = lh->u.def.value;
11962 break;
11963 case bfd_link_hash_indirect:
11964 case bfd_link_hash_warning:
11965 lh = lh->u.i.link;
11966 /* @@FIXME ignoring warning for now */
11967 goto lookup;
11968 case bfd_link_hash_new:
11969 default:
11970 abort ();
11971 }
11972 }
11973 else
11974 gp_found = 0;
11975 }
11976 /* end mips */
11977 for (parent = reloc_vector; *parent != NULL; parent++)
11978 {
11979 char *error_message = NULL;
11980 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
11981
11982 /* Specific to MIPS: Deal with relocation types that require
11983 knowing the gp of the output bfd. */
11984 asymbol *sym = *(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr;
11985
11986 /* If we've managed to find the gp and have a special
11987 function for the relocation then go ahead, else default
11988 to the generic handling. */
11989 if (gp_found
11990 && (*parent)->howto->special_function
11991 == _bfd_mips_elf32_gprel16_reloc)
11992 r = _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (input_bfd, sym, *parent,
11993 input_section, relocatable,
11994 data, gp);
11995 else
11996 r = bfd_perform_relocation (input_bfd, *parent, data,
11997 input_section,
11998 relocatable ? abfd : NULL,
11999 &error_message);
12000
12001 if (relocatable)
12002 {
12003 asection *os = input_section->output_section;
12004
12005 /* A partial link, so keep the relocs */
12006 os->orelocation[os->reloc_count] = *parent;
12007 os->reloc_count++;
12008 }
12009
12010 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
12011 {
12012 switch (r)
12013 {
12014 case bfd_reloc_undefined:
12015 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
12016 (link_info, bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
12017 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address, TRUE)))
12018 goto error_return;
12019 break;
12020 case bfd_reloc_dangerous:
12021 BFD_ASSERT (error_message != NULL);
12022 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
12023 (link_info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
12024 (*parent)->address)))
12025 goto error_return;
12026 break;
12027 case bfd_reloc_overflow:
12028 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
12029 (link_info, NULL,
12030 bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
12031 (*parent)->howto->name, (*parent)->addend,
12032 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address)))
12033 goto error_return;
12034 break;
12035 case bfd_reloc_outofrange:
12036 default:
12037 abort ();
12038 break;
12039 }
12040
12041 }
12042 }
12043 }
12044 if (reloc_vector != NULL)
12045 free (reloc_vector);
12046 return data;
12047
12048 error_return:
12049 if (reloc_vector != NULL)
12050 free (reloc_vector);
12051 return NULL;
12052 }
12053 \f
12054 static bfd_boolean
12055 mips_elf_relax_delete_bytes (bfd *abfd,
12056 asection *sec, bfd_vma addr, int count)
12057 {
12058 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
12059 unsigned int sec_shndx;
12060 bfd_byte *contents;
12061 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend;
12062 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
12063 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
12064 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
12065 struct elf_link_hash_entry **end_hashes;
12066 struct elf_link_hash_entry **start_hashes;
12067 unsigned int symcount;
12068
12069 sec_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
12070 contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
12071
12072 irel = elf_section_data (sec)->relocs;
12073 irelend = irel + sec->reloc_count;
12074
12075 /* Actually delete the bytes. */
12076 memmove (contents + addr, contents + addr + count,
12077 (size_t) (sec->size - addr - count));
12078 sec->size -= count;
12079
12080 /* Adjust all the relocs. */
12081 for (irel = elf_section_data (sec)->relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
12082 {
12083 /* Get the new reloc address. */
12084 if (irel->r_offset > addr)
12085 irel->r_offset -= count;
12086 }
12087
12088 BFD_ASSERT (addr % 2 == 0);
12089 BFD_ASSERT (count % 2 == 0);
12090
12091 /* Adjust the local symbols defined in this section. */
12092 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
12093 isym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
12094 for (isymend = isym + symtab_hdr->sh_info; isym < isymend; isym++)
12095 if (isym->st_shndx == sec_shndx && isym->st_value > addr)
12096 isym->st_value -= count;
12097
12098 /* Now adjust the global symbols defined in this section. */
12099 symcount = (symtab_hdr->sh_size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Sym)
12100 - symtab_hdr->sh_info);
12101 sym_hashes = start_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
12102 end_hashes = sym_hashes + symcount;
12103
12104 for (; sym_hashes < end_hashes; sym_hashes++)
12105 {
12106 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym_hash = *sym_hashes;
12107
12108 if ((sym_hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
12109 || sym_hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
12110 && sym_hash->root.u.def.section == sec)
12111 {
12112 bfd_vma value = sym_hash->root.u.def.value;
12113
12114 if (ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (sym_hash->other))
12115 value &= MINUS_TWO;
12116 if (value > addr)
12117 sym_hash->root.u.def.value -= count;
12118 }
12119 }
12120
12121 return TRUE;
12122 }
12123
12124
12125 /* Opcodes needed for microMIPS relaxation as found in
12126 opcodes/micromips-opc.c. */
12127
12128 struct opcode_descriptor {
12129 unsigned long match;
12130 unsigned long mask;
12131 };
12132
12133 /* The $ra register aka $31. */
12134
12135 #define RA 31
12136
12137 /* 32-bit instruction format register fields. */
12138
12139 #define OP32_SREG(opcode) (((opcode) >> 16) & 0x1f)
12140 #define OP32_TREG(opcode) (((opcode) >> 21) & 0x1f)
12141
12142 /* Check if a 5-bit register index can be abbreviated to 3 bits. */
12143
12144 #define OP16_VALID_REG(r) \
12145 ((2 <= (r) && (r) <= 7) || (16 <= (r) && (r) <= 17))
12146
12147
12148 /* 32-bit and 16-bit branches. */
12149
12150 static const struct opcode_descriptor b_insns_32[] = {
12151 { /* "b", "p", */ 0x40400000, 0xffff0000 }, /* bgez 0 */
12152 { /* "b", "p", */ 0x94000000, 0xffff0000 }, /* beq 0, 0 */
12153 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
12154 };
12155
12156 static const struct opcode_descriptor bc_insn_32 =
12157 { /* "bc(1|2)(ft)", "N,p", */ 0x42800000, 0xfec30000 };
12158
12159 static const struct opcode_descriptor bz_insn_32 =
12160 { /* "b(g|l)(e|t)z", "s,p", */ 0x40000000, 0xff200000 };
12161
12162 static const struct opcode_descriptor bzal_insn_32 =
12163 { /* "b(ge|lt)zal", "s,p", */ 0x40200000, 0xffa00000 };
12164
12165 static const struct opcode_descriptor beq_insn_32 =
12166 { /* "b(eq|ne)", "s,t,p", */ 0x94000000, 0xdc000000 };
12167
12168 static const struct opcode_descriptor b_insn_16 =
12169 { /* "b", "mD", */ 0xcc00, 0xfc00 };
12170
12171 static const struct opcode_descriptor bz_insn_16 =
12172 { /* "b(eq|ne)z", "md,mE", */ 0x8c00, 0xdc00 };
12173
12174
12175 /* 32-bit and 16-bit branch EQ and NE zero. */
12176
12177 /* NOTE: All opcode tables have BEQ/BNE in the same order: first the
12178 eq and second the ne. This convention is used when replacing a
12179 32-bit BEQ/BNE with the 16-bit version. */
12180
12181 #define BZC32_REG_FIELD(r) (((r) & 0x1f) << 16)
12182
12183 static const struct opcode_descriptor bz_rs_insns_32[] = {
12184 { /* "beqz", "s,p", */ 0x94000000, 0xffe00000 },
12185 { /* "bnez", "s,p", */ 0xb4000000, 0xffe00000 },
12186 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
12187 };
12188
12189 static const struct opcode_descriptor bz_rt_insns_32[] = {
12190 { /* "beqz", "t,p", */ 0x94000000, 0xfc01f000 },
12191 { /* "bnez", "t,p", */ 0xb4000000, 0xfc01f000 },
12192 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
12193 };
12194
12195 static const struct opcode_descriptor bzc_insns_32[] = {
12196 { /* "beqzc", "s,p", */ 0x40e00000, 0xffe00000 },
12197 { /* "bnezc", "s,p", */ 0x40a00000, 0xffe00000 },
12198 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
12199 };
12200
12201 static const struct opcode_descriptor bz_insns_16[] = {
12202 { /* "beqz", "md,mE", */ 0x8c00, 0xfc00 },
12203 { /* "bnez", "md,mE", */ 0xac00, 0xfc00 },
12204 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
12205 };
12206
12207 /* Switch between a 5-bit register index and its 3-bit shorthand. */
12208
12209 #define BZ16_REG(opcode) ((((((opcode) >> 7) & 7) + 0x1e) & 0x17) + 2)
12210 #define BZ16_REG_FIELD(r) \
12211 (((2 <= (r) && (r) <= 7) ? (r) : ((r) - 16)) << 7)
12212
12213
12214 /* 32-bit instructions with a delay slot. */
12215
12216 static const struct opcode_descriptor jal_insn_32_bd16 =
12217 { /* "jals", "a", */ 0x74000000, 0xfc000000 };
12218
12219 static const struct opcode_descriptor jal_insn_32_bd32 =
12220 { /* "jal", "a", */ 0xf4000000, 0xfc000000 };
12221
12222 static const struct opcode_descriptor jal_x_insn_32_bd32 =
12223 { /* "jal[x]", "a", */ 0xf0000000, 0xf8000000 };
12224
12225 static const struct opcode_descriptor j_insn_32 =
12226 { /* "j", "a", */ 0xd4000000, 0xfc000000 };
12227
12228 static const struct opcode_descriptor jalr_insn_32 =
12229 { /* "jalr[.hb]", "t,s", */ 0x00000f3c, 0xfc00efff };
12230
12231 /* This table can be compacted, because no opcode replacement is made. */
12232
12233 static const struct opcode_descriptor ds_insns_32_bd16[] = {
12234 { /* "jals", "a", */ 0x74000000, 0xfc000000 },
12235
12236 { /* "jalrs[.hb]", "t,s", */ 0x00004f3c, 0xfc00efff },
12237 { /* "b(ge|lt)zals", "s,p", */ 0x42200000, 0xffa00000 },
12238
12239 { /* "b(g|l)(e|t)z", "s,p", */ 0x40000000, 0xff200000 },
12240 { /* "b(eq|ne)", "s,t,p", */ 0x94000000, 0xdc000000 },
12241 { /* "j", "a", */ 0xd4000000, 0xfc000000 },
12242 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
12243 };
12244
12245 /* This table can be compacted, because no opcode replacement is made. */
12246
12247 static const struct opcode_descriptor ds_insns_32_bd32[] = {
12248 { /* "jal[x]", "a", */ 0xf0000000, 0xf8000000 },
12249
12250 { /* "jalr[.hb]", "t,s", */ 0x00000f3c, 0xfc00efff },
12251 { /* "b(ge|lt)zal", "s,p", */ 0x40200000, 0xffa00000 },
12252 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
12253 };
12254
12255
12256 /* 16-bit instructions with a delay slot. */
12257
12258 static const struct opcode_descriptor jalr_insn_16_bd16 =
12259 { /* "jalrs", "my,mj", */ 0x45e0, 0xffe0 };
12260
12261 static const struct opcode_descriptor jalr_insn_16_bd32 =
12262 { /* "jalr", "my,mj", */ 0x45c0, 0xffe0 };
12263
12264 static const struct opcode_descriptor jr_insn_16 =
12265 { /* "jr", "mj", */ 0x4580, 0xffe0 };
12266
12267 #define JR16_REG(opcode) ((opcode) & 0x1f)
12268
12269 /* This table can be compacted, because no opcode replacement is made. */
12270
12271 static const struct opcode_descriptor ds_insns_16_bd16[] = {
12272 { /* "jalrs", "my,mj", */ 0x45e0, 0xffe0 },
12273
12274 { /* "b", "mD", */ 0xcc00, 0xfc00 },
12275 { /* "b(eq|ne)z", "md,mE", */ 0x8c00, 0xdc00 },
12276 { /* "jr", "mj", */ 0x4580, 0xffe0 },
12277 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
12278 };
12279
12280
12281 /* LUI instruction. */
12282
12283 static const struct opcode_descriptor lui_insn =
12284 { /* "lui", "s,u", */ 0x41a00000, 0xffe00000 };
12285
12286
12287 /* ADDIU instruction. */
12288
12289 static const struct opcode_descriptor addiu_insn =
12290 { /* "addiu", "t,r,j", */ 0x30000000, 0xfc000000 };
12291
12292 static const struct opcode_descriptor addiupc_insn =
12293 { /* "addiu", "mb,$pc,mQ", */ 0x78000000, 0xfc000000 };
12294
12295 #define ADDIUPC_REG_FIELD(r) \
12296 (((2 <= (r) && (r) <= 7) ? (r) : ((r) - 16)) << 23)
12297
12298
12299 /* Relaxable instructions in a JAL delay slot: MOVE. */
12300
12301 /* The 16-bit move has rd in 9:5 and rs in 4:0. The 32-bit moves
12302 (ADDU, OR) have rd in 15:11 and rs in 10:16. */
12303 #define MOVE32_RD(opcode) (((opcode) >> 11) & 0x1f)
12304 #define MOVE32_RS(opcode) (((opcode) >> 16) & 0x1f)
12305
12306 #define MOVE16_RD_FIELD(r) (((r) & 0x1f) << 5)
12307 #define MOVE16_RS_FIELD(r) (((r) & 0x1f) )
12308
12309 static const struct opcode_descriptor move_insns_32[] = {
12310 { /* "move", "d,s", */ 0x00000150, 0xffe007ff }, /* addu d,s,$0 */
12311 { /* "move", "d,s", */ 0x00000290, 0xffe007ff }, /* or d,s,$0 */
12312 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
12313 };
12314
12315 static const struct opcode_descriptor move_insn_16 =
12316 { /* "move", "mp,mj", */ 0x0c00, 0xfc00 };
12317
12318
12319 /* NOP instructions. */
12320
12321 static const struct opcode_descriptor nop_insn_32 =
12322 { /* "nop", "", */ 0x00000000, 0xffffffff };
12323
12324 static const struct opcode_descriptor nop_insn_16 =
12325 { /* "nop", "", */ 0x0c00, 0xffff };
12326
12327
12328 /* Instruction match support. */
12329
12330 #define MATCH(opcode, insn) ((opcode & insn.mask) == insn.match)
12331
12332 static int
12333 find_match (unsigned long opcode, const struct opcode_descriptor insn[])
12334 {
12335 unsigned long indx;
12336
12337 for (indx = 0; insn[indx].mask != 0; indx++)
12338 if (MATCH (opcode, insn[indx]))
12339 return indx;
12340
12341 return -1;
12342 }
12343
12344
12345 /* Branch and delay slot decoding support. */
12346
12347 /* If PTR points to what *might* be a 16-bit branch or jump, then
12348 return the minimum length of its delay slot, otherwise return 0.
12349 Non-zero results are not definitive as we might be checking against
12350 the second half of another instruction. */
12351
12352 static int
12353 check_br16_dslot (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *ptr)
12354 {
12355 unsigned long opcode;
12356 int bdsize;
12357
12358 opcode = bfd_get_16 (abfd, ptr);
12359 if (MATCH (opcode, jalr_insn_16_bd32) != 0)
12360 /* 16-bit branch/jump with a 32-bit delay slot. */
12361 bdsize = 4;
12362 else if (MATCH (opcode, jalr_insn_16_bd16) != 0
12363 || find_match (opcode, ds_insns_16_bd16) >= 0)
12364 /* 16-bit branch/jump with a 16-bit delay slot. */
12365 bdsize = 2;
12366 else
12367 /* No delay slot. */
12368 bdsize = 0;
12369
12370 return bdsize;
12371 }
12372
12373 /* If PTR points to what *might* be a 32-bit branch or jump, then
12374 return the minimum length of its delay slot, otherwise return 0.
12375 Non-zero results are not definitive as we might be checking against
12376 the second half of another instruction. */
12377
12378 static int
12379 check_br32_dslot (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *ptr)
12380 {
12381 unsigned long opcode;
12382 int bdsize;
12383
12384 opcode = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, ptr);
12385 if (find_match (opcode, ds_insns_32_bd32) >= 0)
12386 /* 32-bit branch/jump with a 32-bit delay slot. */
12387 bdsize = 4;
12388 else if (find_match (opcode, ds_insns_32_bd16) >= 0)
12389 /* 32-bit branch/jump with a 16-bit delay slot. */
12390 bdsize = 2;
12391 else
12392 /* No delay slot. */
12393 bdsize = 0;
12394
12395 return bdsize;
12396 }
12397
12398 /* If PTR points to a 16-bit branch or jump with a 32-bit delay slot
12399 that doesn't fiddle with REG, then return TRUE, otherwise FALSE. */
12400
12401 static bfd_boolean
12402 check_br16 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *ptr, unsigned long reg)
12403 {
12404 unsigned long opcode;
12405
12406 opcode = bfd_get_16 (abfd, ptr);
12407 if (MATCH (opcode, b_insn_16)
12408 /* B16 */
12409 || (MATCH (opcode, jr_insn_16) && reg != JR16_REG (opcode))
12410 /* JR16 */
12411 || (MATCH (opcode, bz_insn_16) && reg != BZ16_REG (opcode))
12412 /* BEQZ16, BNEZ16 */
12413 || (MATCH (opcode, jalr_insn_16_bd32)
12414 /* JALR16 */
12415 && reg != JR16_REG (opcode) && reg != RA))
12416 return TRUE;
12417
12418 return FALSE;
12419 }
12420
12421 /* If PTR points to a 32-bit branch or jump that doesn't fiddle with REG,
12422 then return TRUE, otherwise FALSE. */
12423
12424 static bfd_boolean
12425 check_br32 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *ptr, unsigned long reg)
12426 {
12427 unsigned long opcode;
12428
12429 opcode = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, ptr);
12430 if (MATCH (opcode, j_insn_32)
12431 /* J */
12432 || MATCH (opcode, bc_insn_32)
12433 /* BC1F, BC1T, BC2F, BC2T */
12434 || (MATCH (opcode, jal_x_insn_32_bd32) && reg != RA)
12435 /* JAL, JALX */
12436 || (MATCH (opcode, bz_insn_32) && reg != OP32_SREG (opcode))
12437 /* BGEZ, BGTZ, BLEZ, BLTZ */
12438 || (MATCH (opcode, bzal_insn_32)
12439 /* BGEZAL, BLTZAL */
12440 && reg != OP32_SREG (opcode) && reg != RA)
12441 || ((MATCH (opcode, jalr_insn_32) || MATCH (opcode, beq_insn_32))
12442 /* JALR, JALR.HB, BEQ, BNE */
12443 && reg != OP32_SREG (opcode) && reg != OP32_TREG (opcode)))
12444 return TRUE;
12445
12446 return FALSE;
12447 }
12448
12449 /* If the instruction encoding at PTR and relocations [INTERNAL_RELOCS,
12450 IRELEND) at OFFSET indicate that there must be a compact branch there,
12451 then return TRUE, otherwise FALSE. */
12452
12453 static bfd_boolean
12454 check_relocated_bzc (bfd *abfd, const bfd_byte *ptr, bfd_vma offset,
12455 const Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs,
12456 const Elf_Internal_Rela *irelend)
12457 {
12458 const Elf_Internal_Rela *irel;
12459 unsigned long opcode;
12460
12461 opcode = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, ptr);
12462 if (find_match (opcode, bzc_insns_32) < 0)
12463 return FALSE;
12464
12465 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
12466 if (irel->r_offset == offset
12467 && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) == R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1)
12468 return TRUE;
12469
12470 return FALSE;
12471 }
12472
12473 /* Bitsize checking. */
12474 #define IS_BITSIZE(val, N) \
12475 (((((val) & ((1ULL << (N)) - 1)) ^ (1ULL << ((N) - 1))) \
12476 - (1ULL << ((N) - 1))) == (val))
12477
12478 \f
12479 bfd_boolean
12480 _bfd_mips_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
12481 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
12482 bfd_boolean *again)
12483 {
12484 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
12485 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
12486 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend;
12487 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
12488 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
12489
12490 /* Assume nothing changes. */
12491 *again = FALSE;
12492
12493 /* We don't have to do anything for a relocatable link, if
12494 this section does not have relocs, or if this is not a
12495 code section. */
12496
12497 if (link_info->relocatable
12498 || (sec->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
12499 || sec->reloc_count == 0
12500 || (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0)
12501 return TRUE;
12502
12503 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
12504
12505 /* Get a copy of the native relocations. */
12506 internal_relocs = (_bfd_elf_link_read_relocs
12507 (abfd, sec, NULL, (Elf_Internal_Rela *) NULL,
12508 link_info->keep_memory));
12509 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
12510 goto error_return;
12511
12512 /* Walk through them looking for relaxing opportunities. */
12513 irelend = internal_relocs + sec->reloc_count;
12514 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
12515 {
12516 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
12517 unsigned int r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
12518 bfd_boolean target_is_micromips_code_p;
12519 unsigned long opcode;
12520 bfd_vma symval;
12521 bfd_vma pcrval;
12522 bfd_byte *ptr;
12523 int fndopc;
12524
12525 /* The number of bytes to delete for relaxation and from where
12526 to delete these bytes starting at irel->r_offset. */
12527 int delcnt = 0;
12528 int deloff = 0;
12529
12530 /* If this isn't something that can be relaxed, then ignore
12531 this reloc. */
12532 if (r_type != R_MICROMIPS_HI16
12533 && r_type != R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1
12534 && r_type != R_MICROMIPS_26_S1)
12535 continue;
12536
12537 /* Get the section contents if we haven't done so already. */
12538 if (contents == NULL)
12539 {
12540 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
12541 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
12542 contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
12543 /* Go get them off disk. */
12544 else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, sec, &contents))
12545 goto error_return;
12546 }
12547 ptr = contents + irel->r_offset;
12548
12549 /* Read this BFD's local symbols if we haven't done so already. */
12550 if (isymbuf == NULL && symtab_hdr->sh_info != 0)
12551 {
12552 isymbuf = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
12553 if (isymbuf == NULL)
12554 isymbuf = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr,
12555 symtab_hdr->sh_info, 0,
12556 NULL, NULL, NULL);
12557 if (isymbuf == NULL)
12558 goto error_return;
12559 }
12560
12561 /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc. */
12562 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
12563 {
12564 /* A local symbol. */
12565 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
12566 asection *sym_sec;
12567
12568 isym = isymbuf + r_symndx;
12569 if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_UNDEF)
12570 sym_sec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
12571 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
12572 sym_sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
12573 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON)
12574 sym_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
12575 else
12576 sym_sec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
12577 symval = (isym->st_value
12578 + sym_sec->output_section->vma
12579 + sym_sec->output_offset);
12580 target_is_micromips_code_p = ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (isym->st_other);
12581 }
12582 else
12583 {
12584 unsigned long indx;
12585 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
12586
12587 /* An external symbol. */
12588 indx = r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
12589 h = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[indx];
12590 BFD_ASSERT (h != NULL);
12591
12592 if (h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
12593 && h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
12594 /* This appears to be a reference to an undefined
12595 symbol. Just ignore it -- it will be caught by the
12596 regular reloc processing. */
12597 continue;
12598
12599 symval = (h->root.u.def.value
12600 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
12601 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset);
12602 target_is_micromips_code_p = (!h->needs_plt
12603 && ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (h->other));
12604 }
12605
12606
12607 /* For simplicity of coding, we are going to modify the
12608 section contents, the section relocs, and the BFD symbol
12609 table. We must tell the rest of the code not to free up this
12610 information. It would be possible to instead create a table
12611 of changes which have to be made, as is done in coff-mips.c;
12612 that would be more work, but would require less memory when
12613 the linker is run. */
12614
12615 /* Only 32-bit instructions relaxed. */
12616 if (irel->r_offset + 4 > sec->size)
12617 continue;
12618
12619 opcode = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, ptr);
12620
12621 /* This is the pc-relative distance from the instruction the
12622 relocation is applied to, to the symbol referred. */
12623 pcrval = (symval
12624 - (sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset)
12625 - irel->r_offset);
12626
12627 /* R_MICROMIPS_HI16 / LUI relaxation to nil, performing relaxation
12628 of corresponding R_MICROMIPS_LO16 to R_MICROMIPS_HI0_LO16 or
12629 R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2. The R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2 condition is
12630
12631 (symval % 4 == 0 && IS_BITSIZE (pcrval, 25))
12632
12633 where pcrval has first to be adjusted to apply against the LO16
12634 location (we make the adjustment later on, when we have figured
12635 out the offset). */
12636 if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_HI16 && MATCH (opcode, lui_insn))
12637 {
12638 bfd_boolean bzc = FALSE;
12639 unsigned long nextopc;
12640 unsigned long reg;
12641 bfd_vma offset;
12642
12643 /* Give up if the previous reloc was a HI16 against this symbol
12644 too. */
12645 if (irel > internal_relocs
12646 && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info) == R_MICROMIPS_HI16
12647 && ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info) == r_symndx)
12648 continue;
12649
12650 /* Or if the next reloc is not a LO16 against this symbol. */
12651 if (irel + 1 >= irelend
12652 || ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[1].r_info) != R_MICROMIPS_LO16
12653 || ELF32_R_SYM (irel[1].r_info) != r_symndx)
12654 continue;
12655
12656 /* Or if the second next reloc is a LO16 against this symbol too. */
12657 if (irel + 2 >= irelend
12658 && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[2].r_info) == R_MICROMIPS_LO16
12659 && ELF32_R_SYM (irel[2].r_info) == r_symndx)
12660 continue;
12661
12662 /* See if the LUI instruction *might* be in a branch delay slot.
12663 We check whether what looks like a 16-bit branch or jump is
12664 actually an immediate argument to a compact branch, and let
12665 it through if so. */
12666 if (irel->r_offset >= 2
12667 && check_br16_dslot (abfd, ptr - 2)
12668 && !(irel->r_offset >= 4
12669 && (bzc = check_relocated_bzc (abfd,
12670 ptr - 4, irel->r_offset - 4,
12671 internal_relocs, irelend))))
12672 continue;
12673 if (irel->r_offset >= 4
12674 && !bzc
12675 && check_br32_dslot (abfd, ptr - 4))
12676 continue;
12677
12678 reg = OP32_SREG (opcode);
12679
12680 /* We only relax adjacent instructions or ones separated with
12681 a branch or jump that has a delay slot. The branch or jump
12682 must not fiddle with the register used to hold the address.
12683 Subtract 4 for the LUI itself. */
12684 offset = irel[1].r_offset - irel[0].r_offset;
12685 switch (offset - 4)
12686 {
12687 case 0:
12688 break;
12689 case 2:
12690 if (check_br16 (abfd, ptr + 4, reg))
12691 break;
12692 continue;
12693 case 4:
12694 if (check_br32 (abfd, ptr + 4, reg))
12695 break;
12696 continue;
12697 default:
12698 continue;
12699 }
12700
12701 nextopc = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, contents + irel[1].r_offset);
12702
12703 /* Give up unless the same register is used with both
12704 relocations. */
12705 if (OP32_SREG (nextopc) != reg)
12706 continue;
12707
12708 /* Now adjust pcrval, subtracting the offset to the LO16 reloc
12709 and rounding up to take masking of the two LSBs into account. */
12710 pcrval = ((pcrval - offset + 3) | 3) ^ 3;
12711
12712 /* R_MICROMIPS_LO16 relaxation to R_MICROMIPS_HI0_LO16. */
12713 if (IS_BITSIZE (symval, 16))
12714 {
12715 /* Fix the relocation's type. */
12716 irel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_MICROMIPS_HI0_LO16);
12717
12718 /* Instructions using R_MICROMIPS_LO16 have the base or
12719 source register in bits 20:16. This register becomes $0
12720 (zero) as the result of the R_MICROMIPS_HI16 being 0. */
12721 nextopc &= ~0x001f0000;
12722 bfd_put_16 (abfd, (nextopc >> 16) & 0xffff,
12723 contents + irel[1].r_offset);
12724 }
12725
12726 /* R_MICROMIPS_LO16 / ADDIU relaxation to R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2.
12727 We add 4 to take LUI deletion into account while checking
12728 the PC-relative distance. */
12729 else if (symval % 4 == 0
12730 && IS_BITSIZE (pcrval + 4, 25)
12731 && MATCH (nextopc, addiu_insn)
12732 && OP32_TREG (nextopc) == OP32_SREG (nextopc)
12733 && OP16_VALID_REG (OP32_TREG (nextopc)))
12734 {
12735 /* Fix the relocation's type. */
12736 irel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2);
12737
12738 /* Replace ADDIU with the ADDIUPC version. */
12739 nextopc = (addiupc_insn.match
12740 | ADDIUPC_REG_FIELD (OP32_TREG (nextopc)));
12741
12742 bfd_put_micromips_32 (abfd, nextopc,
12743 contents + irel[1].r_offset);
12744 }
12745
12746 /* Can't do anything, give up, sigh... */
12747 else
12748 continue;
12749
12750 /* Fix the relocation's type. */
12751 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_MIPS_NONE);
12752
12753 /* Delete the LUI instruction: 4 bytes at irel->r_offset. */
12754 delcnt = 4;
12755 deloff = 0;
12756 }
12757
12758 /* Compact branch relaxation -- due to the multitude of macros
12759 employed by the compiler/assembler, compact branches are not
12760 always generated. Obviously, this can/will be fixed elsewhere,
12761 but there is no drawback in double checking it here. */
12762 else if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1
12763 && irel->r_offset + 5 < sec->size
12764 && ((fndopc = find_match (opcode, bz_rs_insns_32)) >= 0
12765 || (fndopc = find_match (opcode, bz_rt_insns_32)) >= 0)
12766 && MATCH (bfd_get_16 (abfd, ptr + 4), nop_insn_16))
12767 {
12768 unsigned long reg;
12769
12770 reg = OP32_SREG (opcode) ? OP32_SREG (opcode) : OP32_TREG (opcode);
12771
12772 /* Replace BEQZ/BNEZ with the compact version. */
12773 opcode = (bzc_insns_32[fndopc].match
12774 | BZC32_REG_FIELD (reg)
12775 | (opcode & 0xffff)); /* Addend value. */
12776
12777 bfd_put_micromips_32 (abfd, opcode, ptr);
12778
12779 /* Delete the 16-bit delay slot NOP: two bytes from
12780 irel->offset + 4. */
12781 delcnt = 2;
12782 deloff = 4;
12783 }
12784
12785 /* R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1 relaxation to R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1. We need
12786 to check the distance from the next instruction, so subtract 2. */
12787 else if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1
12788 && IS_BITSIZE (pcrval - 2, 11)
12789 && find_match (opcode, b_insns_32) >= 0)
12790 {
12791 /* Fix the relocation's type. */
12792 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1);
12793
12794 /* Replace the 32-bit opcode with a 16-bit opcode. */
12795 bfd_put_16 (abfd,
12796 (b_insn_16.match
12797 | (opcode & 0x3ff)), /* Addend value. */
12798 ptr);
12799
12800 /* Delete 2 bytes from irel->r_offset + 2. */
12801 delcnt = 2;
12802 deloff = 2;
12803 }
12804
12805 /* R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1 relaxation to R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1. We need
12806 to check the distance from the next instruction, so subtract 2. */
12807 else if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1
12808 && IS_BITSIZE (pcrval - 2, 8)
12809 && (((fndopc = find_match (opcode, bz_rs_insns_32)) >= 0
12810 && OP16_VALID_REG (OP32_SREG (opcode)))
12811 || ((fndopc = find_match (opcode, bz_rt_insns_32)) >= 0
12812 && OP16_VALID_REG (OP32_TREG (opcode)))))
12813 {
12814 unsigned long reg;
12815
12816 reg = OP32_SREG (opcode) ? OP32_SREG (opcode) : OP32_TREG (opcode);
12817
12818 /* Fix the relocation's type. */
12819 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1);
12820
12821 /* Replace the 32-bit opcode with a 16-bit opcode. */
12822 bfd_put_16 (abfd,
12823 (bz_insns_16[fndopc].match
12824 | BZ16_REG_FIELD (reg)
12825 | (opcode & 0x7f)), /* Addend value. */
12826 ptr);
12827
12828 /* Delete 2 bytes from irel->r_offset + 2. */
12829 delcnt = 2;
12830 deloff = 2;
12831 }
12832
12833 /* R_MICROMIPS_26_S1 -- JAL to JALS relaxation for microMIPS targets. */
12834 else if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_26_S1
12835 && target_is_micromips_code_p
12836 && irel->r_offset + 7 < sec->size
12837 && MATCH (opcode, jal_insn_32_bd32))
12838 {
12839 unsigned long n32opc;
12840 bfd_boolean relaxed = FALSE;
12841
12842 n32opc = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, ptr + 4);
12843
12844 if (MATCH (n32opc, nop_insn_32))
12845 {
12846 /* Replace delay slot 32-bit NOP with a 16-bit NOP. */
12847 bfd_put_16 (abfd, nop_insn_16.match, ptr + 4);
12848
12849 relaxed = TRUE;
12850 }
12851 else if (find_match (n32opc, move_insns_32) >= 0)
12852 {
12853 /* Replace delay slot 32-bit MOVE with 16-bit MOVE. */
12854 bfd_put_16 (abfd,
12855 (move_insn_16.match
12856 | MOVE16_RD_FIELD (MOVE32_RD (n32opc))
12857 | MOVE16_RS_FIELD (MOVE32_RS (n32opc))),
12858 ptr + 4);
12859
12860 relaxed = TRUE;
12861 }
12862 /* Other 32-bit instructions relaxable to 16-bit
12863 instructions will be handled here later. */
12864
12865 if (relaxed)
12866 {
12867 /* JAL with 32-bit delay slot that is changed to a JALS
12868 with 16-bit delay slot. */
12869 bfd_put_micromips_32 (abfd, jal_insn_32_bd16.match, ptr);
12870
12871 /* Delete 2 bytes from irel->r_offset + 6. */
12872 delcnt = 2;
12873 deloff = 6;
12874 }
12875 }
12876
12877 if (delcnt != 0)
12878 {
12879 /* Note that we've changed the relocs, section contents, etc. */
12880 elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = internal_relocs;
12881 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
12882 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
12883
12884 /* Delete bytes depending on the delcnt and deloff. */
12885 if (!mips_elf_relax_delete_bytes (abfd, sec,
12886 irel->r_offset + deloff, delcnt))
12887 goto error_return;
12888
12889 /* That will change things, so we should relax again.
12890 Note that this is not required, and it may be slow. */
12891 *again = TRUE;
12892 }
12893 }
12894
12895 if (isymbuf != NULL
12896 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
12897 {
12898 if (! link_info->keep_memory)
12899 free (isymbuf);
12900 else
12901 {
12902 /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd. */
12903 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
12904 }
12905 }
12906
12907 if (contents != NULL
12908 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
12909 {
12910 if (! link_info->keep_memory)
12911 free (contents);
12912 else
12913 {
12914 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
12915 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
12916 }
12917 }
12918
12919 if (internal_relocs != NULL
12920 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
12921 free (internal_relocs);
12922
12923 return TRUE;
12924
12925 error_return:
12926 if (isymbuf != NULL
12927 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
12928 free (isymbuf);
12929 if (contents != NULL
12930 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
12931 free (contents);
12932 if (internal_relocs != NULL
12933 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
12934 free (internal_relocs);
12935
12936 return FALSE;
12937 }
12938 \f
12939 /* Create a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
12940
12941 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
12942 _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
12943 {
12944 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
12945 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table);
12946
12947 ret = bfd_zmalloc (amt);
12948 if (ret == NULL)
12949 return NULL;
12950
12951 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->root, abfd,
12952 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
12953 sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry),
12954 MIPS_ELF_DATA))
12955 {
12956 free (ret);
12957 return NULL;
12958 }
12959
12960 return &ret->root.root;
12961 }
12962
12963 /* Likewise, but indicate that the target is VxWorks. */
12964
12965 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
12966 _bfd_mips_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
12967 {
12968 struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
12969
12970 ret = _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
12971 if (ret)
12972 {
12973 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
12974
12975 htab = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ret;
12976 htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs = TRUE;
12977 htab->is_vxworks = TRUE;
12978 }
12979 return ret;
12980 }
12981
12982 /* A function that the linker calls if we are allowed to use PLTs
12983 and copy relocs. */
12984
12985 void
12986 _bfd_mips_elf_use_plts_and_copy_relocs (struct bfd_link_info *info)
12987 {
12988 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_plts_and_copy_relocs = TRUE;
12989 }
12990 \f
12991 /* We need to use a special link routine to handle the .reginfo and
12992 the .mdebug sections. We need to merge all instances of these
12993 sections together, not write them all out sequentially. */
12994
12995 bfd_boolean
12996 _bfd_mips_elf_final_link (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
12997 {
12998 asection *o;
12999 struct bfd_link_order *p;
13000 asection *reginfo_sec, *mdebug_sec, *gptab_data_sec, *gptab_bss_sec;
13001 asection *rtproc_sec;
13002 Elf32_RegInfo reginfo;
13003 struct ecoff_debug_info debug;
13004 struct mips_htab_traverse_info hti;
13005 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
13006 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap = bed->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
13007 HDRR *symhdr = &debug.symbolic_header;
13008 void *mdebug_handle = NULL;
13009 asection *s;
13010 EXTR esym;
13011 unsigned int i;
13012 bfd_size_type amt;
13013 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
13014
13015 static const char * const secname[] =
13016 {
13017 ".text", ".init", ".fini", ".data",
13018 ".rodata", ".sdata", ".sbss", ".bss"
13019 };
13020 static const int sc[] =
13021 {
13022 scText, scInit, scFini, scData,
13023 scRData, scSData, scSBss, scBss
13024 };
13025
13026 /* Sort the dynamic symbols so that those with GOT entries come after
13027 those without. */
13028 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
13029 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
13030
13031 if (!mips_elf_sort_hash_table (abfd, info))
13032 return FALSE;
13033
13034 /* Create any scheduled LA25 stubs. */
13035 hti.info = info;
13036 hti.output_bfd = abfd;
13037 hti.error = FALSE;
13038 htab_traverse (htab->la25_stubs, mips_elf_create_la25_stub, &hti);
13039 if (hti.error)
13040 return FALSE;
13041
13042 /* Get a value for the GP register. */
13043 if (elf_gp (abfd) == 0)
13044 {
13045 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
13046
13047 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
13048 if (h != NULL && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
13049 elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.value
13050 + h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
13051 + h->u.def.section->output_offset);
13052 else if (htab->is_vxworks
13053 && (h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash,
13054 "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_",
13055 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE))
13056 && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
13057 elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
13058 + h->u.def.section->output_offset
13059 + h->u.def.value);
13060 else if (info->relocatable)
13061 {
13062 bfd_vma lo = MINUS_ONE;
13063
13064 /* Find the GP-relative section with the lowest offset. */
13065 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
13066 if (o->vma < lo
13067 && (elf_section_data (o)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_MIPS_GPREL))
13068 lo = o->vma;
13069
13070 /* And calculate GP relative to that. */
13071 elf_gp (abfd) = lo + ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (info);
13072 }
13073 else
13074 {
13075 /* If the relocate_section function needs to do a reloc
13076 involving the GP value, it should make a reloc_dangerous
13077 callback to warn that GP is not defined. */
13078 }
13079 }
13080
13081 /* Go through the sections and collect the .reginfo and .mdebug
13082 information. */
13083 reginfo_sec = NULL;
13084 mdebug_sec = NULL;
13085 gptab_data_sec = NULL;
13086 gptab_bss_sec = NULL;
13087 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
13088 {
13089 if (strcmp (o->name, ".reginfo") == 0)
13090 {
13091 memset (&reginfo, 0, sizeof reginfo);
13092
13093 /* We have found the .reginfo section in the output file.
13094 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
13095 the information together. */
13096 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
13097 {
13098 asection *input_section;
13099 bfd *input_bfd;
13100 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
13101 Elf32_RegInfo sub;
13102
13103 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
13104 {
13105 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
13106 continue;
13107 abort ();
13108 }
13109
13110 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
13111 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
13112
13113 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section,
13114 &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
13115 return FALSE;
13116
13117 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (input_bfd, &ext, &sub);
13118
13119 reginfo.ri_gprmask |= sub.ri_gprmask;
13120 reginfo.ri_cprmask[0] |= sub.ri_cprmask[0];
13121 reginfo.ri_cprmask[1] |= sub.ri_cprmask[1];
13122 reginfo.ri_cprmask[2] |= sub.ri_cprmask[2];
13123 reginfo.ri_cprmask[3] |= sub.ri_cprmask[3];
13124
13125 /* ri_gp_value is set by the function
13126 mips_elf32_section_processing when the section is
13127 finally written out. */
13128
13129 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
13130 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
13131 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
13132 }
13133
13134 /* Size has been set in _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections. */
13135 BFD_ASSERT(o->size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
13136
13137 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
13138 matters, but someday it might). */
13139 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
13140
13141 reginfo_sec = o;
13142 }
13143
13144 if (strcmp (o->name, ".mdebug") == 0)
13145 {
13146 struct extsym_info einfo;
13147 bfd_vma last;
13148
13149 /* We have found the .mdebug section in the output file.
13150 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
13151 the information together. */
13152 symhdr->magic = swap->sym_magic;
13153 /* FIXME: What should the version stamp be? */
13154 symhdr->vstamp = 0;
13155 symhdr->ilineMax = 0;
13156 symhdr->cbLine = 0;
13157 symhdr->idnMax = 0;
13158 symhdr->ipdMax = 0;
13159 symhdr->isymMax = 0;
13160 symhdr->ioptMax = 0;
13161 symhdr->iauxMax = 0;
13162 symhdr->issMax = 0;
13163 symhdr->issExtMax = 0;
13164 symhdr->ifdMax = 0;
13165 symhdr->crfd = 0;
13166 symhdr->iextMax = 0;
13167
13168 /* We accumulate the debugging information itself in the
13169 debug_info structure. */
13170 debug.line = NULL;
13171 debug.external_dnr = NULL;
13172 debug.external_pdr = NULL;
13173 debug.external_sym = NULL;
13174 debug.external_opt = NULL;
13175 debug.external_aux = NULL;
13176 debug.ss = NULL;
13177 debug.ssext = debug.ssext_end = NULL;
13178 debug.external_fdr = NULL;
13179 debug.external_rfd = NULL;
13180 debug.external_ext = debug.external_ext_end = NULL;
13181
13182 mdebug_handle = bfd_ecoff_debug_init (abfd, &debug, swap, info);
13183 if (mdebug_handle == NULL)
13184 return FALSE;
13185
13186 esym.jmptbl = 0;
13187 esym.cobol_main = 0;
13188 esym.weakext = 0;
13189 esym.reserved = 0;
13190 esym.ifd = ifdNil;
13191 esym.asym.iss = issNil;
13192 esym.asym.st = stLocal;
13193 esym.asym.reserved = 0;
13194 esym.asym.index = indexNil;
13195 last = 0;
13196 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (secname) / sizeof (secname[0]); i++)
13197 {
13198 esym.asym.sc = sc[i];
13199 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, secname[i]);
13200 if (s != NULL)
13201 {
13202 esym.asym.value = s->vma;
13203 last = s->vma + s->size;
13204 }
13205 else
13206 esym.asym.value = last;
13207 if (!bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (abfd, &debug, swap,
13208 secname[i], &esym))
13209 return FALSE;
13210 }
13211
13212 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
13213 {
13214 asection *input_section;
13215 bfd *input_bfd;
13216 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *input_swap;
13217 struct ecoff_debug_info input_debug;
13218 char *eraw_src;
13219 char *eraw_end;
13220
13221 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
13222 {
13223 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
13224 continue;
13225 abort ();
13226 }
13227
13228 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
13229 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
13230
13231 if (!is_mips_elf (input_bfd))
13232 {
13233 /* I don't know what a non MIPS ELF bfd would be
13234 doing with a .mdebug section, but I don't really
13235 want to deal with it. */
13236 continue;
13237 }
13238
13239 input_swap = (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
13240 ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap);
13241
13242 BFD_ASSERT (p->size == input_section->size);
13243
13244 /* The ECOFF linking code expects that we have already
13245 read in the debugging information and set up an
13246 ecoff_debug_info structure, so we do that now. */
13247 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (input_bfd, input_section,
13248 &input_debug))
13249 return FALSE;
13250
13251 if (! (bfd_ecoff_debug_accumulate
13252 (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, input_bfd,
13253 &input_debug, input_swap, info)))
13254 return FALSE;
13255
13256 /* Loop through the external symbols. For each one with
13257 interesting information, try to find the symbol in
13258 the linker global hash table and save the information
13259 for the output external symbols. */
13260 eraw_src = input_debug.external_ext;
13261 eraw_end = (eraw_src
13262 + (input_debug.symbolic_header.iextMax
13263 * input_swap->external_ext_size));
13264 for (;
13265 eraw_src < eraw_end;
13266 eraw_src += input_swap->external_ext_size)
13267 {
13268 EXTR ext;
13269 const char *name;
13270 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
13271
13272 (*input_swap->swap_ext_in) (input_bfd, eraw_src, &ext);
13273 if (ext.asym.sc == scNil
13274 || ext.asym.sc == scUndefined
13275 || ext.asym.sc == scSUndefined)
13276 continue;
13277
13278 name = input_debug.ssext + ext.asym.iss;
13279 h = mips_elf_link_hash_lookup (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
13280 name, FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
13281 if (h == NULL || h->esym.ifd != -2)
13282 continue;
13283
13284 if (ext.ifd != -1)
13285 {
13286 BFD_ASSERT (ext.ifd
13287 < input_debug.symbolic_header.ifdMax);
13288 ext.ifd = input_debug.ifdmap[ext.ifd];
13289 }
13290
13291 h->esym = ext;
13292 }
13293
13294 /* Free up the information we just read. */
13295 free (input_debug.line);
13296 free (input_debug.external_dnr);
13297 free (input_debug.external_pdr);
13298 free (input_debug.external_sym);
13299 free (input_debug.external_opt);
13300 free (input_debug.external_aux);
13301 free (input_debug.ss);
13302 free (input_debug.ssext);
13303 free (input_debug.external_fdr);
13304 free (input_debug.external_rfd);
13305 free (input_debug.external_ext);
13306
13307 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
13308 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
13309 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
13310 }
13311
13312 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && info->shared)
13313 {
13314 /* Create .rtproc section. */
13315 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".rtproc");
13316 if (rtproc_sec == NULL)
13317 {
13318 flagword flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
13319 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
13320
13321 rtproc_sec = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd,
13322 ".rtproc",
13323 flags);
13324 if (rtproc_sec == NULL
13325 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, rtproc_sec, 4))
13326 return FALSE;
13327 }
13328
13329 if (! mips_elf_create_procedure_table (mdebug_handle, abfd,
13330 info, rtproc_sec,
13331 &debug))
13332 return FALSE;
13333 }
13334
13335 /* Build the external symbol information. */
13336 einfo.abfd = abfd;
13337 einfo.info = info;
13338 einfo.debug = &debug;
13339 einfo.swap = swap;
13340 einfo.failed = FALSE;
13341 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
13342 mips_elf_output_extsym, &einfo);
13343 if (einfo.failed)
13344 return FALSE;
13345
13346 /* Set the size of the .mdebug section. */
13347 o->size = bfd_ecoff_debug_size (abfd, &debug, swap);
13348
13349 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
13350 matters, but someday it might). */
13351 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
13352
13353 mdebug_sec = o;
13354 }
13355
13356 if (CONST_STRNEQ (o->name, ".gptab."))
13357 {
13358 const char *subname;
13359 unsigned int c;
13360 Elf32_gptab *tab;
13361 Elf32_External_gptab *ext_tab;
13362 unsigned int j;
13363
13364 /* The .gptab.sdata and .gptab.sbss sections hold
13365 information describing how the small data area would
13366 change depending upon the -G switch. These sections
13367 not used in executables files. */
13368 if (! info->relocatable)
13369 {
13370 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
13371 {
13372 asection *input_section;
13373
13374 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
13375 {
13376 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
13377 continue;
13378 abort ();
13379 }
13380
13381 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
13382
13383 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
13384 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
13385 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
13386 }
13387
13388 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this
13389 currently matters, but someday it might). */
13390 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
13391
13392 /* Really remove the section. */
13393 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, o);
13394 --abfd->section_count;
13395
13396 continue;
13397 }
13398
13399 /* There is one gptab for initialized data, and one for
13400 uninitialized data. */
13401 if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sdata") == 0)
13402 gptab_data_sec = o;
13403 else if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sbss") == 0)
13404 gptab_bss_sec = o;
13405 else
13406 {
13407 (*_bfd_error_handler)
13408 (_("%s: illegal section name `%s'"),
13409 bfd_get_filename (abfd), o->name);
13410 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
13411 return FALSE;
13412 }
13413
13414 /* The linker script always combines .gptab.data and
13415 .gptab.sdata into .gptab.sdata, and likewise for
13416 .gptab.bss and .gptab.sbss. It is possible that there is
13417 no .sdata or .sbss section in the output file, in which
13418 case we must change the name of the output section. */
13419 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
13420 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) == NULL)
13421 {
13422 if (o == gptab_data_sec)
13423 o->name = ".gptab.data";
13424 else
13425 o->name = ".gptab.bss";
13426 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
13427 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) != NULL);
13428 }
13429
13430 /* Set up the first entry. */
13431 c = 1;
13432 amt = c * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
13433 tab = bfd_malloc (amt);
13434 if (tab == NULL)
13435 return FALSE;
13436 tab[0].gt_header.gt_current_g_value = elf_gp_size (abfd);
13437 tab[0].gt_header.gt_unused = 0;
13438
13439 /* Combine the input sections. */
13440 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
13441 {
13442 asection *input_section;
13443 bfd *input_bfd;
13444 bfd_size_type size;
13445 unsigned long last;
13446 bfd_size_type gpentry;
13447
13448 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
13449 {
13450 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
13451 continue;
13452 abort ();
13453 }
13454
13455 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
13456 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
13457
13458 /* Combine the gptab entries for this input section one
13459 by one. We know that the input gptab entries are
13460 sorted by ascending -G value. */
13461 size = input_section->size;
13462 last = 0;
13463 for (gpentry = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
13464 gpentry < size;
13465 gpentry += sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))
13466 {
13467 Elf32_External_gptab ext_gptab;
13468 Elf32_gptab int_gptab;
13469 unsigned long val;
13470 unsigned long add;
13471 bfd_boolean exact;
13472 unsigned int look;
13473
13474 if (! (bfd_get_section_contents
13475 (input_bfd, input_section, &ext_gptab, gpentry,
13476 sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))))
13477 {
13478 free (tab);
13479 return FALSE;
13480 }
13481
13482 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (input_bfd, &ext_gptab,
13483 &int_gptab);
13484 val = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_g_value;
13485 add = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes - last;
13486
13487 exact = FALSE;
13488 for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
13489 {
13490 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value >= val)
13491 tab[look].gt_entry.gt_bytes += add;
13492
13493 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value == val)
13494 exact = TRUE;
13495 }
13496
13497 if (! exact)
13498 {
13499 Elf32_gptab *new_tab;
13500 unsigned int max;
13501
13502 /* We need a new table entry. */
13503 amt = (bfd_size_type) (c + 1) * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
13504 new_tab = bfd_realloc (tab, amt);
13505 if (new_tab == NULL)
13506 {
13507 free (tab);
13508 return FALSE;
13509 }
13510 tab = new_tab;
13511 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_g_value = val;
13512 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes = add;
13513
13514 /* Merge in the size for the next smallest -G
13515 value, since that will be implied by this new
13516 value. */
13517 max = 0;
13518 for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
13519 {
13520 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value < val
13521 && (max == 0
13522 || (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value
13523 > tab[max].gt_entry.gt_g_value)))
13524 max = look;
13525 }
13526 if (max != 0)
13527 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes +=
13528 tab[max].gt_entry.gt_bytes;
13529
13530 ++c;
13531 }
13532
13533 last = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes;
13534 }
13535
13536 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
13537 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
13538 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
13539 }
13540
13541 /* The table must be sorted by -G value. */
13542 if (c > 2)
13543 qsort (tab + 1, c - 1, sizeof (tab[0]), gptab_compare);
13544
13545 /* Swap out the table. */
13546 amt = (bfd_size_type) c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
13547 ext_tab = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
13548 if (ext_tab == NULL)
13549 {
13550 free (tab);
13551 return FALSE;
13552 }
13553
13554 for (j = 0; j < c; j++)
13555 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (abfd, tab + j, ext_tab + j);
13556 free (tab);
13557
13558 o->size = c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
13559 o->contents = (bfd_byte *) ext_tab;
13560
13561 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
13562 matters, but someday it might). */
13563 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
13564 }
13565 }
13566
13567 /* Invoke the regular ELF backend linker to do all the work. */
13568 if (!bfd_elf_final_link (abfd, info))
13569 return FALSE;
13570
13571 /* Now write out the computed sections. */
13572
13573 if (reginfo_sec != NULL)
13574 {
13575 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
13576
13577 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (abfd, &reginfo, &ext);
13578 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, reginfo_sec, &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
13579 return FALSE;
13580 }
13581
13582 if (mdebug_sec != NULL)
13583 {
13584 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->output_has_begun);
13585 if (! bfd_ecoff_write_accumulated_debug (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug,
13586 swap, info,
13587 mdebug_sec->filepos))
13588 return FALSE;
13589
13590 bfd_ecoff_debug_free (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, info);
13591 }
13592
13593 if (gptab_data_sec != NULL)
13594 {
13595 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_data_sec,
13596 gptab_data_sec->contents,
13597 0, gptab_data_sec->size))
13598 return FALSE;
13599 }
13600
13601 if (gptab_bss_sec != NULL)
13602 {
13603 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_bss_sec,
13604 gptab_bss_sec->contents,
13605 0, gptab_bss_sec->size))
13606 return FALSE;
13607 }
13608
13609 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
13610 {
13611 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
13612 if (rtproc_sec != NULL)
13613 {
13614 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, rtproc_sec,
13615 rtproc_sec->contents,
13616 0, rtproc_sec->size))
13617 return FALSE;
13618 }
13619 }
13620
13621 return TRUE;
13622 }
13623 \f
13624 /* Structure for saying that BFD machine EXTENSION extends BASE. */
13625
13626 struct mips_mach_extension {
13627 unsigned long extension, base;
13628 };
13629
13630
13631 /* An array describing how BFD machines relate to one another. The entries
13632 are ordered topologically with MIPS I extensions listed last. */
13633
13634 static const struct mips_mach_extension mips_mach_extensions[] = {
13635 /* MIPS64r2 extensions. */
13636 { bfd_mach_mips_octeon2, bfd_mach_mips_octeonp },
13637 { bfd_mach_mips_octeonp, bfd_mach_mips_octeon },
13638 { bfd_mach_mips_octeon, bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2 },
13639
13640 /* MIPS64 extensions. */
13641 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
13642 { bfd_mach_mips_sb1, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
13643 { bfd_mach_mips_xlr, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
13644 { bfd_mach_mips_loongson_3a, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
13645
13646 /* MIPS V extensions. */
13647 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64, bfd_mach_mips5 },
13648
13649 /* R10000 extensions. */
13650 { bfd_mach_mips12000, bfd_mach_mips10000 },
13651 { bfd_mach_mips14000, bfd_mach_mips10000 },
13652 { bfd_mach_mips16000, bfd_mach_mips10000 },
13653
13654 /* R5000 extensions. Note: the vr5500 ISA is an extension of the core
13655 vr5400 ISA, but doesn't include the multimedia stuff. It seems
13656 better to allow vr5400 and vr5500 code to be merged anyway, since
13657 many libraries will just use the core ISA. Perhaps we could add
13658 some sort of ASE flag if this ever proves a problem. */
13659 { bfd_mach_mips5500, bfd_mach_mips5400 },
13660 { bfd_mach_mips5400, bfd_mach_mips5000 },
13661
13662 /* MIPS IV extensions. */
13663 { bfd_mach_mips5, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
13664 { bfd_mach_mips10000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
13665 { bfd_mach_mips5000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
13666 { bfd_mach_mips7000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
13667 { bfd_mach_mips9000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
13668
13669 /* VR4100 extensions. */
13670 { bfd_mach_mips4120, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
13671 { bfd_mach_mips4111, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
13672
13673 /* MIPS III extensions. */
13674 { bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2e, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
13675 { bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2f, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
13676 { bfd_mach_mips8000, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
13677 { bfd_mach_mips4650, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
13678 { bfd_mach_mips4600, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
13679 { bfd_mach_mips4400, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
13680 { bfd_mach_mips4300, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
13681 { bfd_mach_mips4100, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
13682 { bfd_mach_mips4010, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
13683 { bfd_mach_mips5900, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
13684
13685 /* MIPS32 extensions. */
13686 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa32 },
13687
13688 /* MIPS II extensions. */
13689 { bfd_mach_mips4000, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
13690 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
13691
13692 /* MIPS I extensions. */
13693 { bfd_mach_mips6000, bfd_mach_mips3000 },
13694 { bfd_mach_mips3900, bfd_mach_mips3000 }
13695 };
13696
13697
13698 /* Return true if bfd machine EXTENSION is an extension of machine BASE. */
13699
13700 static bfd_boolean
13701 mips_mach_extends_p (unsigned long base, unsigned long extension)
13702 {
13703 size_t i;
13704
13705 if (extension == base)
13706 return TRUE;
13707
13708 if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32
13709 && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64, extension))
13710 return TRUE;
13711
13712 if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2
13713 && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, extension))
13714 return TRUE;
13715
13716 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_mach_extensions); i++)
13717 if (extension == mips_mach_extensions[i].extension)
13718 {
13719 extension = mips_mach_extensions[i].base;
13720 if (extension == base)
13721 return TRUE;
13722 }
13723
13724 return FALSE;
13725 }
13726
13727
13728 /* Return true if the given ELF header flags describe a 32-bit binary. */
13729
13730 static bfd_boolean
13731 mips_32bit_flags_p (flagword flags)
13732 {
13733 return ((flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE) != 0
13734 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32
13735 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32
13736 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1
13737 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2
13738 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32
13739 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2);
13740 }
13741
13742
13743 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Raise an error if
13744 there are conflicting attributes. */
13745 static bfd_boolean
13746 mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
13747 {
13748 obj_attribute *in_attr;
13749 obj_attribute *out_attr;
13750 bfd *abi_fp_bfd;
13751
13752 abi_fp_bfd = mips_elf_tdata (obfd)->abi_fp_bfd;
13753 in_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
13754 if (!abi_fp_bfd && in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i != 0)
13755 mips_elf_tdata (obfd)->abi_fp_bfd = ibfd;
13756
13757 if (!elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd)[0].i)
13758 {
13759 /* This is the first object. Copy the attributes. */
13760 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
13761
13762 /* Use the Tag_null value to indicate the attributes have been
13763 initialized. */
13764 elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd)[0].i = 1;
13765
13766 return TRUE;
13767 }
13768
13769 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP attributes and merge
13770 non-conflicting ones. */
13771 out_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
13772 if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i != out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
13773 {
13774 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].type = 1;
13775 if (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i == 0)
13776 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i = in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i;
13777 else if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i != 0)
13778 switch (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
13779 {
13780 case 1:
13781 switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
13782 {
13783 case 2:
13784 _bfd_error_handler
13785 (_("Warning: %B uses %s (set by %B), %B uses %s"),
13786 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd, "-mdouble-float", "-msingle-float");
13787 break;
13788
13789 case 3:
13790 _bfd_error_handler
13791 (_("Warning: %B uses %s (set by %B), %B uses %s"),
13792 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd, "-mhard-float", "-msoft-float");
13793 break;
13794
13795 case 4:
13796 _bfd_error_handler
13797 (_("Warning: %B uses %s (set by %B), %B uses %s"),
13798 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd,
13799 "-mdouble-float", "-mips32r2 -mfp64");
13800 break;
13801
13802 default:
13803 _bfd_error_handler
13804 (_("Warning: %B uses %s (set by %B), "
13805 "%B uses unknown floating point ABI %d"),
13806 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd,
13807 "-mdouble-float", in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i);
13808 break;
13809 }
13810 break;
13811
13812 case 2:
13813 switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
13814 {
13815 case 1:
13816 _bfd_error_handler
13817 (_("Warning: %B uses %s (set by %B), %B uses %s"),
13818 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd, "-msingle-float", "-mdouble-float");
13819 break;
13820
13821 case 3:
13822 _bfd_error_handler
13823 (_("Warning: %B uses %s (set by %B), %B uses %s"),
13824 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd, "-mhard-float", "-msoft-float");
13825 break;
13826
13827 case 4:
13828 _bfd_error_handler
13829 (_("Warning: %B uses %s (set by %B), %B uses %s"),
13830 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd,
13831 "-msingle-float", "-mips32r2 -mfp64");
13832 break;
13833
13834 default:
13835 _bfd_error_handler
13836 (_("Warning: %B uses %s (set by %B), "
13837 "%B uses unknown floating point ABI %d"),
13838 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd,
13839 "-msingle-float", in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i);
13840 break;
13841 }
13842 break;
13843
13844 case 3:
13845 switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
13846 {
13847 case 1:
13848 case 2:
13849 case 4:
13850 _bfd_error_handler
13851 (_("Warning: %B uses %s (set by %B), %B uses %s"),
13852 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd, "-msoft-float", "-mhard-float");
13853 break;
13854
13855 default:
13856 _bfd_error_handler
13857 (_("Warning: %B uses %s (set by %B), "
13858 "%B uses unknown floating point ABI %d"),
13859 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd,
13860 "-msoft-float", in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i);
13861 break;
13862 }
13863 break;
13864
13865 case 4:
13866 switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
13867 {
13868 case 1:
13869 _bfd_error_handler
13870 (_("Warning: %B uses %s (set by %B), %B uses %s"),
13871 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd,
13872 "-mips32r2 -mfp64", "-mdouble-float");
13873 break;
13874
13875 case 2:
13876 _bfd_error_handler
13877 (_("Warning: %B uses %s (set by %B), %B uses %s"),
13878 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd,
13879 "-mips32r2 -mfp64", "-msingle-float");
13880 break;
13881
13882 case 3:
13883 _bfd_error_handler
13884 (_("Warning: %B uses %s (set by %B), %B uses %s"),
13885 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd, "-mhard-float", "-msoft-float");
13886 break;
13887
13888 default:
13889 _bfd_error_handler
13890 (_("Warning: %B uses %s (set by %B), "
13891 "%B uses unknown floating point ABI %d"),
13892 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd,
13893 "-mips32r2 -mfp64", in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i);
13894 break;
13895 }
13896 break;
13897
13898 default:
13899 switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
13900 {
13901 case 1:
13902 _bfd_error_handler
13903 (_("Warning: %B uses unknown floating point ABI %d "
13904 "(set by %B), %B uses %s"),
13905 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd,
13906 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i, "-mdouble-float");
13907 break;
13908
13909 case 2:
13910 _bfd_error_handler
13911 (_("Warning: %B uses unknown floating point ABI %d "
13912 "(set by %B), %B uses %s"),
13913 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd,
13914 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i, "-msingle-float");
13915 break;
13916
13917 case 3:
13918 _bfd_error_handler
13919 (_("Warning: %B uses unknown floating point ABI %d "
13920 "(set by %B), %B uses %s"),
13921 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd,
13922 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i, "-msoft-float");
13923 break;
13924
13925 case 4:
13926 _bfd_error_handler
13927 (_("Warning: %B uses unknown floating point ABI %d "
13928 "(set by %B), %B uses %s"),
13929 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd,
13930 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i, "-mips32r2 -mfp64");
13931 break;
13932
13933 default:
13934 _bfd_error_handler
13935 (_("Warning: %B uses unknown floating point ABI %d "
13936 "(set by %B), %B uses unknown floating point ABI %d"),
13937 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd,
13938 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i,
13939 in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i);
13940 break;
13941 }
13942 break;
13943 }
13944 }
13945
13946 /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
13947 _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
13948
13949 return TRUE;
13950 }
13951
13952 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
13953 object file when linking. */
13954
13955 bfd_boolean
13956 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
13957 {
13958 flagword old_flags;
13959 flagword new_flags;
13960 bfd_boolean ok;
13961 bfd_boolean null_input_bfd = TRUE;
13962 asection *sec;
13963
13964 /* Check if we have the same endianness. */
13965 if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, obfd))
13966 {
13967 (*_bfd_error_handler)
13968 (_("%B: endianness incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
13969 ibfd);
13970 return FALSE;
13971 }
13972
13973 if (!is_mips_elf (ibfd) || !is_mips_elf (obfd))
13974 return TRUE;
13975
13976 if (strcmp (bfd_get_target (ibfd), bfd_get_target (obfd)) != 0)
13977 {
13978 (*_bfd_error_handler)
13979 (_("%B: ABI is incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
13980 ibfd);
13981 return FALSE;
13982 }
13983
13984 if (!mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd))
13985 return FALSE;
13986
13987 new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
13988 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
13989 old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
13990
13991 if (! elf_flags_init (obfd))
13992 {
13993 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
13994 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
13995 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
13996 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS];
13997
13998 if (bfd_get_arch (obfd) == bfd_get_arch (ibfd)
13999 && (bfd_get_arch_info (obfd)->the_default
14000 || mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd),
14001 bfd_get_mach (ibfd))))
14002 {
14003 if (! bfd_set_arch_mach (obfd, bfd_get_arch (ibfd),
14004 bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
14005 return FALSE;
14006 }
14007
14008 return TRUE;
14009 }
14010
14011 /* Check flag compatibility. */
14012
14013 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
14014 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
14015
14016 /* Some IRIX 6 BSD-compatibility objects have this bit set. It
14017 doesn't seem to matter. */
14018 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
14019 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
14020
14021 /* MIPSpro generates ucode info in n64 objects. Again, we should
14022 just be able to ignore this. */
14023 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
14024 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
14025
14026 /* DSOs should only be linked with CPIC code. */
14027 if ((ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
14028 new_flags |= EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC;
14029
14030 if (new_flags == old_flags)
14031 return TRUE;
14032
14033 /* Check to see if the input BFD actually contains any sections.
14034 If not, its flags may not have been initialised either, but it cannot
14035 actually cause any incompatibility. */
14036 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
14037 {
14038 /* Ignore synthetic sections and empty .text, .data and .bss sections
14039 which are automatically generated by gas. Also ignore fake
14040 (s)common sections, since merely defining a common symbol does
14041 not affect compatibility. */
14042 if ((sec->flags & SEC_IS_COMMON) == 0
14043 && strcmp (sec->name, ".reginfo")
14044 && strcmp (sec->name, ".mdebug")
14045 && (sec->size != 0
14046 || (strcmp (sec->name, ".text")
14047 && strcmp (sec->name, ".data")
14048 && strcmp (sec->name, ".bss"))))
14049 {
14050 null_input_bfd = FALSE;
14051 break;
14052 }
14053 }
14054 if (null_input_bfd)
14055 return TRUE;
14056
14057 ok = TRUE;
14058
14059 if (((new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0)
14060 != ((old_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0))
14061 {
14062 (*_bfd_error_handler)
14063 (_("%B: warning: linking abicalls files with non-abicalls files"),
14064 ibfd);
14065 ok = TRUE;
14066 }
14067
14068 if (new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC))
14069 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_MIPS_CPIC;
14070 if (! (new_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC))
14071 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_PIC;
14072
14073 new_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
14074 old_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
14075
14076 /* Compare the ISAs. */
14077 if (mips_32bit_flags_p (old_flags) != mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags))
14078 {
14079 (*_bfd_error_handler)
14080 (_("%B: linking 32-bit code with 64-bit code"),
14081 ibfd);
14082 ok = FALSE;
14083 }
14084 else if (!mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (ibfd), bfd_get_mach (obfd)))
14085 {
14086 /* OBFD's ISA isn't the same as, or an extension of, IBFD's. */
14087 if (mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd), bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
14088 {
14089 /* Copy the architecture info from IBFD to OBFD. Also copy
14090 the 32-bit flag (if set) so that we continue to recognise
14091 OBFD as a 32-bit binary. */
14092 bfd_set_arch_info (obfd, bfd_get_arch_info (ibfd));
14093 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
14094 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags
14095 |= new_flags & (EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
14096
14097 /* Copy across the ABI flags if OBFD doesn't use them
14098 and if that was what caused us to treat IBFD as 32-bit. */
14099 if ((old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == 0
14100 && mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags)
14101 && !mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags & ~EF_MIPS_ABI))
14102 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI;
14103 }
14104 else
14105 {
14106 /* The ISAs aren't compatible. */
14107 (*_bfd_error_handler)
14108 (_("%B: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
14109 ibfd,
14110 bfd_printable_name (ibfd),
14111 bfd_printable_name (obfd));
14112 ok = FALSE;
14113 }
14114 }
14115
14116 new_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
14117 old_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
14118
14119 /* Compare ABIs. The 64-bit ABI does not use EF_MIPS_ABI. But, it
14120 does set EI_CLASS differently from any 32-bit ABI. */
14121 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
14122 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
14123 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
14124 {
14125 /* Only error if both are set (to different values). */
14126 if (((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) && (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
14127 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
14128 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
14129 {
14130 (*_bfd_error_handler)
14131 (_("%B: ABI mismatch: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
14132 ibfd,
14133 elf_mips_abi_name (ibfd),
14134 elf_mips_abi_name (obfd));
14135 ok = FALSE;
14136 }
14137 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
14138 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
14139 }
14140
14141 /* Compare ASEs. Forbid linking MIPS16 and microMIPS ASE modules together
14142 and allow arbitrary mixing of the remaining ASEs (retain the union). */
14143 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE))
14144 {
14145 int old_micro = old_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MICROMIPS;
14146 int new_micro = new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MICROMIPS;
14147 int old_m16 = old_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16;
14148 int new_m16 = new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16;
14149 int micro_mis = old_m16 && new_micro;
14150 int m16_mis = old_micro && new_m16;
14151
14152 if (m16_mis || micro_mis)
14153 {
14154 (*_bfd_error_handler)
14155 (_("%B: ASE mismatch: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
14156 ibfd,
14157 m16_mis ? "MIPS16" : "microMIPS",
14158 m16_mis ? "microMIPS" : "MIPS16");
14159 ok = FALSE;
14160 }
14161
14162 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
14163
14164 new_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
14165 old_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
14166 }
14167
14168 /* Warn about any other mismatches */
14169 if (new_flags != old_flags)
14170 {
14171 (*_bfd_error_handler)
14172 (_("%B: uses different e_flags (0x%lx) fields than previous modules (0x%lx)"),
14173 ibfd, (unsigned long) new_flags,
14174 (unsigned long) old_flags);
14175 ok = FALSE;
14176 }
14177
14178 if (! ok)
14179 {
14180 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
14181 return FALSE;
14182 }
14183
14184 return TRUE;
14185 }
14186
14187 /* Function to keep MIPS specific file flags like as EF_MIPS_PIC. */
14188
14189 bfd_boolean
14190 _bfd_mips_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
14191 {
14192 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
14193 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
14194
14195 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
14196 elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
14197 return TRUE;
14198 }
14199
14200 char *
14201 _bfd_mips_elf_get_target_dtag (bfd_vma dtag)
14202 {
14203 switch (dtag)
14204 {
14205 default: return "";
14206 case DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION:
14207 return "MIPS_RLD_VERSION";
14208 case DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP:
14209 return "MIPS_TIME_STAMP";
14210 case DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM:
14211 return "MIPS_ICHECKSUM";
14212 case DT_MIPS_IVERSION:
14213 return "MIPS_IVERSION";
14214 case DT_MIPS_FLAGS:
14215 return "MIPS_FLAGS";
14216 case DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS:
14217 return "MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS";
14218 case DT_MIPS_MSYM:
14219 return "MIPS_MSYM";
14220 case DT_MIPS_CONFLICT:
14221 return "MIPS_CONFLICT";
14222 case DT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
14223 return "MIPS_LIBLIST";
14224 case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO:
14225 return "MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO";
14226 case DT_MIPS_CONFLICTNO:
14227 return "MIPS_CONFLICTNO";
14228 case DT_MIPS_LIBLISTNO:
14229 return "MIPS_LIBLISTNO";
14230 case DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO:
14231 return "MIPS_SYMTABNO";
14232 case DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO:
14233 return "MIPS_UNREFEXTNO";
14234 case DT_MIPS_GOTSYM:
14235 return "MIPS_GOTSYM";
14236 case DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO:
14237 return "MIPS_HIPAGENO";
14238 case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP:
14239 return "MIPS_RLD_MAP";
14240 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_CLASS:
14241 return "MIPS_DELTA_CLASS";
14242 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_CLASS_NO:
14243 return "MIPS_DELTA_CLASS_NO";
14244 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_INSTANCE:
14245 return "MIPS_DELTA_INSTANCE";
14246 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_INSTANCE_NO:
14247 return "MIPS_DELTA_INSTANCE_NO";
14248 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_RELOC:
14249 return "MIPS_DELTA_RELOC";
14250 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_RELOC_NO:
14251 return "MIPS_DELTA_RELOC_NO";
14252 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_SYM:
14253 return "MIPS_DELTA_SYM";
14254 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_SYM_NO:
14255 return "MIPS_DELTA_SYM_NO";
14256 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_CLASSSYM:
14257 return "MIPS_DELTA_CLASSSYM";
14258 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_CLASSSYM_NO:
14259 return "MIPS_DELTA_CLASSSYM_NO";
14260 case DT_MIPS_CXX_FLAGS:
14261 return "MIPS_CXX_FLAGS";
14262 case DT_MIPS_PIXIE_INIT:
14263 return "MIPS_PIXIE_INIT";
14264 case DT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
14265 return "MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB";
14266 case DT_MIPS_LOCALPAGE_GOTIDX:
14267 return "MIPS_LOCALPAGE_GOTIDX";
14268 case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTIDX:
14269 return "MIPS_LOCAL_GOTIDX";
14270 case DT_MIPS_HIDDEN_GOTIDX:
14271 return "MIPS_HIDDEN_GOTIDX";
14272 case DT_MIPS_PROTECTED_GOTIDX:
14273 return "MIPS_PROTECTED_GOT_IDX";
14274 case DT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
14275 return "MIPS_OPTIONS";
14276 case DT_MIPS_INTERFACE:
14277 return "MIPS_INTERFACE";
14278 case DT_MIPS_DYNSTR_ALIGN:
14279 return "DT_MIPS_DYNSTR_ALIGN";
14280 case DT_MIPS_INTERFACE_SIZE:
14281 return "DT_MIPS_INTERFACE_SIZE";
14282 case DT_MIPS_RLD_TEXT_RESOLVE_ADDR:
14283 return "DT_MIPS_RLD_TEXT_RESOLVE_ADDR";
14284 case DT_MIPS_PERF_SUFFIX:
14285 return "DT_MIPS_PERF_SUFFIX";
14286 case DT_MIPS_COMPACT_SIZE:
14287 return "DT_MIPS_COMPACT_SIZE";
14288 case DT_MIPS_GP_VALUE:
14289 return "DT_MIPS_GP_VALUE";
14290 case DT_MIPS_AUX_DYNAMIC:
14291 return "DT_MIPS_AUX_DYNAMIC";
14292 case DT_MIPS_PLTGOT:
14293 return "DT_MIPS_PLTGOT";
14294 case DT_MIPS_RWPLT:
14295 return "DT_MIPS_RWPLT";
14296 }
14297 }
14298
14299 bfd_boolean
14300 _bfd_mips_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *ptr)
14301 {
14302 FILE *file = ptr;
14303
14304 BFD_ASSERT (abfd != NULL && ptr != NULL);
14305
14306 /* Print normal ELF private data. */
14307 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, ptr);
14308
14309 /* xgettext:c-format */
14310 fprintf (file, _("private flags = %lx:"), elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags);
14311
14312 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32)
14313 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O32]"));
14314 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O64)
14315 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O64]"));
14316 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32)
14317 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI32]"));
14318 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
14319 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI64]"));
14320 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
14321 fprintf (file, _(" [abi unknown]"));
14322 else if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
14323 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=N32]"));
14324 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
14325 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=64]"));
14326 else
14327 fprintf (file, _(" [no abi set]"));
14328
14329 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1)
14330 fprintf (file, " [mips1]");
14331 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2)
14332 fprintf (file, " [mips2]");
14333 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_3)
14334 fprintf (file, " [mips3]");
14335 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_4)
14336 fprintf (file, " [mips4]");
14337 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_5)
14338 fprintf (file, " [mips5]");
14339 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32)
14340 fprintf (file, " [mips32]");
14341 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64)
14342 fprintf (file, " [mips64]");
14343 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2)
14344 fprintf (file, " [mips32r2]");
14345 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2)
14346 fprintf (file, " [mips64r2]");
14347 else
14348 fprintf (file, _(" [unknown ISA]"));
14349
14350 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MDMX)
14351 fprintf (file, " [mdmx]");
14352
14353 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16)
14354 fprintf (file, " [mips16]");
14355
14356 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MICROMIPS)
14357 fprintf (file, " [micromips]");
14358
14359 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE)
14360 fprintf (file, " [32bitmode]");
14361 else
14362 fprintf (file, _(" [not 32bitmode]"));
14363
14364 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER)
14365 fprintf (file, " [noreorder]");
14366
14367 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC)
14368 fprintf (file, " [PIC]");
14369
14370 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_CPIC)
14371 fprintf (file, " [CPIC]");
14372
14373 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_XGOT)
14374 fprintf (file, " [XGOT]");
14375
14376 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_UCODE)
14377 fprintf (file, " [UCODE]");
14378
14379 fputc ('\n', file);
14380
14381 return TRUE;
14382 }
14383
14384 const struct bfd_elf_special_section _bfd_mips_elf_special_sections[] =
14385 {
14386 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".lit4"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
14387 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".lit8"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
14388 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".mdebug"), 0, SHT_MIPS_DEBUG, 0 },
14389 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
14390 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
14391 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".ucode"), 0, SHT_MIPS_UCODE, 0 },
14392 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
14393 };
14394
14395 /* Merge non visibility st_other attributes. Ensure that the
14396 STO_OPTIONAL flag is copied into h->other, even if this is not a
14397 definiton of the symbol. */
14398 void
14399 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_symbol_attribute (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
14400 const Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
14401 bfd_boolean definition,
14402 bfd_boolean dynamic ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
14403 {
14404 if ((isym->st_other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1)) != 0)
14405 {
14406 unsigned char other;
14407
14408 other = (definition ? isym->st_other : h->other);
14409 other &= ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1);
14410 h->other = other | ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other);
14411 }
14412
14413 if (!definition
14414 && ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (isym->st_other))
14415 h->other |= STO_OPTIONAL;
14416 }
14417
14418 /* Decide whether an undefined symbol is special and can be ignored.
14419 This is the case for OPTIONAL symbols on IRIX. */
14420 bfd_boolean
14421 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_undef_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
14422 {
14423 return ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (h->other) ? TRUE : FALSE;
14424 }
14425
14426 bfd_boolean
14427 _bfd_mips_elf_common_definition (Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
14428 {
14429 return (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
14430 || sym->st_shndx == SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON
14431 || sym->st_shndx == SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON);
14432 }
14433
14434 /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
14435 or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included. */
14436
14437 bfd_vma
14438 _bfd_mips_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i, const asection *plt,
14439 const arelent *rel ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
14440 {
14441 return (plt->vma
14442 + 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_o32_exec_plt0_entry)
14443 + i * 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_exec_plt_entry));
14444 }
14445
14446 void
14447 _bfd_mips_post_process_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
14448 {
14449 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
14450 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;
14451
14452 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
14453 if (link_info)
14454 {
14455 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (link_info);
14456 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
14457
14458 if (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs && !htab->is_vxworks)
14459 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION] = 1;
14460 }
14461 }